QCC Human Resources Master Files Manual

Quintessential School Systems
QCC
Human Resources
Master Files Manual
© Quintessential School Systems (QSS), 2010
All Rights Reserved
867 American Street, 5Seconf Floor --- San Carlos, CA 94070 --- Voice 650/598-9500 --- Fax 650/372-3386 --- www.qss.com
Published: 01/10
Copyright Notice
Copyright © Quintessential School Systems, 2010
This document contains proprietary information which is protected by copyright. All rights are reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced,
transmitted, transcribed, stored in a retrieval system or translated into any language or computer language, in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, optical, chemical, manual or otherwise without the prior written approval
of Quintessential School Systems (QSS).
The information contained in this document is subject to change without
notice.
QUINTESSENTIAL SCHOOL SYSTEMS MAKES NO WARRANTY OF
ANY KIND WITH REGARD TO THIS MATERIAL, INCLUDING, BUT
NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
Quintessential School Systems shall not be liable for errors contained
herein or resulting from the use of this material.
QSS/OASIS, STUDENT/3000, and SCHOOL/3000 are registered trademarks
of Quintessential School Systems.
The samples of reports, windows, and dialog boxes in this document are provided to illustrate the operation of the software at a typical site. All names and
addresses are fictitious. The actual windows, dialog boxes, and reports at your
site may vary from the samples in this documentation.
Contents
List of Figures
List of Tables
Chapter 1: Introduction
Chapter Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Manual Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Chapter 1: Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Chapter 2: HR Code Maintenance Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Chapter 3: HR Code Maintenance 2 Window. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Chapter 4: Maintaining Master Files. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Appendix A: Common Elements in QCC Windows. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Appendix B: QSSInstaPrint Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Relation to Other Manuals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Objectives. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
How to Use this Manual. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Locating Master Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Detailed Instructions for Master File Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Audience and Knowledge Assumed. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Related Documentation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Help Files for QCC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Viewing Help Files from QCC. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
QSS ControlCenter Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Printing Reports with Print Manager . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Additional Resources for System Administrators. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Gaining Access to Help Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
System Security and Session Administration for QCC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Module, Task, and User Security for QCC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1-1
1-2
1-2
1-2
1-2
1-2
1-3
1-3
1-3
1-3
1-5
1-5
1-5
1-6
1-7
1-7
1-7
1-7
1-8
1-8
1-8
1-8
1-9
Chapter 2: HR Code Maintenance Window
Chapter Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
Description of the HR Code Maintenance Window. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3
Title Bar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3
Menu Bar and Toolbar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4
File Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4
View Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5
Options Menu and Toolbar. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6
Help Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6
Message Bar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8
Tree View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8
Purpose . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
Expanding and Collapsing Folders. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
Displaying a Master File in the Grid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10
Access Levels and Types of Master Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11
--- continued on next page ---
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
Contents-1
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 2: HR Code Maintenance Window - continued
Tree View - continued
Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Grid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Name of the Grid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Contents of the Grid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Status Bar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Opening the Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Maintaining and Reporting Master File Records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Inspecting Records (Inspect Command) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Changing and Deleting Records (Change Command). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Adding and Importing Records (Add New Command and Add New [No Preload]
Command) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Launching a Report (Create Report Command). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Add/Import Multiple Records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Importing Multiple Records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Data Formats for Master Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-13
2-19
2-19
2-19
2-20
2-21
2-23
2-23
2-25
2-27
2-29
2-30
2-30
2-32
Chapter 3: HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
Chapter Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1
Description of the HR Code Maintenance 2 Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3
Title Bar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3
Menu Bar and Toolbar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
File Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
View Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5
Options Menu and Toolbar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6
Help Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6
Message Bar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8
Tree View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8
Purpose . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9
Expanding and Collapsing Folders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9
Displaying a Master File in the Grid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11
Access Levels and Types of Master Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11
Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14
Grid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19
Name of the Grid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19
Contents of the Grid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19
Status Bar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20
Opening the Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-21
Maintaining and Reporting Tax Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23
Inspecting and Changing Tax Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23
Adding a New Tax Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25
Deleting a Tax Table. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27
Creating Reports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-28
Contents-2
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Contents
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Chapter Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1
How to Use This Chapter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2
Master Files in this Chapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
Master File Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13
Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13
Sample Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13
Box Label Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14
R/O/D Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14
Required . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14
Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14
Optional . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14
Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15
Contents Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15
Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15
Dollar Amount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16
Fiscal Year . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16
Fixed Decimal Point. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17
Numerals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17
Numeric Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17
Selection from Option Buttons. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18
Selection from List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18
Text. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19
Time Stamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19
Absence Tracking Master Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-21
Absence Reasons (AR) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-21
Leave Groups (LG) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23
General Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23
Leave Buckets Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23
Service Years Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25
Paystub Mapping Tab. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25
Absence Indices (AI) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27
Absence FTE Codes (AF) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29
Absence Tracking Accrual Subfolder. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30
Roll Codes (RO) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31
Accrual Rules (AC) Master File. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32
Accrual Schedules (AS) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-36
Absence Interface Rules (IR) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-37
General Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-37
Global Site . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-38
Global Leave Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40
Site/Leave Group Rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40
Personnel Master Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-43
District Master (DP) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-44
Locations (LOC) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46
Location Org Levels Fields (LO) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-49
Bargaining Units (BU) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-50
--- continued on next page ---
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
Contents-3
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files - continued
Personnel Master Files - continued
Board Dates (BD) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-51
Certificate Level (CL) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-52
Certificate Type (CT) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-54
Comments Types (CO) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-55
Contract Types (CN) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-56
Control Groups (CG) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-57
County/State Codes (CS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-59
Credentials Subfolder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-61
Credentials (CR) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-61
Credential Authorizations (CA) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-62
Credential Renewal Codes (CW) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-64
Credential Subject Codes (CB) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-65
Credential Level Codes (CV) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-66
Degree Type (DT) Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-67
Employee Types (EM) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-69
Ethnic Codes (ET) Code Master Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-70
Experience Types (ET) Master Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-71
Freeze Placement Reasons (FP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-73
Handicap (HA) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-74
Hospital Codes (HO) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-75
Institutions (Colleges) (IN) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-77
Immunization (IM) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-78
Inservice Ed Component (IE) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-79
Insurance Carrier (IC) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-81
Medical Codes (ME) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-82
Membership List (LM) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-83
Job Categories (JB) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-84
Job Codes (JC) Master File. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-85
General Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-85
Code Definition and Credentials/Education Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-85
Subject/Skills Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-87
Test Information/Experience Tab. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-87
Sample Master File Report. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-88
Language Codes (LA) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-88
Program of Graduation (PG) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-89
Refusal Reason (RR) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-91
Report Codes (RC) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-92
Seniority Class (SN) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-93
Skill Codes (SK) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-95
Subject Codes (SU) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-96
Termination Code (TE) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-98
Test Master Codes (TM) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-100
Personnel Action Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-101
PAF Category (PA) Master File. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-101
PAF Actions (PF) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-103
PAF Dictionary (PD) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-104
--- continued on next page ---
Contents-4
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Contents
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files - continued
Payroll Master Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pay Codes (PC) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Payroll Name (PYN) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pay Schedules (PS) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pay Types (PT) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Retirement Systems (RS) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Retirement Edits (RE) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Payroll Profiles (PP) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Statutory Deductions Subfolder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Statutory Deduction Codes (SD) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Statutory Deduction Profiles (SP) Master File. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Deduction Schedule (DS) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Deduction Rate Table (DR) Master File. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Bonus Codes (BC) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Payroll Edit Rules (PE) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Deduction Rule Codes (PR) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SMF Status Codes (SM) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pending Retirement Status Codes (PN) Master File. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Vol-Ded Frequency Codes (VD) Master File. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Voluntary Deductions (VD) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Benefit Controls (BC) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Benefit Object Maps (OMAP) Master File. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Health/Welfare Benefit Maps (VMAP) Master File. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Benefit Group Maps (GMAP) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tax Tables Subfolder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Federal Income Tax (TT01) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
OASDI/Medicare (TT03) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Workers Compensation (TT05) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
State Tax California (TT06) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SUI California (TT07) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PERS California (TT08) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
STRS California (TT09) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
California Retirement Setup (TT10) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
California State Disability Insurance (TT11) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Position Control Master Files. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Position Bonus Codes (PB) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Benefit Projected Rates (BPR) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
District Authorized Positions (DAP) Master File. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Maintaining District Authorized Positions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Header Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Description Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Requirements 1 Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Requirements 2 Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Account Distribution Tab. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Benefits Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Employee List Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-105
4-106
4-107
4-109
4-111
4-113
4-114
4-116
4-117
4-118
4-119
4-121
4-123
4-125
4-127
4-128
4-129
4-131
4-132
4-133
4-135
4-136
4-138
4-139
4-140
4-141
4-147
4-148
4-150
4-153
4-155
4-156
4-158
4-159
4-161
4-162
4-164
4-166
4-167
4-170
4-170
4-172
4-173
4-174
4-175
4-176
--- continued on next page ---
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
Contents-5
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files - continued
Position Control Master Files - continued
New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Maintaining District Authorized Positions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Header Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Description Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Requirements 1 Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Requirements 2 Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Account Distribution Tab. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Benefits Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Employee List Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Reports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Salary Schedules (SS) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
New Salary Schedules (SSN) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Maintaining and Reporting Salary Schedules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Description of the Dialog Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Sample Salary Schedule Matrix (PP0302) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Work Calendars (WC) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Maintaining Work Calendars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Changing Days on the Calendar. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Report Sample . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Master File Links . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pay Code Links (FL01) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Voluntary Deduction Code Links (FL02) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Vol-Ded Frequency Code Links (FL03) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pay Schedule Code Links (FL04) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Stat Ded Profile Code Links (FL05) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Deduction Schedule Code Links (FL06) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Link Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Benefits Management Master Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Coverage Level Codes (BMLC) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Deduction Class List (BMCL) Master File. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Dependent Codes (BMDC) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
FTE Allocation Table (BMFT) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Package Codes (BMPK) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Plan Codes (BMPC) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Plan/Level Amounts (BMPL) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cap Amounts (BMCA) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Benefit Status Codes (BMBS) Master File. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Package Assignment (BMPA) Master File. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Retirement - CA Master Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
District Master File (RTDI) Master File. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Accumulator Limits (RTAL) Master File. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
STRS Rates (RTST) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PERS Rates (RTPE) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pay Schedule Controls (RTPS) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Retirement Group Subfolder. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
District Master File by Group (RTDG) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PERS Rates by Group (RTGP) Master File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Contents-6
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-177
4-177
4-181
4-182
4-183
4-184
4-185
4-186
4-187
4-188
4-193
4-193
4-194
4-199
4-208
4-209
4-209
4-210
4-213
4-215
4-216
4-216
4-217
4-218
4-219
4-220
4-221
4-221
4-223
4-223
4-226
4-227
4-229
4-234
4-237
4-240
4-242
4-243
4-244
4-246
4-247
4-249
4-250
4-251
4-253
4-254
4-255
4-257
01/10
Contents
Chapter A: Common Elements in QCC Windows
Appendix Contents. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-1
The Grid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-2
Navigating through the Grid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-2
Sorting the Grid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-4
Filling In Boxes in Tabs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-5
Moving from Tab to Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-5
Moving from One Box to Another . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-5
Selecting Options from Lists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-6
Typing in a Text Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-7
Checking Boxes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-8
Selecting Option Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-8
Typing or Selecting Dates. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-9
Help Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-11
About Command. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-11
Commands for the About Dialog Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-12
Tabs on the About Dialog Box. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-13
User Security Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-17
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-17
Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-17
Columns in the Grid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-18
Chapter B:QSSInstaPrint Window
Appendix Contents. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-1
Overview of QSSInstaPrint Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-2
Menu Bar and Toolbar Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-3
File Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-3
Options Menu and Toolbar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-3
Saving and Printing Instaprint Reports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-5
Saving a File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-5
Opening in Excel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-6
Opening in Excel Wizard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-8
Opening in Word . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-13
Creating a PDF File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-14
Index
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
Contents-7
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Contents-8
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
List of Figures
Chapter 2: HR Code Maintenance Window
Figure 2-1: HR Code Maintenance window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-3
Figure 2-2: Title bar for the HR Code Maintenance window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-3
Figure 2-3: Menu bar and toolbar for the HR Code Maintenance window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4
Figure 2-4:: File menu for the HR Code Maintenance window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4
Figure 2-5: QSS Personnel dialog box for the Show Status command. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4
Figure 2-6: View menu for the HR Code Maintenance window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-5
Figure 2-7: Options menu, View menu, and toolbar commands for the
HR Code Maintenance window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-6
Figure 2-8: Help menu for the HR Code Maintenance window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-6
Figure 2-9: Message bar for the HR Code Maintenance window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-8
Figure 2-10: Tree view for the HR Code Maintenance window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-8
Figure 2-11: Tree view with all folders collapsed (closed) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-9
Figure 2-12: Tree view with Retirement - CA folder expanded . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-10
Figure 2-13: Toolbar commands for maintaining master files. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-11
Figure 2-14: Filter for the HR Code Maintenance window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-13
Figure 2-15: Result of searching for "principal teacher (env/ed))" with no wildcards . . . . . . . . .2-15
Figure 2-16: Result of searching for "prin*" with first word match . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-16
Figure 2-17: Result of searching for "*prin" with partial word match . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-17
Figure 2-18: Lists for selecting a district, site, and year in the Settings dialog box . . . . . . . . . . .2-18
Figure 2-19: Grid for the HR Code Maintenance window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-19
Figure 2-20: Name of master file above the grid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-19
Figure 2-21: Status bar for the HR Code Maintenance window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-20
Figure 2-22: Go menu expanded . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-21
Figure 2-23: Human Resources submenu expanded . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-21
Figure 2-24: Tree view with Human Resources folder open. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-22
Figure 2-25: Tree view after opening the Master Files / Utilities subfolder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-22
Figure 2-26: View dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-24
Figure 2-27: Change dialog box for changing or deleting records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-25
Figure 2-28: Add dialog box for creating records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-28
Figure 2-29: Report dialog box for HR Code Maintenance window. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-29
Figure 2-30: Grid Import dialog box for the Pay Types master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-32
Chapter 3: HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
Figure 3-1: HR Code Maintenance 2 window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-3
Figure 3-2: Title bar for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-3
Figure 3-3: Menu bar and toolbar for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-4
Figure 3-4:: File menu for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-4
Figure 3-5: QSS Personnel dialog box for the Show Status command. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-4
--- continued on next page ---
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
Figures-1
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 3: HR Code Maintenance 2 Window - continued
Figure 3-6: View menu for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-5
Figure 3-7: Options menu, View menu, and toolbar commands for the
HR Code Maintenance 2 window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-6
Figure 3-8: Help menu for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-6
Figure 3-9: Message bar for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-8
Figure 3-10: Tree view for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-8
Figure 3-11: Tree view with all folders collapsed (closed) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-9
Figure 3-12: Tree view with Retirement - CA folder expanded . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-10
Figure 3-13: Toolbar commands for maintaining master files. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-12
Figure 3-14: Filter for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-14
Figure 3-15: Result of searching for "principal teacher (env/ed))" with no wildcards . . . . . . . . .3-16
Figure 3-16: Result of searching for "prin*" with first word match . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-16
Figure 3-17: Result of searching for "*prin" with partial word match . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-17
Figure 3-18: Lists for selecting a district, site, and year in the Settings dialog box . . . . . . . . . . .3-18
Figure 3-19: Grid for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-19
Figure 3-20: Name of master file above the grid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-19
Figure 3-21: Status bar for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-20
Figure 3-22: Go menu expanded . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-21
Figure 3-23: Human Resources submenu expanded . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-21
Figure 3-24: Tree view with Human Resources folder open. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-22
Figure 3-25: Tree view after opening the Master Files / Utilities subfolder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-22
Figure 3-26: Dialog box for displaying and maintaining tax tables. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-24
Figure 3-27: Add dialog box for creating a new tax table from an existing tax table . . . . . . . . . .3-26
Figure 3-28: Dialog box for confirming or cancelling the deletion of a tax table . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-27
Figure 3-29: Sample InstaPrint report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-28
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Figure 4-1: Previous View and Back View buttons for Adobe Reader and Acrobat . . . . . . . . . .4-14
Figure 4-2: Date box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-15
Figure 4-3: Examples of cleared and selected check boxes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-17
Figure 4-4: Option buttons for selecting Interim Period 1, 2, or 3 in a row . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-18
Figure 4-5: Options buttons for selecting one of the options under Record Type . . . . . . . . . . . .4-18
Figure 4-6: List box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-18
Figure 4-7: List box with options expanded after clicking the drop-down arrow . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-19
Figure 4-8: Add dialog box for the Absence Reasons (AR) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-21
Figure 4-9: Add dialog box for the Leave Groups (LG) master file (Leave Buckets tab). . . . . . .4-24
Figure 4-10: Service Years tab for the Leave Groups (LG) master file. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-25
Figure 4-11: Paystub Mapping Tab for the Leave Groups (LG) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-25
Figure 4-12: Add dialog box for the Absence Indices (AI) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-27
Figure 4-13: Add dialog box for the Absence FTE Codes (AF) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-29
Figure 4-14: Add dialog box for the Roll Codes (RO) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-31
--- continued on next page ---
Figures-2
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
List of Figures
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files - continued
Figure 4-15: Add dialog box for Accrual Rules master file (Page 1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-33
Figure 4-16: Add dialog box for Accrual Rules master file (Page 2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-34
Figure 4-17: Add dialog box for the Accrual Schedule (AS) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-36
Figure 4-18: Add dialog box for Absence Interface Rules master file (Global Site) . . . . . . . . . .4-38
Figure 4-19: Add dialog box for Absence Interface Rules master file (Global Leave Group) . . .4-40
Figure 4-20: Add dialog box for Absence Interface Rules master file (Site/Leave Groups). . . . .4-41
Figure 4-21: Add dialog box for the District Master (DP) master file. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-45
Figure 4-22: Add dialog: Add dialog box for the Locations (LOC) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-46
Figure 4-23: Add dialog box for the Location Org Level Fields (LO) master file . . . . . . . . . . . .4-49
Figure 4-24: Add dialog box for the Bargaining Units (BU) master file. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-50
Figure 4-25: Add dialog box for the Board Dates (BD) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-51
Figure 4-26: Add dialog box for the Certificate Level (CL) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-52
Figure 4-27: Add dialog box for the Certificate Type (CT) master file. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-54
Figure 4-28: Add dialog box for the Comments Types (CO) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-55
Figure 4-29: Add dialog box for the Contract Types (CN) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-56
Figure 4-30: Add dialog box for the Control Groups (CG) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-57
Figure 4-31: Add dialog box for the County/State Codes (CS) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-59
Figure 4-32: Add dialog box for the Credentials (CR) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-61
Figure 4-33: Add dialog box for the Credential Authorizations (CA) master file. . . . . . . . . . . . .4-62
Figure 4-34: Add dialog box for the Credential Renewal Codes (CW) master file. . . . . . . . . . . .4-64
Figure 4-35: Add dialog box for the Credential Subject Codes (CB) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-65
Figure 4-36: Add dialog box for the Credential Level Codes (CB) master file. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-66
Figure 4-37: Add dialog box for the Degree Type (DT) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-67
Figure 4-38: Add dialog box for the Employee Types (EM) master file. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-69
Figure 4-39: Add dialog box for the Ethnic Codes (ET) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-70
Figure 4-40: Add dialog box for the Experience Types (ET) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-71
Figure 4-41: Add dialog box for the Freeze Placement Reasons (FP) master file. . . . . . . . . . . . .4-73
Figure 4-42: Add dialog box for the Handicap (HA) master file. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-74
Figure 4-43: Add dialog box for the Hospital Codes (HO) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-75
Figure 4-44: Add dialog box for the Institutions (Colleges) (IN) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-77
Figure 4-45: Add dialog box for the Immunizations (IM) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-78
Figure 4-46: Add dialog box for the Inservice Ed Component (IE) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-79
Figure 4-47: Add dialog box for the Insurance Carrier (IC) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-81
Figure 4-48: Add dialog box for the Medical Codes (ME) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-82
Figure 4-49: Add dialog box for the Membership List (LM) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-83
Figure 4-50: Add dialog box for the Job Categories (JB) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-84
Figure 4-51: Code definition and Credentials/Education tab for the Job Codes (JC) master file .4-86
Figure 4-52: Subjects/Skills tab for the Job Codes (JC) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-87
Figure 4-53: Test Information/Experience tab for the Job Codes master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-87
Figure 4-54: Add dialog box for the Language Codes (LA) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-88
Figure 4-55: Add dialog box for the Program of Graduation (PG) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-89
--- continued on next page ---
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
Figures-3
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files - continued
Figure 4-56: Add dialog box for the Refusal Reason (RR) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-91
Figure 4-57: Add dialog box for the Report Codes (RC) master file. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-92
Figure 4-58: Add dialog box for the Seniority Class (SN) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-93
Figure 4-59: Add dialog box for the Sill Codes (SK) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-95
Figure 4-60: Add dialog box for the Subject Codes (SU) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-96
Figure 4-61: Add dialog box for the Termination Code (TE) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-98
Figure 4-62: Add dialog box for the Test Master Codes (TM) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-100
Figure 4-63: Add dialog box for the PAF Category (PA) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-101
Figure 4-64: Add dialog box for the PAF Actions (PF) master file. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-103
Figure 4-65: Add dialog box for the Pay Codes (PC) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-106
Figure 4-66: Add dialog box for the Payroll Name (PYN) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-107
Figure 4-67: Change dialog box for the Pay Schedules (PS) master file. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-109
Figure 4-68: Add dialog box for the Pay Types (PT) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-111
Figure 4-69: Add dialog box for the Retirement Systems (RS) master file. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-113
Figure 4-70: Change dialog box for the Retirement Edits (RE) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-114
Figure 4-71: Add dialog box for the Payroll Profiles (PP) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-116
Figure 4-72: Statutory Deduction Codes master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-118
Figure 4-73: Change dialog box for the Statutory Deduction Profiles (SP) master file . . . . . . .4-119
Figure 4-74: Change dialog box for the Deduction Schedule (DS) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-121
Figure 4-75: Add dialog box for the Deduction Rate Table (DR) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-123
Figure 4-76: Add dialog box for the Bonus Codes (BC) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-125
Figure 4-77: Add dialog box for the Payroll Edit Rules (PE) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-127
Figure 4-78: Add dialog box for the Deduction Rule Codes (PR) master file. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-128
Figure 4-79: Add dialog box for the SMF Status Codes (SM) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-129
Figure 4-80: Add dialog box for the Pending Retirement Status Codes (PN) master file . . . . . .4-131
Figure 4-81: Add dialog box for the Vol-Ded Frequency Codes (VD) master file . . . . . . . . . . .4-132
Figure 4-82: Add dialog box for the Voluntary Deductions (VD) master file. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-133
Figure 4-83: Add dialog box for the Benefit Controls (BC) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-135
Figure 4-84: Add dialog box for the Benefit Object Maps (OMAP) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-136
Figure 4-85: Add dialog box for the Health/Welfare Benefit Maps (VMAP) master file . . . . . .4-138
Figure 4-86: Add dialog box for the Benefit Group Maps (GMAP) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-139
Figure 4-87: Change dialog box for the Federal Income Tax (TT01) master file (EIC tab) . . . .4-142
Figure 4-88: Change dialog box for the Federal Income Tax (TT01) master file
(withholding tabs) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-144
Figure 4-89: Change dialog box for the Federal Income Tax (TT01) master file
(New EIC tab) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-145
Figure 4-90: Change dialog box for the OASDI/Medicare (TT03) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-147
Figure 4-91: Change dialog box for the Workers Compensation (TT05) master file . . . . . . . . .4-149
Figure 4-92: Change dialog box for the State Tax California (TT06) master file
(Tables 1/2, 3/4 tab) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-151
--- continued on next page ---
Figures-4
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
List of Figures
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files - continued
Figure 4-93: Change dialog box for the State Tax California (TT06) master file
(Method B tabs) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-153
Figure 4-94: Change dialog box for the SUI California (TT07) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-154
Figure 4-95: Change dialog box for the PERS California (TT08) master file. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-155
Figure 4-96: Change dialog box for the STRS California (TT09) master file. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-157
Figure 4-97: Change dialog box for the California Retirement Setup (TT10) master file . . . . .4-158
Figure 4-98: Add dialog box for the California State Disability Insurance (TT11) master file .4-160
Figure 4-99: Add dialog box for the Position Bonus Codes (PB) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-162
Figure 4-100: Add dialog box for the Benefit Projected Rate (BPR) master file . . . . . . . . . . . .4-164
Figure 4-101: Add mode for District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-166
Figure 4-102: Header information for the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file. . . .4-170
Figure 4-103: Description tab for the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file . . . . . . .4-170
Figure 4-104: Requirements 1 tab for the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file . . . .4-172
Figure 4-105: Requirements 2 tab for the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file . . . .4-173
Figure 4-106: Account Distribution tab for the District Authorized Positions (DAP)
master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-174
Figure 4-107: Benefits tab for the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file. . . . . . . . . .4-175
Figure 4-108: Employee List tab for the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file. . . . .4-176
Figure 4-109: Add mode for New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) master file . . . . . . . .4-177
Figure 4-110: Position Reports dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-180
Figure 4-111: Header information for the New District Authorized Positions (DAPN)
master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-181
Figure 4-112: Description tab for the New District Authorized Positions (DAPN)
master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-182
Figure 4-113: Requirements 1 tab for the New District Authorized Positions (DAPN)
master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-183
Figure 4-114: Requirements 2 tab for the New District Authorized Positions (DAPN)
master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-184
Figure 4-115: Account Distribution tab for the New District Authorized Positions (DAPN)
master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-185
Figure 4-116: Benefits tab for the New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) master file . . . .4-186
Figure 4-117: Employee List tab for the New District Authorized Positions (DAPN)
master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-187
Figure 4-118: Launch screen for the District Position Report (PCR400) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-188
Figure 4-119: Launch screen for Employee Position Report (PCR405) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-189
Figure 4-120: Launch window for the Abbreviated Position District Report (PCR420) . . . . . .4-190
Figure 4-121: Launch window for the Position-Account Report (PCR409) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-192
Figure 4-122: Dialog box for displaying and maintaining tax tables. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-195
Figure 4-123: Add dialog box for creating a new salary schedule from an existing one . . . . . .4-197
Figure 4-124: Dialog box for confirming or cancelling the deletion of a salary schedule . . . . .4-198
Figure 4-125: Sample InstaPrint report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-199
Figure 4-126: Header information for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN) master file . . . . . .4-200
--- continued on next page ---
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
Figures-5
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files - continued
Figure 4-127: Schedule Calculation Factors tab for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN)
master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-201
Figure 4-128: Payroll Interface tab for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN) master file. . . . . .4-202
Figure 4-129: Bonus Calculation Rules tab for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN)
master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-203
Figure 4-130: Steps and Ranges tab for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN) master file . . . . .4-204
Figure 4-131: Commands used only on the Steps and Ranges tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-204
Figure 4-132: Benefits tab for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN) master file . . . . . . . . . . . .4-207
Figure 4-133: Change Work Calendars dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-210
Figure 4-134: View Work Calendars dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-211
Figure 4-135: Button for modifying the days in a monthly calendar. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-212
Figure 4-136: Button for modifying the days in a monthly calendar. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-213
Figure 4-137: Legend area after clicking Paid Holiday (PH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-213
Figure 4-138: Mouse pointer hovered over August 23 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-214
Figure 4-139: Calendar after clicking August 23. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-214
Figure 4-140: Add dialog box for the Pay Code Links (FL01) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-216
Figure 4-141: Add dialog box for the Voluntary Deduction Code Links (FL02) master file . . .4-217
Figure 4-142: Add dialog box for the Vol-Ded Frequency Code Links (FL03) master file . . . .4-218
Figure 4-143: Add dialog box for the Pay Schedule Code Links (FL04) master file . . . . . . . . .4-219
Figure 4-144: Add dialog box for the Stat Ded Profile Code Links (FL05) master file . . . . . . .4-220
Figure 4-145: Add dialog box for the Deduction Schedule Code Links (FL06) master file . . . .4-221
Figure 4-146: Add dialog box for the Coverage Level Codes (BMLC) master file . . . . . . . . . .4-223
Figure 4-147: Add dialog box for the Deduction Class List (BMCL) master file . . . . . . . . . . . .4-226
Figure 4-148: Add dialog box for the Dependent Codes (BMDC) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-227
Figure 4-149: Change dialog box for the FTE Allocation Table (BMFT) master file . . . . . . . .4-229
Figure 4-150: Add dialog box for the Package Codes (BMPK) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-234
Figure 4-151: Add dialog box for the Plan Codes (BMPC) master file. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-237
Figure 4-152: Add dialog box for the Plan/Level Amounts (BMPL) master file . . . . . . . . . . . .4-240
Figure 4-153: Change dialog box for the Cap Amounts (BMCA) master file. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-242
Figure 4-154: Add dialog box for the Benefit Status Codes (BMBS) master file . . . . . . . . . . . .4-243
Figure 4-155: Add dialog box for the Package Assignment (BMPA) master file . . . . . . . . . . . .4-244
Figure 4-156: Add dialog box for the District Master File (RTDI) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-247
Figure 4-157: Add dialog box for the Accumulator Limits (RTAL) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-249
Figure 4-158: Add dialog box for the STRS Rates (RTST) master file. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-250
Figure 4-159: Add dialog box for the PERS Rates (RTPE) master file. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-251
Figure 4-160: Add dialog box for the Pay Schedule Controls (RTPS) master file . . . . . . . . . . .4-253
Figure 4-161: Add dialog box for the District Master File by Group (RTDG) master file . . . . .4-255
Figure 4-162: Add dialog box for the PERS Rates by Group (RTGP) master file . . . . . . . . . . .4-257
Figures-6
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
List of Figures
Chapter A: Common Elements in QCC Windows
Figure A-1: Grid for QCC applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-2
Figure A-2: Unavailable, available, and active boxes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-6
Figure A-3: Drop-down list box. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-6
Figure A-4: Drop-down list box with options expanded after clicking the drop-down arrow . . . A-6
Figure A-5: Check boxes for yes (checked) or no (unchecked) options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-8
Figure A-6: Option buttons for selecting Interim Period 1, 2, or 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-8
Figure A-7: Date box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-9
Figure A-8: : About dialog box for the About command on the Help menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-11
Figure A-9: Tab bar for the About dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-13
Figure A-10: Program Info tab for the About dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-13
Figure A-11: Package information for QCC on the Package Info tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-15
Figure A-12: USERSEC tab for the About dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-16
Figure A-13: User Security window for the Security command on the Help menu . . . . . . . . . . A-17
Figure A-14: Columns in the grid for the User Security window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-18
Chapter B: QSSInstaPrint Window
Figure B-1: QSSInstaPrint window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-2
Figure B-2: Options menu and toolbar for the Grid Output window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-3
Figure B-3: Save As dialog box for making a text file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-5
Figure B-4: Excel worksheet with entire report line in Column A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-7
Figure B-5: Save As dialog box dialog box for Excel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-7
Figure B-6: Text Import Wizard step for choosing original data type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-9
Figure B-7: Wizard for dividing up the report line into spreadsheet columns. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-10
Figure B-8: Wizard for defining the data format for each column of the spreadsheet . . . . . . . . B-10
Figure B-9: Microsoft Excel window with data imported into columns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-11
Figure B-10: Save As dialog box dialog box for Excel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-12
Figure B-11: Save As dialog box dialog box for Word . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-13
Figure B-12: Create PDF dialog box for making a PDF file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-14
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
Figures-7
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Figures-8
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
List of Tables
Chapter 2: HR Code Maintenance Window
Table 2-1: Quick start guide for the HR Code Maintenance window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2
Table 2-2: Option menu and toolbar commands for the HR Code Maintenance window . 2-7
Chapter 3: HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
Table 3-1: Quick start guide for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2
Table 3-2: Option menu and toolbar commands for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window 3-7
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-1: Master files by folder on tree view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4
Table 4-2: Master files by name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7
Table 4-3: Master files by code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10
Table 4-4: Sample master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13
Table 4-5: Master files in the Absence Tracking folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-21
Table 4-6: Absence Reasons (AR) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22
Table 4-7: Leave Groups (LG) master file (Leave Buckets tab) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23
Table 4-8: Leave Groups (LG) master file (Service Years tab) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25
Table 4-9: Leave Groups (LG) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-26
Table 4-10: Absence Indices (AI) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27
Table 4-11: Absence FTE Codes (AF) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30
Table 4-12: Roll Codes (RO) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31
Table 4-13: Accrual Rules (AC) master file (Page 1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32
Table 4-14: Accrual Rules (AC) master file (Page 2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34
Table 4-15: Accrual Schedule (AS) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-36
Table 4-16: Absence Interface Rules (IR) master file (Global Site) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-39
Table 4-17: Absence Interface Rules (IR) master file (Global Site) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40
Table 4-18: Absence Interface Rules (IR) master file (Site/Leave Group) . . . . . . . . . . . 4-41
Table 4-19: Personnel master files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-43
Table 4-20: District Master (DP) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-45
Table 4-21: Locations (LOC) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-47
Table 4-22: Location Org Level Fields (LO) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-49
Table 4-23: Bargaining Units (BU) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-50
Table 4-24: Board Dates (BD) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-52
Table 4-25: Certificate Level (CL) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53
Table 4-26: Certificate Type (CT) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-54
Table 4-27: Comments Types (CO) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-56
Table 4-28: Contract Types (CN) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-57
Table 4-29: Control Groups (CG) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-58
Table 4-30: County/State Codes (CS) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-59
Table 4-31: Credentials (CR) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-62
Table 4-32: Credential Authorizations (CA) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-63
Table 4-33: Credential Renewal Codes (CW) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-64
Table 4-34: Credential Subject Codes (CB) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-66
Table 4-35: Credential Level Codes (CB) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-67
--- continued on next page ---
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
Tables-1
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files - continued
Table 4-36: Degree Type (DT) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-68
Table 4-37: Employee Types (EM) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-69
Table 4-38: Ethnic Codes (ET) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-71
Table 4-39: Experience Types (ET) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-72
Table 4-40: Freeze Placement Reasons (FP) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-73
Table 4-41: Handicap (HA) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-74
Table 4-42: Hospital Codes (HO) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-76
Table 4-43: Institutions (Colleges) (IN) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-77
Table 4-44: Immunizations (IM) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-79
Table 4-45: Inservice Ed Component (IE) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-80
Table 4-46: Insurance Carrier (IC) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-81
Table 4-47: Medical Codes (ME) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-82
Table 4-48: Membership List (LM) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-84
Table 4-49: Job Categories (JB) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-85
Table 4-50: Job Codes (JC) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-86
Table 4-51: Job Codes (JC) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-87
Table 4-52: Job Codes (JC) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-88
Table 4-53: Language Codes (LA) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-89
Table 4-54: Program of Graduation (PG) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-90
Table 4-55: Refusal Reason (RR) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-91
Table 4-56: Report Codes (RC) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-93
Table 4-57: Seniority Class (SN) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-94
Table 4-58: Skill Codes (SK) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-95
Table 4-59: Subject Codes (SU) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-97
Table 4-60: Termination Code (TE) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-98
Table 4-61: Test Master Codes (TM) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-100
Table 4-62: PAF Category (PA) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-102
Table 4-63: PAF Actions (PF) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-103
Table 4-64: Master files for the Payroll folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-105
Table 4-65: Pay Codes (PC) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-106
Table 4-66: Payroll Name (PYN) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-108
Table 4-67: Pay Schedules (PS) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-110
Table 4-68: Pay Types (PT) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-112
Table 4-69: Retirement Systems (RS) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-113
Table 4-70: Retirement Edits (RE) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-115
Table 4-71: Payroll Profiles (PP) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-116
Table 4-72: Statutory Deduction Profiles (SP) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-119
Table 4-73: Deduction Schedule (DS) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-122
Table 4-74: Deduction Rate Table (DR) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-123
Table 4-75: Bonus Codes (BC) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-125
Table 4-76: Payroll Edit Rules (PE) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-127
Table 4-77: Deduction Rule Codes (PR) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-129
Table 4-78: SMF Status Codes (SM) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-130
Table 4-79: Pending Retirement Status Codes (PN) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-131
Table 4-80: Vol-Ded Frequency Codes (VD) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-133
Table 4-81: Voluntary Deductions (VD) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-134
Table 4-82: Benefit Controls (BC) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-136
--- continued on next page ---
Tables-2
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files - continued
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files - continued
Table 4-83: Benefit Object Maps (OMAP) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-137
Table 4-84: Health/Welfare Benefit Maps (VMAP) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-138
Table 4-85: Benefit Group Maps (GMAP) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-140
Table 4-86: Master files for the Position Control folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-140
Table 4-87: Federal Income Tax (TT01) master file (EIC tab) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-143
Table 4-88: Federal Income Tax (TT01) master file (withholding tabs) . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-143
Table 4-89: Federal Income Tax (TT01) master file (new EIC tab) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-145
Table 4-90: OASDI/Medicare (TT03) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-148
Table 4-91: Workers Compensation (TT05) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-149
Table 4-92: State Tax California (TT06) master file (Tables 1/2, 3/4 tab) . . . . . . . . . . . 4-151
Table 4-93: State Tax California (TT06) master file (Method B tabs) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-153
Table 4-94: SUI California (TT07) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-154
Table 4-95: PERS California (TT08) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-156
Table 4-96: STRS California (TT09) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-157
Table 4-97: California Retirement Setup (TT10) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-159
Table 4-98: California State Disability Insurance (TT11) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-160
Table 4-99: Master files for the Position Control folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-161
Table 4-100: Position Bonus Codes (PB) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-163
Table 4-101: Benefit Projected Rate (BPR) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-165
Table 4-102: Header information for the District Authorized Positions (DAP)
master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-170
Table 4-103: Description for the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file . . . . 4-170
Table 4-104: for the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-172
Table 4-105: Requirements 2 tab for the District Authorized Positions (DAP)
master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-173
Table 4-106: Account Distribution tab for the District Authorized Positions (DAP)
master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-174
Table 4-107: Benefits tab for the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file . . . . 4-175
Table 4-108: Employee List tab for the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master
file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-176
Table 4-109: Header information for the New District Authorized Positions (DAPN)
master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-181
Table 4-110: Description for the New District Authorized Positions (DAPN)
master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-182
Table 4-111: Requirements 1 tab for the New District Authorized Positions (DAPN)
master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-184
Table 4-112: Requirements 2 tab for the New District Authorized Positions (DAPN)
master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-185
Table 4-113: Account Distribution tab for the New District Authorized Positions
(DAPN) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-186
Table 4-114: Benefits tab for the New District Authorized Positions (DAPN)
master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-186
Table 4-115: Employee List tab for the New District Authorized Positions (DAPN)
master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-187
Table 4-116: Launch window for the District Position Report (PCR400) . . . . . . . . . . . 4-188
Table 4-117: Launch window for the Employee Position Report (PCR405) . . . . . . . . . 4-189
Table 4-118: Launch window for the Abbreviated District Position Report (PCR420) . 4-191
--- continued on next page ---
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
Tables-3
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files - continued
Table 4-119: Launch window for the Position-Account Report (PCR409) . . . . . . . . . . 4-192
Table 4-120: Header information for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN) master file 4-200
Table 4-121: Schedule Calculation factors tab for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN)
master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-200
Table 4-122: Payroll Interface Rules tab for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN)
master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-202
Table 4-123: Bonus Calculation Rules tab for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN)
master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-202
Table 4-124: Steps and Ranges tab for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN) master file 4-204
Table 4-125: Benefits tab for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN) master file . . . . . . . 4-206
Table 4-126: Work Calendars (WC) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-209
Table 4-127: Master files in the Master File Links folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-216
Table 4-128: Pay Code Links (FL01) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-217
Table 4-129: Voluntary Deduction Code Links (FL02) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-218
Table 4-130: Vol-Ded Frequency Code Links (FL03) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-218
Table 4-131: Pay Schedule Code Links (FL04) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-219
Table 4-132: Stat Ded Profile Code Links (FL05) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-220
Table 4-133: Deduction Schedule Code Links (FL06) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-221
Table 4-134: Master files in the Benefits Management folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-223
Table 4-135: Coverage Level Codes (BMLC) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-224
Table 4-136: Deduction Class List (BMCL) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-226
Table 4-137: Dependent Codes (BMDC) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-228
Table 4-138: FTE Allocation Table (BMFT) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-230
Table 4-139: Package Codes (BMPK) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-234
Table 4-140: Plan Codes (BMPC) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-237
Table 4-141: Plan/Level Amounts (BMPL) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-240
Table 4-142: Cap Amounts (BMCA) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-242
Table 4-143: Benefit Status Codes (BMBS) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-244
Table 4-144: Package Assignment (BMPA) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-245
Table 4-145: Master files in the Retirement - CA folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-246
Table 4-146: District Master File (RTDI) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-247
Table 4-147: Accumulator Limits (RTAL) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-249
Table 4-148: STRS Rates (RTST) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-250
Table 4-149: PERS Rates (RTPE) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-252
Table 4-150: Pay Schedule Controls (RTPS) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-254
Table 4-151: District Master File by Group (RTDG) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-255
Table 4-152: PERS Rates by Group (RTGP) master file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-257
Chapter A: Common Elements in QCC Windows
Table A-1: Keyboard shortcuts for moving through the grid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-4
Chapter B: QSSInstaPrint Window
Table B-1: Parts of the QSSInstaPrint window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-2
Table B-2: Menu bar and toolbar commands for the QSSInstaPrint window . . . . . . . . . . B-4
Table B-3: Commands for the PDF dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-15
Tables-4
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Chapter 1:
Introduction
Chapter Contents
Manual Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-2
Relation to Other Manuals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-3
Objectives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-3
How to Use this Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-5
Audience and Knowledge Assumed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-6
Related Documentation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-7
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
1-1
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 1: Introduction
Manual Overview
The Human Resources Master Files Manual tells how to use the HR Code Maintenance window and HR Master Code Maintenance 2 window to maintain the master
files for the following Human Resources systems: Absence Tracking, Personnel, Payroll, Position Control, Benefits Management, and Retirement. This manual discusses
the mechanics of how to use the HR Code Maintenance window and the HR Master
Code Maintenance 2 window, but not the specifics when to create master files and the
specific content for them.
Chapter 1: Introduction
Chapter 1 defines the purpose of the manual and provides a high-level overview of
the topics covered in each chapter. It also describes how to use this manual and points
to related resources in the suite of QSS/OASIS documentation.
Chapter 2: HR Code Maintenance Window
Chapter 2 provides instructions for the HR Code Maintenance window that you use
for maintaining almost all of the master files. It describes the parts of the window and
provides instructions on adding, changing, inspecting, and deleting records.
Chapter 3: HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
Chapter 3 provides instructions for the HR Master Code Maintenance 2 window that
you use for maintaining tax tables for the Payroll System, as well as salary schedules
and positions for Position Control. It describes the parts of the window and provides
instructions on adding, changing, inspecting, and deleting records.
Chapter 4: Maintaining Master Files
Chapter 4 provides instructions for maintaining the master file. It provides the
following:
♦ Lists of master files by their order in the tree view, name, and abbreviations.
♦ Instructions for selecting the HR Code Maintenance window from the QSS ControlCenter window
♦ Instructions for adding, changing, deleting, and inspecting master file records
♦ Instructions for creating master file reports and a sample of each master file
♦ A description of the kind of data to fill in for each box in a master file maintenance
window, such as a number, text, or date
1-2
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Relation to Other Manuals
Appendix A: Common Elements in QCC Windows
Appendix A: Common Elements in QCC Windows
Appendix A describes the following elements that are in most QCC window: the grid,
how to fill in boxes in tabs, and the Help menu.
Appendix B: QSSInstaPrint Window
Appendix B describes how to use the QSS InstaPrint window to create InstaPrint
reports of tax tables.
Relation to Other Manuals
The Human Resources Master Files Manual complements manuals for specific
systems.
♦ The Human Resources Master Files Manual describes the mechanics of how to
maintain master files on the HR Code Maintenance window and HR Master Code
Maintenance 2 window. For example, the description of the Pay Codes master file
in this manual simply states that a pay code has a 2-digit key, a 30-character name,,
and an 8-character abbreviation.
♦ The manuals for each system describe the purpose of a master file and how to
select the specific values to type in each box. For example, the instructions for the
Payroll System would describe the purpose of the Pay Codes master file and provide guidance in how to select pay codes that work best for your site.
Objectives
The Human Resources Master Files Manual tells how to do the following:
♦ Open the HR Code Maintenance window from the QSS ControlCenter window.
♦ Understand the parts of the HR Code Maintenance window, such as the menu bar,
toolbar, tree view, and pane for displaying master files.
♦ Use the commands for maintaining master files from the menu bar, toolbar, and
keyboard shortcuts.
♦ Use the tree view to display a list of master files that are available and identify
whether you have read, write, or no access to a particular master file.
♦ Select a master file from the tree view.
♦ Display master file records in the grid and use the filter to select a subset for the
master file.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
1-3
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 1: Introduction
♦ Add, change, delete, and inspect codes in a master file.
♦ For each master file, describe the dialog box for adding, changing, inspecting, and
deleting records.
♦ Describe the following for each box to fill in for a master file:
◊ Name
◊ Status of required or optional
◊ Type of data, such as text, number, date, or check box
◊ For text and numeric fields, the length of the field and any special rules for formatting, such as upshifting or implied decimal places
This manual does not provide detailed description of the content of the box. For
example, the Pay Schedules master file has an Hours box in which you can type
up to 999.99 hours. It is up to the instructions for payroll to explain when to use
this box and how to determine the number of hours to type.
♦ For each master file, describe the process for creating a report and provide a sample report.
♦ Provide general instructions for using the GUI interface in QCC, such as sorting
columns, filling in date fields, and selecting an item from a list box.
1-4
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
How to Use this Manual
Locating Master Files
How to Use this Manual
Locating Master Files
Chapter 4 provides samples for the master files that you can maintain with the HR
Code Maintenance and HR Code Maintenance 2 windows. The tables at the start of
the chapter allow you to locate the desired master file.
♦ Table 4-1 on page 4-4 lists the master files as they are organized in the tree view
for the code maintenance windows.
♦ Table 4-2 on page 4-7 lists the master files by name.
♦ Table 4-3 on page 4-10 lists the master files by their code.
The instructions for each master file includes the following:
♦ A sample of the dialog box for maintaining the master file and a description of the
kind of information to type in each box.
♦ Pointers to instructions for maintaining the master file.
♦ A sample report.
Detailed Instructions for Master File Window
There are two windows for maintaining master files: the HR Code Maintenance window and HR Master Code Maintenance 2 window.
♦ The HR Code Maintenance window allows you to maintain most of the master
files. Chapter 2 provides detailed instructions for using this window.
♦ The HR Master Code Maintenance 2 window allows you to maintain the
following:
◊ Tax tables for Payroll.
◊ Salary schedules and positions for Position Control.
Chapter 3 provides detailed instructions for using this window.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
1-5
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 1: Introduction
Audience and Knowledge Assumed
The instructions in this manual do not require any specific knowledge of individual
parts of QSS/OASIS, such as the Payroll System or Personnel System. Instead, the
instructions focus on the mechanics of using the HR Code Maintenance window.
This document assumes that you can do basic tasks on a PC, such as the following:
♦ Turning on the computer and starting Windows.
♦ Logging in to the network at your site. This procedure can vary from site to site.
See your system administrator for any questions about logging in or your
password.
♦ Logging in to QCC and using the QSS ControlCenter window to select the
QSS/OASIS module that you want to run.
♦ Opening and closing windows on the Windows desktop.
♦ Typing text in boxes, selecting items from lists, selecting and clearing check
boxes, filling in date boxes, and other such tasks for filling in tabs for QSS/OASIS
modules.
♦ Switching among windows on the Windows desktop with the mouse and keyboard
shortcuts.
♦ Navigating through windows and dialog boxes with the TAB key, mouse clicks,
and other standard Windows keys.
If you are not sure of how to do these tasks, consult the following resources.
♦ See Appendix A for detailed instructions on using the mouse, resizing windows,
using the grid, filling in boxes, selecting dates, and selecting check boxes and
option buttons.
♦ See the QSS ControlCenter Guide for instructions on logging on to QCC and
launching QCC applications from the Go menu. This document is available from
the Help menu in the QSS ControlCenter window.
1-6
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Related Documentation
Help Files for QCC
Related Documentation
This discussion points out the following additional sources for information about QSS
ControlCenter (QCC):
♦ Help Files for QCC
♦ Additional Resources for System Administrators
Help Files for QCC
This discussion focuses on the following areas:
♦ Viewing Help Files from QCC
♦ QSS ControlCenter Guide
♦ Printing Reports with Print Manager with Print Manager
Viewing Help Files from QCC
The Help menu on the QSS ControlCenter window allows you to have access to this
document, as well as other manuals for QCC. The documents are in .pdf format, and
your PC must have Adobe Reader 5.0 or later installed to open these files.
To view documentation for QCC:
1 From the menu bar on the QSS ControlCenter window, point to Help then select
QSS Latest Migration Information.
2 Click the link to Migration Documentation and Training Guides.
3 Click the manual that you want to view.
Two of the manuals on this list provide the basic instructions for using QCC: QSS
ControlCenter Guide and Printing Reports with Print Manager.
QSS ControlCenter Guide
The QSS ControlCenter Guide is the basic guide for how to use QCC. This guide tells
how to do the following:
♦ Log on to QCC.
♦ Open QCC application windows from the menus on the QSS ControlCenter
window.
♦ Switch from one application window to another.
♦ Log off from QCC.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
1-7
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 1: Introduction
Printing Reports with Print Manager
Printing Reports with Print Manager tells how to use the Print Manager window to
manage and print financial reports for the core financial applications in QSS/OASIS.
This window allows you to do the following:
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
List reports by date, job number, program title, and report title.
View the $STDLISTs for creating reports.
Open up to 9 report windows with resizable fonts and full-text search.
Print reports to a Windows printer.
Route reports to a system printer on the HP e3000.
Export reports to Word, Excel, a PDF file, or a plain text file.
Additional Resources for System Administrators
This heading describes additional resources that system administrators can use for
setting up application security for QCC. It looks at the following areas:
♦ Gaining Access to Help Files
♦ System Security and Session Administration for QCC
♦ Module, Task, and User Security for QCC
Gaining Access to Help Files
The Support area of the QSS Web site allows access to additional materials that are
designed for system administrators. To view these materials, you need the user name
and password for your site. The Support area provides access to release notes and system administration guides, including System Security and Session Administration for
QCC and Module, Task, and User Security for QCC.
System Security and Session Administration for QCC
System Security and Session Administration is the reference guide for setting up and
managing QCC at your site.
♦ The System Security window allows you to set up QCC users and define two kinds
of application security. Module and task security allows you to define the modules
(windows) that members of each QCC user class can open from the QSS ControlCenter window and Job Menu window. User security allows you to customize how
QCC windows work for individual QCC users.
♦ The Session Administration window allows you to see what GUI users are logged
in, what applications are running, and view a log of logon and logoff events.
1-8
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Related Documentation
Additional Resources for System Administrators
Module, Task, and User Security for QCC
Module, Task, and User Security for QCC contains the technical notes for QCC applications. It describes the set-up options that allow you to define the GUI modules to
which each GUI user has access.
♦ Module and task security allows you to define the QCC modules that members of
each user class can open from the QSS ControlCenter window and Job Menu
windows. Each QCC user is assigned to one or more user classes and inherits its
module and task security from them.
♦ User security allows you to customize QCC modules for individual users. For
example, the user security for the Journal Entry (FI02JE) tab on the GL Application window determines whether a a GUI user can add, change, delete, or inspect
journals. User security is linked to the server user that is associated with each QCC
user.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
1-9
Human Resources Master Files Manual
1-10
Chapter 1: Introduction
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Chapter 2:
HR Code Maintenance
Window
Chapter Contents
Description of the HR Code Maintenance Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-3
Title Bar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-3
Menu Bar and Toolbar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4
Message Bar. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-8
Tree View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-8
Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-13
Grid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-19
Status Bar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-20
Opening the Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-21
Maintaining and Reporting Master File Records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-23
Inspecting Records (Inspect Command) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-23
Changing and Deleting Records (Change Command) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-25
Adding and Importing Records (Add New Command and Add New
[No Preload] Command) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-27
Launching a Report (Create Report Command) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-29
Add/Import Multiple Records. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-30
Importing Multiple Records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-30
Data Formats for Master Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-32
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
2-1
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 2: HR Code Maintenance Window
Table 2-1: Quick start guide for the HR Code Maintenance window
TOPIC
TELLS HOW TO
PAGE
Description of the HR Code
Maintenance Window
Identify the parts of the HR Code Maintenance window.
2-3
• Title Bar
Read the name and district number in the title bar.
2-3
• Menu Bar and Toolbar
Use the commands on the menu bar and toolbar for customizing the
window, the tree view, and maintaining master files. The Options menu
and toolbar have the same commands for maintaining master files.
Almost every command also has a keyboard shortcut.
2-4
• Message Bar
Read the messages that display in the message bar and interpret the
mode indicator.
2-8
• Tree View
Use the tree view to do the following:
2-8
• Display the list of master files in the tree view.
• Determine whether you have read, change, or list-only access to a
master file.
• Select a master file for displaying in the grid.
• Filter
Restrict the master file records displayed in the grid by specifying one or
more of the following: a name, a code, or a range of codes.
2-13
• Grid
Maintain records in the master file displayed in the grids. Your user
security can allow you to do the following: add, change, delete, inspect,
and create a report of codes.
2-19
• Status Bar
The district, year, site, and current date and time.
2-20
Opening the Window
Open HR Code Maintenance window from QCC.
2-21
Maintaining and Reporting
Master File Records
Use the HR Code Maintenance window to create and maintain master
files.
2-23
• Inspecting Records
Use the Inspect command to a View dialog box for displaying master file
records to which you have Read or Write access.
2-23
• Changing and Deleting
Records
Use the Change command to open a Change dialog that allows you to
change or delete records in a master file to which you have Write
access.
2-25
• Adding and Importing
Records
Use the Add New command to open an Add window an Add dialog box
for adding new records to a master file to which you have write access.
2-27
• Launching a Report
Use the Create Report command create a report of master files to
which you have Read or Write access or Locked master files.
2-29
Add/Import Multiple Records
Import records into a master file from the Windows clipboard or a tabdelimited file.
2-30
• Importing Multiple Records
Use the Grid Import dialog box to import records.
2-30
• Data Formats for Master
Files
Identify the format for importing records into a master file.
2-32
2-2
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Description of the HR Code Maintenance Window
Title Bar
Description of the HR Code Maintenance
Window
Title bar
Menu bar
Toolbar
Message bar
Filter
Tree view
Grid
Status bar
Figure 2-1: HR Code Maintenance window
Figure 2-1 illustrates the parts of the HR Code Maintenance window. This window
allows you to maintain most master files for the following Human Resources (HR)
software systems:
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
Absence Tracking
Benefits Management
Payroll
Personnel
Position Control
Retirement for California
The tree view includes only the master files to which you have access. The samples in
this chapter list all available master files; however, your user security defines the master files that you can use.
Title Bar
1
2
3
4
Figure 2-2: Title bar for the HR Code Maintenance window
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
2-3
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 2: HR Code Maintenance Window
The title bar includes the following:
1 Icon and name for the window.
2 District number and name for which you are maintaining master files.
3 The QSS/OASIS product name.
4 The standard Minimize, Maximize, and Close buttons for the Windows desktop.
Menu Bar and Toolbar
Figure 2-3: Menu bar and toolbar for the HR Code Maintenance window
File Menu
Figure 2-4:: File menu for the HR Code Maintenance window
Show Status Command
The Show Status command opens a QSS Personnel dialog box that contains a log of
commands executed on the server by the HR Code Maintenance window. This information is normally of interest only to software developers and support staff.
Figure 2-5: QSS Personnel dialog box for the Show Status command
2-4
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Description of the HR Code Maintenance Window
Menu Bar and Toolbar
Take any of the following actions while viewing the QSS Personnel dialog box.
♦ Click the [Clear] button to clear the contents of the log.
♦ Click the [Print Screen] button to print the contents of the dialog box to the default
windows printer for your PC.
♦ Press ALT+F4 to close the dialog box.
Clear Settings on Exit Command
Select this command to clear any custom settings when you close the HR Code Maintenance window. Normally, the window retains settings, such as window size and the
branches of the tree that are open if you check the Preserve Expanded Branches
command on the View menu.
Exit Command
Select the Exit command to close the HR Code Maintenance window.
View Menu
Figure 2-6: View menu for the HR Code Maintenance window
Options for Expanded and Collapsed Branches at Start-Up
The Expand Tree on Startup and Preserve Expanded Branches commands control
how the tree view looks when you open the HR Code Maintenance window.
♦ Check the Expand Tree on Startup command to expand all branches of the tree
view when you open the HR Code Maintenance window. Thus, you can see all
master files that are available.
♦ Check the Preserve Expanded Branches command to have the system keep track
of which branches are expanded and collapsed when you close the HR Code Maintenance window. The next time you open the window, the same branches are
opened and closed.
Options for Expanding Collapsing During a Session
♦ Select the Expand All Branches command to expand all branches of the tree view
so you can see all of the master files to which you have access.
♦ Select the Collapse All Branches to close all individual master files, leaving only
the nodes for categories of master files.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
2-5
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 2: HR Code Maintenance Window
These two commands are also available on the toolbar.
Options Menu and Toolbar
Figure 2-7: Options menu, View menu, and toolbar commands for the HR Code Maintenance window
The Options menu and toolbar contain the commands for selecting and maintaining
master files. Figure 2-7 illustrates the relation of the commands on the Options menu
and toolbar. The commands are in the same order in both places. Also, the toolbar
contains the Expand All Branches and Collapse All Branches commands from the
View menu.
Help Menu
Figure 2-8: Help menu for the HR Code Maintenance window
The Help menu displays the About dialog box. Your support staff may ask you to use
the About box to get information about the version of QCC that you are using. For
details, see page A-11.
2-6
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Description of the HR Code Maintenance Window
Menu Bar and Toolbar
Table 2-2: Option menu and toolbar commands for the HR Code Maintenance window
COMMAND
KEYBOARD
PURPOSE
Save
F9
Save the new or changed master file records.
Retrieve Data
F2
There are two uses for this command.
• If the Auto Select command is not checked, use this command to
make the grid display the master file selected in the tree view.
• After filling in the filter, use this command to make the grid display
only the master file records that match the selection in the filter.
Expand All
Branches
Ctrl+E
Expand all branches of the tree view so that you can see all available
master files.
Collapse All
Branches
Ctrl+O
Collapse the tree view down to the folders for each category of master files.
Inspect
Ctrl+F5
Open a View dialog box so that you can view master file records.
This command is available only for master files to which you have
Read or Write access.
Change
Ctrl+F9
Open a Change dialog box that allows you to change or delete master file records. This command is available only for master files to
which you have Write access.
Add New
Ctrl+F6
Open an Add dialog box that allows you to add master file records by
filling in the form or using the Grid Import window. For simple master
files, the Add dialog box displays the selected record from the grid as
a starting point for adding the first new record. This command is
available only for master files to which you have Write access.
Add New No
Preload
Shift+F6
Open an Add dialog box without any boxes pre-loaded with the current record in the grid. This command is available only for master
files to which you have Write access.
Auto Select
Ctrl+A
Click the icon to toggle between checked and unchecked. When it is
checked, the master file in the grid changes every time you click a
master file in the tree view. When it is unchecked, you must use the
Retrieve Data command to display a master file in the grid.
Create Report
Ctrl+R
Create a report of the master file that displays in the grid. This command is available for master files with Read, Write, or Locked
access.
Clear Filter
F4
Clear the selections in the filter. If you want the grid to display all
master file records again, use the Retrieve Data command.
Grid Output
Shift+F11
Open a Grid Output window that allows you to export the contents of
the grid to Excel, Word, PDF, or a delimited text file. For instructions,
see Appendix D of the QCC Core Financial Manual.
Print Screen
F11
Print the HR Code Maintenance window on the default Windows
printer for your PC.
01/10
ICON
Copyright © QSS, 2010
2-7
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 2: HR Code Maintenance Window
Message Bar
2
1
Figure 2-9: Message bar for the HR Code Maintenance window
1 Message pane
The message pane displays various messages, such as "Master file is read only" or
"You do not have access to view this master file."
2 Mode indicator
The Mode indicator is always Inspect because the grid allows you to look at master
file codes, but not change them.
The background color indicates the fiscal years. The standard colors are red for a
prior year, green for the current year, and blue for a future year. Your site can use
different colors.
Tree View
s
Figure 2-10: Tree view for the HR Code Maintenance window
The discussion of the tree view focuses on the following areas:
♦ Purpose
♦ Expanding and Collapsing Folders
2-8
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Description of the HR Code Maintenance Window
Tree View
♦ Displaying a Master File in the Grid
♦ Access Levels and Types of Master Files
Purpose
The tree view displays the master files that you can display and maintain. It allows
you to do the following:
♦ Expand and collapse folders to reveal or hide master files.
♦ Select the master file for which to add, change, delete, or inspect codes and for
which to create a report.
The samples in this chapter include all available master files. However, your tree view
lists only the master files that your user security allows access to.
Expanding and Collapsing Folders
Master files are organized into folders that are collapsed (closed) or expanded (open).
Figure 2-11 illustrates what the tree view looks like with all folders collapsed. Each
main folder represents a category of master files, such as Absence Tracking or Position Control.
Figure 2-11: Tree view with all folders collapsed (closed)
♦ A + to the left of the folder indicates a collapsed folder. You can expand it to reveal
the master files under it.
♦ A - to the left of the folder indicates an expanded folder. You can collapse it to hide
its master files.
If you do not have access to any master files in a folder, there is no + or - next to it.
Figure 2-11 illustrates a case where a QCC user does not have access to any Position
Control master files. The folder does not expand when you click it.
To change a folder from expanded to collapsed or collapsed to expanded:
♦ Single-clicking the + or - to the left of the folder.
♦ Double-clicking the folder name.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
2-9
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 2: HR Code Maintenance Window
Clicking a collapsed folder opens
it to reveal master files and
subfolders.
The Retirement - CA
folder contains master files
and a subfolder with its
own list of master files.
A folder can contain subfolders
with subcategories of master
files. You can expand or collapse
subfolders independently of the
main folder.
Figure 2-12: Tree view with Retirement - CA folder expanded
Figure 2-12 illustrates the results of double-clicking the Retirement - CA folder. This
example illustrates how a folder opens up to display a list of master files. A folder can
also contain subfolders, such as the Retirement Group Files folder.
To expand or collapse all folders:
♦ Click the
(Expand All Branches [Ctrl+E]) icon to expand all folders.
♦ Click the
(Collapse All Branches [Ctrl+O]) icon to collapse all folders.
To decide how folders look when you open the HR Code Maintenance window, do
either of the following:
♦ In the View menu, click the Expand Tree on Startup command to expand all
folders when you open the HR Code Maintenance window.
♦ In the View menu, click the Preserve Expanded Branches to have the system
remember the tree view when you close the HR Code Maintenance window. The
next time you open the window, the tree view looks the same.
HINT: To tell which command is active, click at the View menu. There is a check mark to the
left of the selected command. Once you check one of these commands, the other is
dimmed.
Displaying a Master File in the Grid
There are two procedures for displaying a master file on the grid, depending on
whether you have checked the
(Auto Select [Ctrl+A]) icon. Each time you click
the icon, it alternates between checked and not checked.
♦ If you have not checked the
(Auto Select [Ctrl+A]) icon, displaying a master
file in the grid is a 2-step process.
2-10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Description of the HR Code Maintenance Window
Tree View
◊ First, click a master file in the tree view.
◊ Second, click the
(Retrieve Data [F2]) icon.
♦ If you have checked the
(Auto Select [Ctrl+A]) icon, a master file displays in
the grid as soon as you click it in the tree view.
Access Levels and Types of Master Files
For each master file, the listing in the tree view identifies the following:
♦ Access Level
♦ Code and County- or District-Level Control
Access Level
The symbol to the left of the master file identifies whether the access level is Read,
Write, Locked, or No Access.
A green check mark indicates that you have Write access to the file.
A right pointing arrow indicates that you have selected a master file
with Write access.
All of the commands for maintaining master files are available
on the toolbar.
Create Report [Ctrl+R]
Add New (No Preload) [Shift+F6 ]
Add New [Ctrl+f6]
Change [Ctrl+F9]
Inspect [Ctrl+F5]
Figure 2-13: Toolbar commands for maintaining master files
A lock icon indicates either Read access or a Locked master file.
♦ For Read access, the message bar reads, "Master file is read
only." The following commands are available:
◊ The
(Inspect [Ctrl+F5]) icon. You can display master
file records in the Inspect dialog box, but you cannot add,
change, or delete records.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
2-11
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 2: HR Code Maintenance Window
◊ The
(Create Report [Ctrl+R]) icon.
♦ For Locked master files, the message bar reads, "Listing onfile values is the only operation allowed at this time." You are
limited to the following:
◊ Listing master file records on the grid.
◊ Clicking the
report.
(Create Report [Ctrl+R]) icon to create a
In a typical situation, individual districts have Read access to
county-level master files.
A red circle indicates No Access.
You cannot display the contents of the master file in the grid.
The grid reads, "You do not have access to view this Master File
(master file name)."
Code and County- or District-Level Control
The information following the name of each master file indicates its code and whether
it is a county- or district-level master file.
♦ Every master file has a code that 2 to 4 character long. For example, the listing of
the Location master file looks like this:
The name of the master file is Locations, and its code is LOC.
♦ Each master file is either a county- or district-level master file.
◊ County master files have a "/C" after their code, as in this example for the
Ethnic Codes master file:
For county-level master files, there is one set of codes that every district uses.
◊ District-level master files do not have a "/C," as in the above example for the
Locations master file.
Each district has its own set of codes.
2-12
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Description of the HR Code Maintenance Window
Filter
There are two basic levels of access: county and district.
♦ County-level access allows you to maintain county-level master files and districtlevel master files for any district.
♦ District-level access allows you to maintain district-level master files for your district and to inspect the contents of county-level master files.
Your system administrator can fine tune this security. For example, your security profile can define custom include and exclude lists for access to master files. For details,
see the discussion of the HRMAINT module in Chapter 2 of Modules, Tasks, and
User Security for QCC.
Filter
Figure 2-14: Filter for the HR Code Maintenance window
Using the Filter
The filter allows you to select a subset of the records displayed in the grid. You can
search by name, code, or a range of codes.
HINT: If a search does not locate the records you were expecting, press F4 and F2 to redisplay the grid before starting another search.
To define a filter:
1 The DI box displays the current district for your QCC session.
◊ In most cases, you are limited to maintaining district-level master files for your
own district.
◊ A few QCC user IDs may grant county-level access that allows selecting the
district for which to maintain master files. For details, see page 2-18.
2 The FY box either a white or shaded background.
◊ The background is shaded for master files that are not linked to a fiscal year.
◊ The background is white for master files that are linked to a specific fiscal year.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
2-13
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 2: HR Code Maintenance Window
For most master files, the background is shaded. You define such master files
once, then continue to use them for all fiscal years. However, there are some master files that you must define for each fiscal year, such as Pay Schedules, Board
Dates, and Bonus Codes.
3 Select the master file records to display in the grid in any of the following ways.
◊ Fill in the Name box for master files that have a Name column in the grid.
The search matches the first characters of a name. The search is not case sensitive. You have a choice of no wildcards, first word match, or partial word
match, as explained on page 2-15.
◊ Fill in the Code box.
The search matches the first characters of a code. The search is not case sensitive. You have a choice of no wildcards, first word match, or partial word
match, as explained on page 2-15.
Numeric codes are treated just like text. For example, job codes are 6-digit
numbers. You must type all 6 digits to match them. For example, type job code
#306 like this: 000306.
◊ Fill in the Code Range From and Code Range To boxes.
Fill in both the start and end of the range. If either the start or end is blank, the
search locates no records.
> For alphabetic codes, you can do partial matches. For example, pay types
have a 4-character code. To search for codes that start with B, type a From
code of B and a To code of BZ. You can type additional letters to narrow
down the match. To search for codes that start with the letters DE through
DR, type a From code of DE and To code of DR.
> For numeric codes, type all digits of the code. Numeric codes are typically 2,
4, 6, or 8 digits. Type all digits when searching for a range. For example, job
codes are 6 digits. To search for job codes 500 through 2000, type a From
value of 000500 and a To value of 00200.
If you type fewer than the full number of digits, the search uses the rules of
matching for alphabetic codes. For example, you type a From code of 300
and a To code of 450 for job codes. The search looks for job codes that begin
with the digits 300 to 450 (job codes 300000 through 450000).
2-14
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Description of the HR Code Maintenance Window
Filter
Searching for Names and Codes
This example illustrates how a search for the Name or Code works with no wildcards, first word match, and any word match. This example goes through a series of
searches on the Job Codes master file to illustrate how to use each option.
♦ No wildcards (exact match)
If you do not use wildcards, you must type the entire Name or Code to display a
match in the grid. For example, you must type "principal teacher (env/ed)" to
locate that specific job code after you click the
(Return Data [F2]) icon.
Figure 2-15: Result of searching for "principal teacher (env/ed))" with no wildcards
If you do not use wildcards, partial searches do not locate the Name, such as "principal teacher" or even "principal teacher (env ed" because it is missing the closing
parenthesis.
♦ First word match
To search for a Name or Code that start with specified letters, type the search pattern followed by the * wildcard. For example, a search for "prin*" displays any
Name that begins with those letters after you click the
(Return Data [F2]) icon.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
2-15
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 2: HR Code Maintenance Window
Figure 2-16: Result of searching for "prin*" with first word match
This search matches all job codes that start with "prin," such as
PRINCIPAL/TEACHER (ENV ED), PRINTING TECHNICIAN, and PRINT
SHOP ASST.
♦ Any word match
To match a partial word match anywhere in a Name or Code, type the * wildcard
at the start of the search pattern. The search locates the search pattern anywhere in
a word after you click the
(Return Data [F2]) icon. In this example, the search
for "*prin" matches any Name for a job code that includes "prin," such as
PRINCIPAL/TEACHER (ENV ED), VICE PRINCIPAL, STUDENT PRINTER,
and SPRINKLER REPAIR WRKR.
2-16
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Description of the HR Code Maintenance Window
Filter
Figure 2-17: Result of searching for "*prin" with partial word match
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
2-17
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 2: HR Code Maintenance Window
Selecting Another District
County-level users may have the ability to select a district for which to maintain district-level master files. This process involves closing the HR Code Maintenance window, selecting another district from the QSS ControlCenter window, and opening the
HR Code Maintenance window again.
To select another district:
1 Close the HR Code Maintenance window.
2 Return to the QSS ControlCenter window.
3 On the File menu, click Settings.
4 In the Settings dialog box, select the district for which you want to maintain
district-level master files.
Figure 2-18: Lists for selecting a district, site, and year in the Settings dialog box
If the District, Site, or Year box has a white background, you can select any item
from the list. If the background is shaded, you cannot change the selection.
5 Click the [OK] button to close the Settings dialog box.
6 From the QSS ControlCenter window, open the HR Code Maintenance window to
maintain master files for the district you just selected.
2-18
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Description of the HR Code Maintenance Window
Grid
Grid
Name of the master file
You can sort the grid
on any column.
Double-click to sort in
ascending order (A-Z).
Double-click again to
sort in descending
order (Z-A).
For a grid that is too long
to fit in the window, use
the scroll arrows, scroll
bar, and standard
Windows keys for
scrolling through the grid.
Figure 2-19: Grid for the HR Code Maintenance window
Name of the Grid
The system builds the name above the grid based on the selection in the tree view. In
this example, the master file selected in the tree view is Employee Types (EM).
Figure 2-20: Name of master file above the grid
The file is either a county or a district master file.
♦ The heading is County if there is a /C in the tree view, such as Certificate Level
(CL/C).
♦ The heading is District if there is no /C in the tree view, such as Employee Type
(EM).
For a more detailed explanation of access levels, see page 2-11.
Contents of the Grid
The grid displays the following information the master file that you select in the grid
view: The grid for most master files includes the following:
♦ A Code that varies in length for different master files
♦ A Name up to 30 characters long
♦ An Abbreviation up to 8 characters long
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
2-19
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 2: HR Code Maintenance Window
♦ An Audit Date for the most recent change to the record
♦ An Audit ID up to 4 characters long for the QSS/OASIS login ID used to make the
most recent change
Some master files do not have a Name or Abbreviation. Their grid has only a Code,
Audit Date, and Audit ID.
For many master files, the grid displays only part of the record. Some simple master
files have only a code, name, and abbreviation. But many master files have additional
information in each record. For example, the District master file includes the name,
address, and phone number for each district.
To display the complete master file record from the grid:
1 Select the record in the grid.
2 Click the
(Inspect [Ctrl+F5]) icon to open an Inspect dialog box that displays
the complete master file record. For detailed instructions, see page 2-23.
Status Bar
1
2
Figure 2-21: Status bar for the HR Code Maintenance window
1
District, year, and site for which you are maintaining master files.
The background color indicates the fiscal year. The standard colors are blue for a future year, green for the current year, and red
for a past year. Your site can select different colors.
You can hover the mouse pointer over this pane to display a tooltip with your QCC user name and the name of the logon district.
2
The current date and time.
You can hover the mouse pointer over the date to display a tooltip that displays the date and time you started using the window.
2-20
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Opening the Window
Status Bar
Opening the Window
These instructions tell how to open the HR Code Maintenance window from the Go
menu and the tree view in QSS ControlCenter (QCC).
To open the HR Code Maintenance window from the Go menu:
1 If you have not done so already, log on to QCC.
2 Click to the Go menu.
Figure 2-22: Go menu expanded
3 Point to Human Resources.
Figure 2-23: Human Resources submenu expanded
4 Click HR Code Maintenance to open the HR Code Maintenance window.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
2-21
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 2: HR Code Maintenance Window
To open the HR Code Maintenance window from the tree view:
1 If you have not done so already, log on to QCC.
2 If the tree view does not display, press CTRL+V to make it display.
3 Click the Human Resources folder of the tree view to open it.
Figure 2-24: Tree view with Human Resources folder open.
4 Under the Human Resources folder, click the Master Files / Utilities subfolder to
open it.
Figure 2-25: Tree view after opening the Master Files / Utilities subfolder
5 Click HR Code Maintenance to open the HR Code Maintenance window.
2-22
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Maintaining and Reporting Master File Records
Inspecting Records (Inspect Command)
Maintaining and Reporting Master File
Records
This heading provides instructions for doing the following from the HR Code Maintenance window:
♦ Inspecting Records (Inspect Command)
♦ Changing and Deleting Records (Change Command)
♦ Adding and Importing Records (Add New Command and Add New [No Preload]
Command)
♦ Launching a Report (Create Report Command)
REMINDER: This chapter provides general instructions for maintaining records. For a
description of each master file, see Chapter 4.
Inspecting Records (Inspect Command)
The Inspect command allows you to view master files to which you have Read or
Write access. For most master files, the grid displays only the Code, Name, Abbr,
Audit Date, and Audit Time. From the grid, you can open a View dialog box that displays the full details of each master file record. For some simple master files, the only
boxes in the View window are the Code, Name, and Abbreviation. However, many
have a View dialog box that contains much more information. For example, the District master file includes the name, address, phone, and tax ID numbers for a district.
To inspect records in a master file:
1 In the tree view, select a master file to display in the grid to which you have either
Read or Write access. For detailed instructions, see “Tree View” on page 2-8.
2 If desired, use the filter to select the master file records to display in the grid. For
detailed instructions, see “Filter” on page 2-13.
3 In the grid, select the master file that you want to inspect.
◊ Click a row to select it. The
pointer displays to the left of the current record.
◊ You can also use the PAGE UP, PAGE DOW, UP ARROW, and DOWN
ARROW keys to move the
pointer.
For a detailed description of the grid, see “Grid” on page 2-19.
4 On the toolbar, click the
(Inspect [Ctrl+F5]) icon to open a View dialog box that
displays the selected record on the grid.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
2-23
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 2: HR Code Maintenance Window
The Options menu and toolbar
commands are the same for every
master file.
The master file record. There are
many different layouts for master
files. Chapter 4 describes the boxes
that display for each master file.
The Audit Information area keeps
track of the most recent change to
the record.
Figure 2-26: View dialog box
◊ The list at the top of the View window allows you to select a record to display.
In this example, the list is Selected Codes. Some master files have a different
name for the list.
◊ The master file record. The boxes are shaded, which means they are displayonly.
Chapter 4 describes the boxes for individual master files. For details, see page
4-3.
◊ The Audit Information displays the following:
> A 4-character ID of the person who made the most recent change to the
record.
> The Date and Time for the change.
5 Take one of the following actions.
◊ To view another record, click one of the VCR buttons.
First record
Last record
Previous Record
Next Record
◊ To close the dialog box, click the
2-24
(Cancel/Close [F12]) icon.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Maintaining and Reporting Master File Records
Changing and Deleting Records (Change Command)
Changing and Deleting Records (Change Command)
The Change command allows you to change and delete records in master files to
which you have Write access. The Change dialog box displays the master file records
in the grid. You can change anything about the master file except its key value, which
is usually the Code.
To change or delete records from a master file:
1 In the tree view, select a master file to display in the grid to which you have Write
access. For detailed instructions, see “Tree View” on page 2-8.
2 If desired, use the filter to select the records to display on the grid. For detailed
instructions, see “Filter” on page 2-13.
3 In the grid, select the master file that you want to change.
◊ Click a row to select it. The
pointer displays to the left of the current record.
◊ You can also use the PAGE UP, PAGE DOW, UP ARROW, and DOWN
ARROW keys to move the
pointer.
For a detailed description of the grid, see “Grid” on page 2-19.
4 On the toolbar, click the
(Change [Ctrl+F9]) icon to open a Change dialog box
that displays the selected record.
The Options menu and toolbar
commands are the same for every
master file.
The master file record. There are
many different layouts for master
files. Chapter 4 describes the boxes
that display for each master file.
The Audit Information area keeps
track of the most recent change to
the record.
Figure 2-27: Change dialog box for changing or deleting records
◊ The list on the top of the Change dialog box allows you to select a record to display. In this example, the list is called Selected Codes. It goes by other names
in some master files.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
2-25
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 2: HR Code Maintenance Window
◊ You cannot change the key value, which is often the Code box. The background
of the box is shaded. For some master files, the key value has another name. In
Chapter 4, the description of each master file identifies the key.
The key value is assigned to the record in the Add dialog box. You cannot
change the key value in the Change dialog bog. (If a key value is wrong, you
can delete the record with the incorrect key and add a new record with the correct key.)
◊ You can change any box that has a white background. For most master files,
you can change everything but the key value.
Chapter 4 describes the boxes for individual master files. For a list of master
files, see page 4-3.
◊ The Audit Information displays the following:
> A 4-character ID of the person who made the most recent change to the
record.
> The Date and Time for the change.
5 Do any of the following:
◊ Click the
(Save [F9]) icon to save the changes to the current record. In the
grid, the row for the changed record is highlighted in pink.
◊ Click the
(Delete [Ctrl+F8]) icon to delete the current record. In the confirmation message, select [No] to cancel the deletion or [Yes] to delete. The
deleted record is removed from the grid, and the dialog box displays the first
record in the grid.
◊ Click one of the VCR buttons to view another record
First record
Previous Record
Last record
Next Record
To change or delete the record, return to Step 4.
◊ Click the
2-26
(Cancel/Close [F12]) icon to close the dialog box.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Maintaining and Reporting Master File Records
Adding and Importing Records (Add New Command and
Adding and Importing Records (Add New Command and Add
New [No Preload] Command)
The Add New command allows you to do the following for master files to which you
have Write access:
♦ Add new records to a master file in the Add dialog box.
♦ If the
(Add/Import Multiple Records [Shift+Ctrl+F8]) icon is available for a
master file, you can import records from the Windows clipboard or a tab-delimited
file. For instructions, see page 2-30.
This command is available only for master files with a relatively simple record
layout. For more complex master files, the only option is to create each record
individually with the Add dialog box.
To add new records in the Add dialog box:
1 In the tree view, select a master file to display in the grid to which you have either
Read or Write access. For detailed instructions, see “Tree View” on page 2-8.
2 If desired, use the filter to display only part of the master file in the grid. For
detailed instructions, see “Filter” on page 2-13.
3 On the toolbar, open an Add dialog box.
◊ If the master file description reads "(pre-fill available)":
> Click the
(Add [Ctrl+F6]) icon to open an Add dialog box that displays
the selected record in the grid as the basis for adding a new record.
> Click the
(Add New (No Preload) [Shift+F6]) icon to open an Add dialog
box with blank boxes so you can type in the new record from scratch.
Pre-fill is available only for simple master files that have only a Code, Name,
and Abbreviation.
◊ If the master file description reads "(no pre-fill)," both add command work
identically. The Add dialog box presents a blank slate for you to fill in.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
2-27
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 2: HR Code Maintenance Window
4 Fill in the Add dialog box.
The Options menu and toolbar
commands are the same for every
master file.
The Add/Import Multiple Records
command is available only for
master files with a relatively simple
record layout.
The master file record. There are
many different layouts for master
files. Chapter 4 describes the boxes
that display for each master file.
Figure 2-28: Add dialog box for creating records
Figure 2-28 illustrates a typical Add window for a simple master file.
◊ The list at the top of the dialog box contains codes that are already defined. It is
not available for adding.
In this example, it is the Selected Codes box. The name varies in other master
files.
◊ Type a key value for the master file, which is usually the Code box. The key
value may have another name in some master files. The key value must be different for each record in the master file.
Chapter 4 describes the size of the key and whether it is numeric or text.
◊ Add the rest of the master file record.
Chapter 4 describes the boxes for individual master files. For details, see page
4-2.
5 Take any of the following actions.
◊ Click the
(Save [F9]) icon to add the new record. It displays in the grid. It is
highlighted in pink to indicate that is new or changed.
To add another record, return to Step 3. You can add as many records as you
like before closing the dialog box. To clear the dialog box before adding
another record, click the
(Clear Data [Shift+F1]) icon.
2-28
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Maintaining and Reporting Master File Records
Launching a Report (Create Report Command)
◊ Click the (Cancel/Close [F12]) icon to close the Add dialog box after you are
finished adding records.
The dialog box closes without saving anything you have typed since the last
save.
Launching a Report (Create Report Command)
The Create Report command allows you to create a report of a master file. You can
create a report for a master file with Read or Write access or that is Locked.
To launch a report:
1 In the tree view, select a master file to display in the grid to which you have either
Read or Write access. For detailed instructions, see “Tree View” on page 2-8.
2 Click the
(Create Report [Ctrl+R]) icon to open a Report dialog box.
Figure 2-29: Report dialog box for HR Code Maintenance window
◊ Type a Report Title up to 30 characters long.
◊ In the Sort Option list, select the option for sorting the report.
◊ Do either of the following:
> Click the
(Send Report [F2]) icon to create the report.
A dialog box displays the job number for the report. Click the [OK] button to
close the dialog box.
> Click the
(Cancel/Close [F12]) icon to close the dialog box without creating a report.
3 View or print the report in the Print Manager window. For instructions, see Printing Reports with Print Manager.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
2-29
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 2: HR Code Maintenance Window
Add/Import Multiple Records
These instructions focus on the following areas:
♦ Importing Multiple Records
♦ Data Formats for Master Files
Importing Multiple Records
These instructions tell how to import multiple records for master files that have the
(Add/Import Multiple Records [Shift+Ctrl+F8]) icon in their Add dialog box. The
process is the same for all such master files. But the format of the data is different for
each one. There are two ways to import records:
♦ Display the records in a tab-delimited text file or an Excel spreadsheet, then cut
and paste the data into the Grid Import dialog box.
♦ Create a tab-delimited text file, then import the file directly into the Grid Import
dialog box.
To import multiple records:
1 Prepare the data in a spreadsheet or other source.
The data must be in the proper format for the master file. For more information,
see “Data Formats for Master Files” on page 2-32.
2 Display the master file for importing in the grid. For details, see “Adding and
Importing Records (Add New Command and Add New [No Preload] Command)”
on page 2-27.
3 Click the
(Add [Ctrl+F6]) icon to open an Add dialog box.
4 In the Add dialog box, click the
(Add/Import Multiple Records
[Shift+Ctrl+F8]) icon to open a Grid Import dialog box.
5 Copy the data into the Grid Import dialog box from the Windows clipboard or a
tab-delimited file.
◊ To import from the Windows clipboard.
> Open a spreadsheet file or tab-delimited text file and display the data.
> Copy the data to the Windows clipboard.
> Click in the Grid Import dialog box.
2-30
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Add/Import Multiple Records
Importing Multiple Records
> Click the (Import from Clipboard [Ctrl+V]) icon. The data displays in the
Grid Import dialog box.
The message bar displays the number of rows imported and the number of
errors.
If there are errors in the data, a message box identifies the errors. You must
correct all errors before importing to the Add dialog box. To do so, click the
(Clear Screen [Shift+F4]) icon. Then fix the errors in the imported data,
copy the corrected data to the clipboard, then paste it into the Grid Import
dialog box again.
◊ To import directly from a tab-delimited text file.
> Click the
(Import from File... [F4]) icon.
> In the Open dialog box, select the file that contains the data that you want to
import.
> Select the [Open] button to copy the contents of the text file into the Grid
Import dialog box.
6 Click the
(Return Data [F2]) icon to import the data from the Grid Import dialog box into the Add dialog box.
◊ The rows for the added records are highlighted in red.
◊ The Error Summary dialog box lists the Add requests (total number of records
in the Grid Import dialog box), number of records Added to the grid, and
Failed records that could not be added.
If some records failed, click [Details..] to see which records were not added. A
Data Import Error Details dialog box lists the records that failed to be added to
the grid. You can click the
(Grid Output [F11]) icon to save the list to a grid.
To close the dialog box, click the
(Cancel/Close [F12]) icon.
◊ Click [OK] to close the Error Summary dialog box.
7 Take either of the following actions.
◊ If you want to import more records from the Add dialog box, return to Step 5.
◊ If you are finished importing, click the
dialog box.
01/10
(Cancel/Close [F12]) icon in the Add
Copyright © QSS, 2010
2-31
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 2: HR Code Maintenance Window
Data Formats for Master Files
The Grid Import dialog box identifies the columns, or fields, in the record. Chapter 4
describes the length and the kind of data for each column. The Excel spreadsheet or
tab-delimited text file must have the same columns as the record layout in the Grid
Import dialog box.
To get the record layout from the Grid Import dialog box:
1 Select the master file from the grid. For instructions, see page 2-8.
2 Click the
(Add New (No Preload) [Shift+F6]) icon to open the Add dialog box.
3 On the Add dialog box, click the
(Add/Import Multiple Records
[Shift+Ctrl+F8]) icon to open the Grid Output window.
4 Get the record layout from the Grid Import dialog box.
Figure 2-30: Grid Import dialog box for the Pay Types master file
The system assigns the Line number during import. The spreadsheet or tab-delimited file must have the remaining columns. In this example, they are Code, Name,
Abbreviation, and Type.
5 For details about the format of the data, see the description of the master file in
Chapter 4.
◊ Table 4-1 on page 4-4 lists the master files in the same order that they appear in
the tree view in the HR Code Maintenance window.
◊ Table 4-2 on page 4-7 lists the master files by their name in the tree view.
◊ Table 4-3 on page 4-10 lists the master files by the 2- to 4-character code in
parentheses after each master file name.
In this example, the description in Chapter 4 identifies the length and data type for
each column: a 4-character Code, a 30-character name, an 8-character Abbreviation, and a 2-character Type.
2-32
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Chapter 3:
HR Code Maintenance 2
Window
Chapter Contents
Description of the HR Code Maintenance Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-3
Title Bar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-3
Menu Bar and Toolbar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-4
Message Bar. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-8
Tree View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-8
Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-14
Grid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-19
Status Bar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-20
Opening the Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-21
Maintaining and Reporting Tax Tables. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-23
Inspecting and Changing Tax Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-23
Adding a New Tax Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-25
Deleting a Tax Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-27
Creating Reports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-28
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
3-1
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 3: HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
Table 3-1: Quick start guide for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window
TOPIC
TELLS HOW TO
PAGE
Description of the HR Code
Maintenance Window
Identify the parts of the HR Code Maintenance 2 window.f
3-3
• Title Bar
Read the name and district number in the title bar.
3-3
• Menu Bar and Toolbar
Use the commands on the menu bar and toolbar for customizing the
window, the tree view, and maintaining master files. The Options menu
and toolbar have the same commands for maintaining master files.
Almost every command also has a keyboard shortcut.
3-4
• Message Bar
Read the messages that display in the message bar and interpret the
mode indicator.
3-8
• Tree View
Use the tree view to do the following:
3-8
• Display the list of master files in the tree view.
• Determine whether you have read, change, or list-only access to a
master file.
• Select a master file for displaying in the grid.
• Filter
Restrict the master file records displayed in the grid by specifying one or
more of the following: a name, a code, or a range of codes.
3-14
• Grid
Maintain records in the master file displayed in the grids. Your user
security can allow you to do the following: add, change, delete, inspect,
and create a report of codes.
3-19
• Status Bar
The district, year, site, and current date and time.
3-20
Opening the Window
Open the HR Code Maintenance 2 window from QCC.
3-21
Maintaining and Reporting
Tax Tables
Use the HR Code Maintenance 2 window to create and maintain tax
tables for the Payroll System, such as FIT, FICA, and retirement.
3-23
• Inspecting and Changing
Tax Tables
Use the Inspect command to open a dialog box that allows you to
inspect, change, and delete tax tables.
3-23
• Adding a New Tax Table
Use the Add command to add new tax tables.
3-25
• Deleting a Tax Table
Delete a tax table from the HR Code Maintenance 2 window or the dialog
box for inspecting a tax table.
3-27
• Creating Reports
Create an InstaPrint report for a tax table.
3-28
3-2
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Description of the HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
Title Bar
Description of the HR Code Maintenance 2
Window
Title bar
Menu bar
Toolbar
Message bar
Filter
Tree view
Grid
Status bar
Figure 3-1: HR Code Maintenance 2 window
Figure 3-1 illustrates the parts of the HR Code Maintenance 2 window. This window
allows you to maintain most master files for the following Human Resources (HR)
software systems:
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
Absence Tracking
Benefits Management
Payroll
Personnel
Position Control
Retirement for California
The tree view includes only the master files to which you have access. The samples in
this chapter list all available master files; however, your user security defines the master files that you can use.
Title Bar
1
2
3
4
Figure 3-2: Title bar for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
3-3
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 3: HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
The title bar includes the following:
1 Icon and name for the window.
2 District number and name for which you are maintaining master files.
3 The QSS/OASIS product name.
4 The standard Minimize, Maximize, and Close buttons for the Windows desktop.
Menu Bar and Toolbar
Figure 3-3: Menu bar and toolbar for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window
File Menu
Figure 3-4:: File menu for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window
Show Status Command
The Show Status command opens a QSS Personnel dialog box that contains a log of
commands executed on the server by the HR Code Maintenance 2 window. This
information is normally of interest only to software developers and support staff.
Figure 3-5: QSS Personnel dialog box for the Show Status command
3-4
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Description of the HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
Menu Bar and Toolbar
Take any of the following actions while viewing the QSS Personnel dialog box.
♦ Click the [Clear] button to clear the contents of the log.
♦ Click the [Print Screen] button to print the contents of the dialog box to the default
windows printer for your PC.
♦ Press ALT+F4 to close the dialog box.
Clear Settings on Exit Command
Select this command to clear any custom settings when you close the HR Code Maintenance 2 window. Normally, the window retains settings, such as window size and
the branches of the tree that are open if you check the Preserve Expanded Branches
command on the View menu.
Exit Command
Select the Exit command to close the HR Code Maintenance 2 window.
View Menu
Figure 3-6: View menu for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window
Options for Expanded and Collapsed Branches at Start-Up
The Expand Tree on Startup and Preserve Expanded Branches commands control
how the tree view looks when you open the HR Code Maintenance 2 window.
♦ Check the Expand Tree on Startup command to expand all branches of the tree
view when you open the HR Code Maintenance 2 window. Thus, you can see all
master files that are available.
♦ Check the Preserve Expanded Branches command to have the system keep track
of which branches are expanded and collapsed when you close the HR Code Maintenance 2 window. The next time you open the window, the same branches are
opened and closed.
Options for Expanding Collapsing During a Session
♦ Select the Expand All Branches command to expand all branches of the tree view
so you can see all of the master files to which you have access.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
3-5
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 3: HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
♦ Select the Collapse All Branches to close all individual master files, leaving only
the nodes for categories of master files.
These two commands are also available on the toolbar.
Options Menu and Toolbar
Figure 3-7: Options menu, View menu, and toolbar commands for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window
The Options menu and toolbar contain the commands for selecting and maintaining
master files. Figure 3-7 illustrates the relation of the commands on the Options menu
and toolbar. The commands are in the same order in both places. Also, the toolbar
contains the Expand All Branches and Collapse All Branches commands from the
View menu.
Help Menu
Figure 3-8: Help menu for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window
The Help menu displays the About dialog box. Your support staff may ask you to use
the About box to get information about the version of QCC that you are using. For
details, see page A-11.
3-6
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Description of the HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
Menu Bar and Toolbar
Table 3-2: Option menu and toolbar commands for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window
COMMAND
KEYBOARD
PURPOSE
Save
F9
Save the new or changed master file records.
Retrieve Data
F2
There are two uses for this command.
• If the Auto Select command is not checked, use this command to
make the grid display the master file selected in the tree view.
• After filling in the filter, use this command to make the grid display
only the master file records that match the selection in the filter.
Expand All
Branches
Ctrl+E
Expand all branches of the tree view so that you can see all available
master files.
Collapse All
Branches
Ctrl+O
Collapse the tree view down to the folders for each category of master files.
Inspect
Ctrl+F5
Open a View dialog box so that you can view master file records.
This command is available only for master files to which you have
Read or Write access.
Change
Ctrl+F9
Open a Change dialog box that allows you to change or delete master file records. This command is available only for master files to
which you have Write access.
Add New
Ctrl+F6
Open an Add dialog box that allows you to add master file records by
filling in the form or using the Grid Import window. For simple master
files, the Add dialog box displays the selected record from the grid as
a starting point for adding the first new record. This command is
available only for master files to which you have Write access.
Add New No
Preload
Shift+F6
Open an Add dialog box without any boxes pre-loaded with the current record in the grid. This command is available only for master
files to which you have Write access.
Auto Select
Ctrl+A
Click the icon to toggle between checked and unchecked. When it is
checked, the master file in the grid changes every time you click a
master file in the tree view. When it is unchecked, you must use the
Retrieve Data command to display a master file in the grid.
Create Report
Ctrl+R
Create a report of the master file that displays in the grid. This command is available for master files with Read, Write, or Locked
access.
Clear Filter
F4
Clear the selections in the filter. If you want the grid to display all
master file records again, use the Retrieve Data command.
Grid Output
Shift+F11
Open a Grid Output window that allows you to export the contents of
the grid to Excel, Word, PDF, or a delimited text file. For instructions,
see Appendix D of the QCC Core Financial Manual.
Print Screen
F11
Print the HR Code Maintenance 2 window on the default Windows
printer for your PC.
01/10
ICON
Copyright © QSS, 2010
3-7
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 3: HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
Message Bar
2
1
Figure 3-9: Message bar for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window
1 Message pane
The message pane displays various messages, such as "Master file is read only" or
"You do not have access to view this master file."
2 Mode indicator
The Mode indicator is always Inspect because the grid allows you to look at master
file codes, but not change them.
The background color indicates the fiscal years. The standard colors are red for a
prior year, green for the current year, and blue for a future year. Your site can use
different colors.
Tree View
s
Figure 3-10: Tree view for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window
The discussion of the tree view focuses on the following areas:
♦ Purpose
♦ Expanding and Collapsing Folders
3-8
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Description of the HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
Tree View
♦ Displaying a Master File in the Grid
♦ Access Levels and Types of Master Files
Purpose
The tree view displays the master files that you can display and maintain. It allows
you to do the following:
♦ Expand and collapse folders to reveal or hide master files.
♦ Select the master file for which to add, change, delete, or inspect codes and for
which to create a report.
The samples in this chapter include all available master files. However, your tree view
lists only the master files that your user security allows access to.
Expanding and Collapsing Folders
Master files are organized into folders that are collapsed (closed) or expanded (open).
Figure 3-11 illustrates what the tree view looks like with all folders collapsed. Each
main folder represents a category of master files, such as Absence Tracking or Position Control.
Figure 3-11: Tree view with all folders collapsed (closed)
♦ A + to the left of the folder indicates a collapsed folder. You can expand it to reveal
the master files under it.
♦ A - to the left of the folder indicates an expanded folder. You can collapse it to hide
its master files.
If you do not have access to any master files in a folder, there is no + or - next to it.
Figure 3-11 illustrates a case where a QCC user does not have access to any Position
Control master files. The folder does not expand when you click it.
To change a folder from expanded to collapsed or collapsed to expanded:
♦ Single-clicking the + or - to the left of the folder.
♦ Double-clicking the folder name.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
3-9
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 3: HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
Clicking a collapsed folder opens
it to reveal master files and
subfolders.
A folder can contain subfolders
with subcategories of master
files. You can expand or collapse
subfolders independently of the
main folder.
The Payroll holder
contains subfolders for
Statutory Deductions
and Tax Tables. The Tax
Tables subfolder contains
the master files that you
can define from the HR
Code Maintenance 2
window.
Figure 3-12: Tree view with Retirement - CA folder expanded
Figure 3-12 illustrates the results of double-clicking the Retirement - CA folder. This
example illustrates how a folder opens up to display a list of master files. A folder can
also contain subfolders, such as the Retirement Group Files folder.
To expand or collapse all folders:
♦ Click the
(Expand All Branches [Ctrl+E]) icon to expand all folders.
♦ Click the
(Collapse All Branches [Ctrl+O]) icon to collapse all folders.
To decide how folders look when you open the HR Code Maintenance 2 window, do
either of the following:
♦ In the View menu, click the Expand Tree on Startup command to expand all
folders when you open the HR Code Maintenance 2 window.
3-10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Description of the HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
Tree View
♦ In the View menu, click the Preserve Expanded Branches to have the system
remember the tree view when you close the HR Code Maintenance 2 window. The
next time you open the window, the tree view looks the same.
HINT: To tell which command is active, click at the View menu. There is a check mark to the
left of the selected command. Once you check one of these commands, the other is
dimmed.
Displaying a Master File in the Grid
There are two procedures for displaying a master file on the grid, depending on
whether you have checked the
(Auto Select [Ctrl+A]) icon. Each time you click
the icon, it alternates between checked and not checked.
♦ If you have not checked the
(Auto Select [Ctrl+A]) icon, displaying a master
file in the grid is a 2-step process.
◊ First, click a master file in the tree view.
◊ Second, click the
(Retrieve Data [F2]) icon.
♦ If you have checked the
(Auto Select [Ctrl+A]) icon, a master file displays in
the grid as soon as you click it in the tree view.
Access Levels and Types of Master Files
For each master file, the listing in the tree view identifies the following:
♦ Access Level
♦ Code and County- or District-Level Control
Access Level
The symbol to the left of the master file identifies whether the access level is Read,
Write, Locked, or No Access.
A green check mark indicates that you have Write access to the file.
A right pointing arrow indicates that you have selected a master file
with Write access.
All of the commands for maintaining master files are available
on the toolbar.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
3-11
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 3: HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
Create Report [Ctrl+R]
Add New (No Preload) [Shift+F6 ]
Add New [Ctrl+f6]
Change [Ctrl+F9]
Inspect [Ctrl+F5]
Figure 3-13: Toolbar commands for maintaining master files
A lock icon indicates either Read access or a Locked master file.
♦ For Read access, the message bar reads, "Master file is read
only." The following commands are available:
◊ The
(Inspect [Ctrl+F5]) icon. You can display master
file records in the Inspect dialog box, but you cannot add,
change, or delete records.
◊ The
(Create Report [Ctrl+R]) icon.
♦ For Locked master files, the message bar reads, "Listing onfile values is the only operation allowed at this time." You are
limited to the following:
◊ Listing master file records on the grid.
◊ Clicking the
report.
(Create Report [Ctrl+R]) icon to create a
In a typical situation, individual districts have Read access to
county-level master files.
This icon indicates that you have selected a locked master file. You
can display its contents on the grid, but not maintain it from the HR
Code Maintenance 2 window.
A red circle indicates No Access.
You cannot display the contents of the master file in the grid.
The grid reads, "You do not have access to view this Master File
(master file name)."
3-12
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Description of the HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
Tree View
Code and County- or District-Level Control
The information following the name of each master file indicates its code and whether
it is a county- or district-level master file.
♦ Every master file has a code that 2 to 4 character long. For example, the listing of
the Workers Compensation master file looks like this:
The name of the master file is Workers Compensation, and its code is TT05.
♦ Each master file is either a county- or district-level master file.
◊ County master files have a "/C" after their code, as in this example for the State
Tax California master file:
For county-level master files, there is one set of codes that every district uses.
◊ District-level master files do not have a "/C," as in the above example for the
Workers Compensation master file.
Each district has its own set of codes.
There are two basic levels of access: county and district.
♦ County-level access allows you to maintain county-level master files and districtlevel master files for any district.
♦ District-level access allows you to maintain district-level master files for your district and to inspect the contents of county-level master files.
Your system administrator can fine tune this security. For example, your security profile can define custom include and exclude lists for access to master files. For details,
see the discussion of the HRMAINT module in Chapter 2 of Modules, Tasks, and
User Security for QCC.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
3-13
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 3: HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
Filter
Figure 3-14: Filter for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window
Using the Filter
The filter allows you to select a subset of the records displayed in the grid. You can
search by name, code, or a range of codes.
HINT: If a search does not locate the records you were expecting, press F4 and F2 to redisplay the grid before starting another search.
To define a filter:
1 The DI box displays the current district for your QCC session.
◊ In most cases, you are limited to maintaining district-level master files for your
own district.
◊ A few QCC user IDs may grant county-level access that allows selecting the
district for which to maintain master files. For details, see page 3-18.
2 The FY box either a white or shaded background.
◊ The background is shaded for master files that are not linked to a fiscal year.
◊ The background is white for master files that are linked to a specific fiscal year.
For most master files, the background is shaded. You define such master files
once, then continue to use them for all fiscal years. However, there are some master files that you must define for each fiscal year, such as Pay Schedules, Board
Dates, and Bonus Codes.
3 Select the master file records to display in the grid in any of the following ways.
◊ Fill in the Name box for master files that have a Name column in the grid.
The search matches the first characters of a name. The search is not case sensitive. You have a choice of no wildcards, first word match, or partial word
match, as explained on page 3-15.
3-14
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Description of the HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
Filter
◊ Fill in the Code box.
The search matches the first characters of a code. The search is not case sensitive. You have a choice of no wildcards, first word match, or partial word
match, as explained on page 3-15.
Numeric codes are treated just like text. For example, job codes are 6-digit
numbers. You must type all 6 digits to match them. For example, type job code
#306 like this: 000306.
◊ Fill in the Code Range From and Code Range To boxes.
Fill in both the start and end of the range. If either the start or end is blank, the
search locates no records.
> For alphabetic codes, you can do partial matches. For example, pay types
have a 4-character code. To search for codes that start with B, type a From
code of B and a To code of BZ. You can type additional letters to narrow
down the match. To search for codes that start with the letters DE through
DR, type a From code of DE and To code of DR.
> For numeric codes, type all digits of the code. Numeric codes are typically 2,
4, 6, or 8 digits. Type all digits when searching for a range. For example, job
codes are 6 digits. To search for job codes 500 through 2000, type a From
value of 000500 and a To value of 00200.
If you type fewer than the full number of digits, the search uses the rules of
matching for alphabetic codes. For example, you type a From code of 300
and a To code of 450 for job codes. The search looks for job codes that begin
with the digits 300 to 450 (job codes 300000 through 450000).
Searching for Names and Codes
This example illustrates how a search for the Name or Code works with no wildcards, first word match, and any word match. This example goes through a series of
searches on the Job Codes master file to illustrate how to use each option.
♦ No wildcards (exact match)
If you do not use wildcards, you must type the entire Name or Code to display a
match in the grid. For example, you must type "principal teacher (env/ed)" to
locate that specific job code after you click the
(Return Data [F2]) icon.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
3-15
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 3: HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
Figure 3-15: Result of searching for "principal teacher (env/ed))" with no wildcards
If you do not use wildcards, partial searches do not locate the Name, such as "principal teacher" or even "principal teacher (env ed" because it is missing the closing
parenthesis.
♦ First word match
To search for a Name or Code that start with specified letters, type the search pattern followed by the * wildcard. For example, a search for "prin*" displays any
Name that begins with those letters after you click the
(Return Data [F2]) icon.
Figure 3-16: Result of searching for "prin*" with first word match
This search machetes all job codes that start with "prin," such as
PRINCIPAL/TEACHER (ENV ED), PRINTING TECHNICIAN, and PRINT
SHOP ASST.
3-16
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Description of the HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
Filter
♦ Any word match
To match a partial word match anywhere in a Name or Code, type the * wildcard
at the start of the search pattern. The search locates the search pattern anywhere in
a word after you click the
(Return Data [F2]) icon. In this example, the search
for "*prin" matches any Name for a job code that includes "prin," such as
PRINCIPAL/TEACHER (ENV ED), VICE PRINCIPAL, STUDENT PRINTER,
and SPRINKLER REPAIR WRKR.
Figure 3-17: Result of searching for "*prin" with partial word match
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
3-17
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 3: HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
Selecting Another District
County-level users may have the ability to select a district for which to maintain district-level master files. This process involves closing the HR Code Maintenance 2
window, selecting another district from the QSS ControlCenter window, and opening
the HR Code Maintenance 2 window again.
To select another district:
1 Close the HR Code Maintenance 2 window.
2 Return to the QSS ControlCenter window.
3 On the File menu, click Settings.
4 In the Settings dialog box, select the district for which you want to maintain
district-level master files.
Figure 3-18: Lists for selecting a district, site, and year in the Settings dialog box
If the District, Site, or Year box has a white background, you can select any item
from the list. If the background is shaded, you cannot change the selection.
5 Click the [OK] button to close the Settings dialog box.
6 From the QSS ControlCenter window, open the HR Code Maintenance 2 window
to maintain master files for the district you just selected.
3-18
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Description of the HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
Grid
Grid
Name of the master file
You can sort the grid
on any column.
Double-click to sort in
ascending order (A-Z).
Double-click again to
sort in descending
order (Z-A).
For a grid that is too long
to fit in the window, use
the scroll arrows, scroll
bar, and standard
Windows keys for
scrolling through the grid.
Figure 3-19: Grid for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window
Name of the Grid
The system builds the name above the grid based on the selection in the tree view. In
this example, the master file selected in the tree view is Federal Income Tax (TT01)
master file.
Figure 3-20: Name of master file above the grid
The label indicates whether a master file is district- or county-level. For a more
detailed explanation of access levels, see page 3-11.
Contents of the Grid
The columns on the grid vary from master file to master file. In many cases, the grid
displays just enough information so that you can select the record that you wish to
maintain.
To display the complete master file record from the grid:
1 Select the record in the grid.
2 Click the
(Inspect [Ctrl+F5]) icon to open an Inspect dialog box that displays
the complete master file record. For detailed instructions, see page 3-23.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
3-19
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 3: HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
Status Bar
1
2
Figure 3-21: Status bar for the HR Code Maintenance 2 window
1 District, year, and site for which you are maintaining master files.
The background color indicates the fiscal year. The standard colors are blue for a
future year, green for the current year, and red for a past year. Your site can select
different colors.
You can hover the mouse pointer over this pane to display a tooltip with your QCC
user name and the name of the logon district.
2 The current date and time.
You can hover the mouse pointer over the date to display a tooltip that displays the
date and time you started using the window.
3-20
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Opening the Window
Status Bar
Opening the Window
These instructions tell how to open the HR Code Maintenance 2 window from the Go
menu and the tree view in QSS ControlCenter (QCC).
To open the HR Code Maintenance 2 window from the Go menu:
1 If you have not done so already, log on to QCC.
2 Click to the Go menu.
Figure 3-22: Go menu expanded
3 Point to Human Resources.
Figure 3-23: Human Resources submenu expanded
4 Click HR Code Maintenance to open the HR Code Maintenance 2 window.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
3-21
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 3: HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
To open the HR Code Maintenance 2 window from the tree view:
1 If you have not done so already, log on to QCC.
2 If the tree view does not display, press CTRL+V to make it display.
3 Click the Human Resources folder of the tree view to open it.
Figure 3-24: Tree view with Human Resources folder open.
4 Under the Human Resources folder, click the Master Files / Utilities subfolder to
open it.
Figure 3-25: Tree view after opening the Master Files / Utilities subfolder
5 Click HR Code Maintenance to open the HR Code Maintenance 2 window.
3-22
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Maintaining and Reporting Tax Tables
Inspecting and Changing Tax Tables
Maintaining and Reporting Tax Tables
This heading provides instructions for doing the following from the HR Code Maintenance 2 window:
♦ Inspecting and Changing Tax Tables
♦ Adding a New Tax Table
♦ Deleting a Tax Table
REMINDER: This chapter provides general instructions for maintaining tax tables. For a
description of each master file, see Chapter 5.
Inspecting and Changing Tax Tables
For complex master files, such as tax tables, the grid displays only the effective date
and description. The Inspect command allows you to open a dialog box that displays
the full details of the tax table. From here, you can add, change, or delete tax tables if
your user security allows.
To inspect and maintain tax tables:
1 In the tree view, open the folder for Payroll and the subfolder for Tax Tables. For
detailed instructions, see “Tree View” on page 3-8.
2 If desired, use the filter to select the master file records to display in the grid. For
detailed instructions, see “Filter” on page 3-14.
3 To display a tax table, do either of the following:
◊ Double-click its row in the grid.
◊ Select the tax table with the command icons.
> Click a row to select it. The
record.
pointer displays to the left of the current
> You can also use the PAGE UP, PAGE DOW, UP ARROW, and DOWN
ARROW keys to move the
pointer.
> Click the
(Inspect [Ctrl+F5]) icon or the
(Change [Ctrl+F9]) icon.
For a detailed description of the grid, see “Grid” on page 3-19.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
3-23
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 3: HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
4 The dialog box for maintaining a tax table allows you to display and maintain tax
tables.
Menu bar and toolbr
commands for
maintaining tax tables
List for selecting a tax
table that is already
defined.
Boxes for filling in the tax
table. These are different
for each tax table.
Figure 3-26: Dialog box for displaying and maintaining tax tables
Take one of the following actions.
◊ To view another table, select it from the list at the top of the dialog box.
◊ To add a tax table, click the
(Add New Tax Table [Ctrl+F6]) icon or the
(Add New (No Preload) [Shift+F6]) icon. For instructions, see page 3-25.
◊ To change a tax table, click the
(Change [Ctrl+F9]) icon. You can change all
aspects of the table except for its effective date.
The boxes that you can change have a white background. Those that you cannot
change have a shaded background.
3-24
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Maintaining and Reporting Tax Tables
Adding a New Tax Table
◊ To delete a tax table, click the
page 3-27.
(Delete [Ctrl+F8]) icon. For instructions, see
◊ To save your changes:
> Click the
(Save All and Return [F2]) icon to save the changes and close
the dialog box.
> Click the
(Save all and Stay [F9]) icon to save the changes and leave the
dialog box open.
You can make changes to multiple tax tables before saving.
◊ To close the dialog box without saving changes, click the
[F12]) icon.
(Cancel/Close
Adding a New Tax Table
For tax tables, the
(Add [Ctrl+F6]) icon and the
(Add New (No Preload)
[Shift+F6]) icon work the same. Both commands provide the option to use an existing
tax table as the basis for creating a new one.
To add a new tax table:
1 Do either of the following:
◊ Click the
(Add [Ctrl+F6]) icon and the
(Add New (No Preload)
[Shift+F6]) icon in the HR Code Maintenance 2 window.
◊ Click the
(Add New Tax Table [Ctrl+F6]) icon in the dialog box for changing or inspecting tax tables.
2 In the Add dialog box for the tax table, select the tax table to use as the basis for
creating the new table.
◊ In the Add from an existing Tax Table list, do either of the following:
> If you do not want to use an existing tax table as the starting point, select the
blank item at the top of the list.
> To add from an existing tax table, select it from the list.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
3-25
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 3: HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
Figure 3-27: Add dialog box for creating a new tax table from an existing tax table
◊ For the Effective Date, type or select the effective date for using the new tax
table.
You must select an Effective Date that has not already been used to add a tax
table. All other boxes in the Add dialog box are optional.
◊ For the Description, type a description up to description up to 30 characters
long or click the [Copy Description] button to use the same description as the
source.
◊ For the Use current values... check box, select the box to add from the selected
tax table or clear the check box
3 Do any of the following:
◊ Press F12 to cancel the add.
◊ Click the
(Clear Form [Ctrl+F1]) icon to clear the Add dialog box.
To add a new tax table, you must type or select an Effective Date before clicking the
(Save and Return [F2]) icon.
◊ Click the
(Save and Return [F2]) icon to open a dialog box for adding the
new tax table.
4 Fill in the dialog box for adding the tax table, as described in Chapter 5.
3-26
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Maintaining and Reporting Tax Tables
5 Click the
Deleting a Tax Table
(Save and Return [F2]) icon to add the new tax table.
6 In the Confirm Closing dialog box, click the [No] button.
Deleting a Tax Table
You can delete a tax table from the HR Code Maintenance 2 window or the dialog box
for maintaining individual tax tables.
WARNING: Do not delete a tax table unless you are absolutely certain that it will never
be used for payroll processing again.
To delete a tax table:
1 In the tree view, open the folder for Payroll and the subfolder for Tax Tables. For
detailed instructions, see “Tree View” on page 3-8.
2 If desired, use the filter to select the master file records to display in the grid. For
detailed instructions, see “Filter” on page 3-14.
3 Do either of the following:
◊ Single-click the row for the tax table to delete, the click the
[Ctrl+F8]) icon in the HR Code Maintenance 2 window.
(Delete
◊ Double-click the row for a tax table to display it in a dialog box, then click the
(Delete [Ctrl+F8]) icon in the dialog box. This latter method allows you to
review the tax table to confirm it is indeed the one that you want to delete.
4 In the Delete confirmation box, confirm or cancel the deletion.
Figure 3-28: Dialog box for confirming or cancelling the deletion of a tax table
◊ To cancel the deletion, press F12.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
3-27
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 3: HR Code Maintenance 2 Window
◊ To confirm the deletion, click the
(Delete [Ctrl+F8]) icon.
In the Confirm Delete dialog message, click the [Yes] button to delete or the
[No] button to cancel the deletion.
Creating Reports
There are two ways to get reports of tax tables:
♦ The On Line Tax Rate Listing (TXR100) report in the traditional software. For
details, see Chapter 6 of the QSS/OASIS Enhanced Payroll Manual.
♦ The InstaPrint report on the dialog box for maintaining tax rate tables.
To create an InstaPrint report:
1 Open a dialog box for a tax table as described on page 3-23.
2 Click the
(InstaPrint [Ctrl+F11]) icon to open a dialog box that displays the
current tax table.
Figure 3-29: Sample InstaPrint report
This window allows you to save the report to a file or print it to a .pdf, .doc, or .xls
file. For instructions, see Appendix B.
3-28
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Chapter 4:
Defining Master Files
Chapter Contents
How to Use This Chapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-2
Master Files in this Chapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3
Master File Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-13
Absence Tracking Master Files. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-21
Personnel Master Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-43
Payroll Master Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-105
Position Control Master Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-161
Master File Links . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-216
Benefits Management Master Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-223
Retirement - CA Master Filess . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-246
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-1
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
How to Use This Chapter
Chapter 4 and Chapter 2 are complementary parts of the Human Resources Master
Files Manual.
♦ Chapter 2 and Chapter 3 describe the windows for maintaining master files.
◊ Chapter 2 describes the HR Code Maintenance window and provides general
instructions for using it to maintain master files and create reports. This window
allows you to maintain most of the master files.
◊ Chapter 3 describes the HR Code Maintenance 2 window that allows you to
maintain tax tables for the Payroll System and salary schedules and positions
for Position Control.
♦ Chapter 4 describes the particulars of each master file. It includes the following for
each master file:
◊ A sample of the dialog box for adding a record.
◊ References to the instructions in Chapter 2 for maintaining master file records
and creating a report of files.
◊ A table that names all of the boxes on the dialog box for a master file and
describes the kind of data to type into each box.
◊ A report sample.
For a more detailed description of the information about each master file, see
“Master File Descriptions” on page 4-13.
Chapter 4 provides several ways to find the description of a master file:
♦ Table 4-1 on page 4-4 lists the master files in the same order as the folders and subfolders for tree view on the HR Code Maintenance window.
♦ Table 4-2 on page 4-7 lists the master files by name.
♦ Table 4-3 on page 4-10 lists the master files by the 2- to 4-character code after each
name.
The order in which the chapter presents the master files mimics the structure of the
tree view in the HR Code Maintenance window.
♦ Each folder in the tree view, such as Absence Tracking or Payroll, corresponds to a
main heading in this chapter.
4-2
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Master Files in this Chapter
♦ Under each main heading, the chapter describes each master file in the folder.
This chapter lists all of the master files that are available from the tree view. However,
you may not have access to all of these files. The security profile for your QCC user
name determines the master files to which you have access.
Master Files in this Chapter
This chapter describes the master files that you can maintain with the HR Code Maintenance window. It provides the following lists so that you can locate a master file in
a variety of ways.
♦ Table 4-1 on page 4-4 lists the master files in the same order that they appear in the
tree view in the HR Code Maintenance window.
♦ Table 4-2 on page 4-7 lists the master files by their name in the tree view.
♦ Table 4-3 on page 4-10 lists the master files by the 2- to 4-character code in parentheses after each master file name.
These tables list all of the master files for the HR Code Maintenance window. The
security profile for your QCC logon name determines the actual master files that are
listed in your tree view.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-3
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-1: Master files by folder on tree view
FOLDER
MASTER FILE
CODE
Absence Tracking
Absence Reasons
Personnel
4-4
SUBFOLDER
LEVEL
PAGE
AR
District
4-21
Leave Group
LG
District
4-23
Absence Indices
AI
District
4-27
Absence FTE Codes
AF
District
4-29
Roll Codes
RO
Absence Tracking Accruals
District
4-31
Accrual Rules
AC
Absence Tracking Accruals
District
4-32
Accrual Schedules
AS
Absence Tracking Accruals
District
4-36
Absence Interface Rules
IR
District
4-37
District Master
DP
County
4-44
Locations
LOC
District
4-46
Location Org Levels Fields
LOC
District
4-49
Bargaining Units
BU
District
4-50
Board Dates
BD
District
4-51
Certificate Level
CL
County
4-52
Certificate Types
CT
County
4-54
Comment Types
CO
District
4-55
Contract Types
CN
District
4-56
Control Groups
CG
District
4-57
County/State Codes
CS
County
4-59
Credentials
CR
Credentials
County
4-61
Credential Authorizations
CA
Credentials
County
4-62
Credential Renewals Codes
CW
Credentials
County
4-64
Credential Subject Codes
CB
Credentials
County
4-65
Credential Level Codes
CV
Credentials
County
4-66
Degree Type
DT
District
4-67
Employee Types
EM
District
4-69
Ethnic Codes
ET
County
4-70
Experience Type
ET
District
4-71
Freeze Placement Reasons
FP
District
4-73
Handicap
HA
District
4-74
Hospital codes
HO
District
4-75
Institutions (Colleges)
IN
District
4-77
Immunization
IM
District
4-78
Inservice Ed Component
IE
District
4-79
Insurance Carrier
IC
District
4-81
Medical Codes
ME
District
4-82
Membership LIst
ML
District
4-83
Job Categories
JB
District
4-84
Job Codes
JC
District
4-85
Languages
LA
District
4-88
Program of Graduation
PG
District
4-89
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Master Files in this Chapter
Table 4-1: Master files by folder on tree view - continued
FOLDER
MASTER FILE
CODE
Personnel - continued
Refusal Reason
Seniority Class
Payroll
01/10
SUBFOLDER
LEVEL
PAGE
RR
District
4-91
SN
District
4-93
Skill Code
SK
District
4-95
Subject Codes
SU
District
4-96
Termination Code
TE
District
4-98
Test Master Codes
TM
District
4-100
PAF Categories
PA
Personnel Action Files
District
4-101
PAF Actions
PF
Personnel Action Files
District
4-103
PAF Dictionary
PD
Personnel Action Files
County
4-104
Report Codes
RC
District
4-92
Pay Codes
PC
County
4-106
Payroll Names
PYN
County
4-107
Pay Schedules
PS
County
4-109
Pay Types
PT
County
4-111
Retirement Systems
RS
County
4-113
Retirement Edits
RE
County
4-114
Payroll Profiles
PP
District
4-116
Statutory Deduction Codes
SD
Statutory Deductions
County
4-118
Statutory Deduction Profiles
SP
Statutory Deductions
County
4-119
Deduction Schedules
DS
County
4-121
Deduction Rate Table
DR
District
4-123
Bonus Code
BC
District
4-125
Payroll Edit Rule
PE
District
4-127
Deduction Rule Code
PR
District
4-128
SMF Status Codes
SM
District
4-129
Pending Retirement Status Codes
PN
District
4-131
Vol-ded Frequency Codes
VF
County
4-132
Voluntary Deductions
VD
County
4-133
Benefit Control
BCT
County
4-135
Benefit Object Maps
OMAP
District
4-136
Benefit H/W Maps
VMAP
District
4-138
Benefit Group Maps
GMAP
District
4-139
Federal Income Tax (HRCM2)
TT01
Tax Tables
County
4-140
OASDI/Medicare (HRCM2)
TT03
Tax Tables
County
4-140
Workers Compensation (HRCM2)
TT05
Tax Tables
County
4-140
SUI California (HRCM2)
TT07
Tax Tables
County
4-140
PERS California (HRCM2)
TT08
Tax Tables
County
4-140
STRS California (HRCM2)
TT09
Tax Tables
County
4-140
California Retirement Setup
(HRCM2)
TT10
Tax Tables
County
4-140
California State Disability Insurance
(HRCM2)
TT11
Tax Tables
County
4-140
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-5
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-1: Master files by folder on tree view - continued
FOLDER
MASTER FILE
CODE
Position Control
Position Control Bonus Codes
Master File Links
Benefits Management
Retirement - CA
4-6
SUBFOLDER
LEVEL
PAGE
PB
District
4-162
Benefit Projected Rates
BPR
District
4-164
District Authorized Positions
(HRCM2)
DAP
District
4-166
New District Authorized Positions
(HRCM2)
DAPN
District
4-177
Salary Schedules (HRCM2)
SS
District
4-193
New Salary Schedules (HRCM2)
SSN
District
4-193
Work Calendars
WC
District
4-209
Pay Code Links
FL01
District
4-216
Voluntary Deduction Code Links
FL02
District
4-217
Vol-Ded Frequency Code Links
FL03
District
4-218
Pay Schedule Code Links
FL04
District
4-219
Stat Ded Profile Code Links
FL05
District
4-220
Deduction Schedule Code Links
FL06
District
4-221
Coverage Level Codes
BMLC
District
4-223
Deduction Class List
BMCL
District
4-226
Dependent Codes
BDCM
District
4-227
FTE Allocation Table
BMFT
District
4-229
Package Codes
BMPK
District
4-234
Plan/Level Amounts
BMPL
District
4-240
Cap Amounts
BMCA
District
4-242
Benefit Status Codes
BMBS
District
4-243
Package Assignment
BMPA
District
4-244
District Master File
RTDI
District
4-247
Accumulator Limits
RTAL
District
4-249
STRS Rates
RTST
District
4-250
PERS Rates
RTPE
District
4-251
Pay Schedule Controls
RTPS
District
4-253
District Master File by Group
RTDB
Retirement Group Files
District
4-255
PERS Rates by Group
TRPG
Retirement Group Files
District
4-257
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Master Files in this Chapter
Table 4-2: Master files by name
MASTER FILE
CODE
FOLDER
Absence FTE Codes
AF
Absence Indices
AI
SUBFOLDER
LEVEL
PAGE
Absence Tracking
District
4-29
Absence Tracking
District
4-27
Absence Interface Rules
IR
Absence Tracking
District
4-37
Absence Reasons
AR
Absence Tracking
District
4-21
Accrual Rules
AC
Absence Tracking
Absence Tracking Accruals
District
4-32
Accrual Schedules
AS
Absence Tracking
Absence Tracking Accruals
District
4-36
Accumulator Limits
RTAL
Retirement - CA
District
4-249
Bargaining Units
BU
Personnel
District
4-50
Benefit Control
BCT
Payroll
County
4-135
Benefit Group Maps
GMAP
Payroll
District
4-139
Benefit H/W Maps
VMAP
Payroll
District
4-138
Benefit Object Maps
OMAP
Payroll
District
4-136
Benefit Projected Rates
BPR
Position Control
District
4-164
Benefit Status Codes
BMBS
Benefits Management
District
4-243
Board Dates
BD
Personnel
District
4-51
Bonus Code
BC
Payroll
District
4-125
California Retirement Setup
TT10
Payroll
Tax Tables
County
4-140
California State Disability Insurance
TT11
Payroll
Tax Tables
County
4-140
Cap Amounts
BMCA
Benefits Management
District
4-242
Certificate Level
CL
Personnel
County
4-52
Certificate Types
CT
Personnel
County
4-54
Comment Types
CO
Personnel
District
4-55
Contract Types
CN
Personnel
District
4-56
Control Groups
CG
Personnel
District
4-57
County/State Codes
CS
Personnel
County
4-59
Coverage Level Codes
BMLC
Benefits Management
District
4-223
Credential Authorizations
CA
Personnel
Credentials
County
4-62
Credential Level Codes
CV
Personnel
Credentials
County
4-66
Credential Renewals Codes
CW
Personnel
Credentials
County
4-64
Credential Subject Codes
CB
Personnel
Credentials
County
4-65
Credentials
Credentials
CR
Personnel
County
4-61
Deduction Class List
BMCL
Benefits Management
District
4-226
Deduction Rate Table
DR
Payroll
District
4-123
Deduction Rule Code
PR
Payroll
District
4-128
Deduction Schedule Code Links
FL06
Master File Links
District
4-221
Deduction Schedules
DS
Payroll
County
4-121
Degree Type
DT
Personnel
District
4-67
Dependent Codes
BDCM
Benefits Management
District
4-227
District Authorized Positions
DAP
Position Control
District
4-166
District Master
DP
Personnel
County
4-44
District Master File
RTDI
Retirement - CA
District
4-247
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-7
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-2: Master files by name - continued
MASTER FILE
CODE
FOLDER
SUBFOLDER
LEVEL
PAGE
District Master File by Group
RTDB
Retirement - CA
Retirement Group Files
District
4-255
Employee Types
EM
Personnel
District
4-69
Ethnic Codes
ET
Personnel
County
4-70
Experience Type
ET
Personnel
District
4-71
Federal Income Tax
TT01
Payroll
County
4-140
Freeze Placement Reasons
FP
Personnel
District
4-73
Tax Tables
FTE Allocation Table
BMFT
Benefits Management
District
4-229
Handicap
HA
Personnel
District
4-74
Hospital codes
HO
Personnel
District
4-75
Immunizations
IM
Personnel
District
4-78
Inservice Ed Component
IE
Personnel
District
4-79
Institutions (Colleges)
IN
Personnel
District
4-77
Insurance Carrier
IC
Personnel
District
4-81
Job Categories
JB
Personnel
District
4-84
Job Codes
JC
Personnel
District
4-85
Languages
LA
Personnel
District
4-88
Leave Group
LG
Absence Tracking
District
4-23
Location
LOC
Personnel
District
4-46
Location Org Levels Field
LOC
Personnel
District
4-49
Medical Codes
ME
Personnel
District
4-82
Membership List
ML
Personnel
District
4-83
New District Authorized Positions
DAPN
Position Control
District
4-177
New Salary Schedules
SSN
Position Control
OASDI/Medicare
TT03
Payroll
Package Assignment
BMPA
Package Codes
BMPK
District
4-193
County
4-140
Benefits Management
District
4-244
Benefits Management
District
4-234
Tax Tables
PAF Actions
PF
Personnel
Personnel Action Files
District
4-103
PAF Category
PA
Personnel
Personnel Action Files
District
4-101
PAF Dictionary
PD
Personnel
Personnel Action Files
County
4-104
Pay Code Links
FL01
Master File Links
District
4-216
Pay Codes
PC
Payroll
County
4-106
Pay Schedule Code Links
FL04
Master File Links
District
4-219
Pay Schedule Controls
RTPS
Retirement - CA
District
4-253
Pay Schedules
PS
Payroll
County
4-109
Pay Types
PT
Payroll
County
4-111
Payroll Edit Rule
PE
Payroll
District
4-127
Payroll Names
PYN
Payroll
County
4-107
Payroll Profiles
PP
Payroll
District
4-116
Pending Retirement Status Codes
PN
Payroll
PERS California
TT08
Payroll
PERS Rates
RTPE
Retirement - CA
4-8
Copyright © QSS, 2010
Tax Tables
District
4-131
County
4-140
District
4-251
01/10
Master Files in this Chapter
Table 4-2: Master files by name - continued
MASTER FILE
CODE
FOLDER
SUBFOLDER
LEVEL
PAGE
PERS Rates by Group
TRPG
Retirement - CA
Retirement Group Files
District
4-257
Plan/Level Amounts
BMPL
Benefits Management
District
4-240
Position Control Bonus Codes
PB
Position Control
District
4-162
Program of Graduation
PG
Personnel
District
4-89
Refusal Reason
RR
Personnel
District
4-91
Report Codes
RC
Personnel
District
4-92
Retirement Edits
RE
Payroll
County
4-114
Retirement Systems
RS
Payroll
County
4-113
Roll Codes
RO
Absence Tracking
District
4-31
Salary Schedules
SS
Position Control
District
4-193
Seniority Class
SN
Personnel
District
4-93
Skill Code
SK
Personnel
District
4-95
SMF Status Codes
SM
Payroll
District
4-129
Stat Ded Profile Code Links
FL05
Master File Links
District
4-220
Statutory Deduction Codes
SD
Payroll
Statutory Deductions
County
4-118
Statutory Deduction Profiles
SP
Payroll
Statutory Deductions
County
4-119
STRS California
TT09
Payroll
Tax Tables
County
4-140
STRS Rates
RTST
Retirement - CA
District
4-250
Subject Codes
SU
Personnel
District
4-96
SUI California
TT07
Payroll
County
4-140
Termination Code
TE
Personnel
District
4-98
Test Master Codes
TM
Personnel
District
4-100
Absence Tracking Accruals
Tax Tables
Vol-Ded Frequency Code Links
FL03
Master File Links
District
4-218
Vol-ded Frequency Codes
VF
Payroll
County
4-132
Voluntary Deduction Code Links
FL02
Master File Links
District
4-217
Voluntary Deductions
VD
Payroll
County
4-133
District
4-209
County
4-140
Work Calendars
WC
Position Control
Workers Compensation
TT05
Payroll
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
Tax Tables
4-9
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-3: Master files by code
CODE
MASTER FILE
FOLDER
SUBFOLDER
LEVEL
PAGE
AC
Accrual Rules
Absence Tracking
Absence Tracking Accruals
District
4-32
AF
Absence FTE Codes
Absence Tracking
District
4-29
AI
Absence Indices
Absence Tracking
District
4-27
AR
Absence Reasons
Absence Tracking
District
4-21
AS
Accrual Schedules
Absence Tracking
District
4-36
BC
Bonus Code
Payroll
District
4-125
BCT
Benefit Control
Payroll
County
4-135
BD
Board Dates
Personnel
District
4-51
BDCM
Dependent Codes
Benefits Management
District
4-227
BMBS
Benefit Status Codes
Benefits Management
District
4-243
BMCA
Cap Amounts
Benefits Management
District
4-242
BMCL
Deduction Class List
Benefits Management
District
4-226
BMFT
FTE Allocation Table
Benefits Management
District
4-229
BMLC
Coverage Level Codes
Benefits Management
District
4-223
BMPA
Package Assignment
Benefits Management
District
4-244
BMPK
Package Codes
Benefits Management
District
4-234
BMPL
Plan/Level Amounts
Benefits Management
District
4-240
BPR
Benefit Projected Rates
Position Control
District
4-164
Absence Tracking Accruals
BU
Bargaining Units
Personnel
District
4-50
CA
Credential Authorizations
Personnel
Credentials
County
4-62
CB
Credential Subject Codes
Personnel
Credentials
County
4-65
CG
Control Groups
Personnel
District
4-57
CL
Certificate Level
Personnel
County
4-52
CN
Contract Types
Personnel
District
4-56
CO
Comment Types
Personnel
District
4-55
CR
Credentials
Personnel
County
4-61
CS
County/State Codes
Personnel
County
4-59
CT
Certificate Types
Personnel
County
4-54
CV
Credential Level Codes
Personnel
Credentials
County
4-66
CW
Credential Renewals Codes
Personnel
Credentials
County
4-64
Credentials
DAP
District Authorized Positions
Position Control
District
4-166
DAPN
New District Authorized Positions
Position Control
District
4-177
DP
District Master
Personnel
County
4-44
DR
Deduction Rate Table
Payroll
District
4-123
DS
Deduction Schedules
Payroll
County
4-121
DT
Degree Type
Personnel
District
4-67
EM
Employee Types
Personnel
District
4-69
ET
Ethnic Codes
Personnel
County
4-70
ET
Experience Type
Personnel
District
4-71
FL01
Pay Code Links
Master File Links
District
4-216
FL02
Voluntary Deduction Code Links
Master File Links
District
4-217
4-10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Master Files in this Chapter
Table 4-3: Master files by code - continued
CODE
MASTER FILE
FOLDER
FL03
Vol-Ded Frequency Code Links
FL04
Pay Schedule Code Links
FL05
Stat Ded Profile Code Links
FL06
Deduction Schedule Code Links
FP
Freeze Placement Reasons
GMAP
Benefit Group Maps
HA
Handicap
HO
Hospital codes
IC
Insurance Carrier
IE
Inservice Ed Component
SUBFOLDER
LEVEL
PAGE
Master File Links
District
4-218
Master File Links
District
4-219
Master File Links
District
4-220
Master File Links
District
4-221
Personnel
District
4-73
Payroll
District
4-139
Personnel
District
4-74
Personnel
District
4-75
Personnel
District
4-81
Personnel
District
4-79
IM
Immunizations
Personnel
District
4-78
IN
Institutions (Colleges)
Personnel
District
4-77
IR
Absence Interface Rules
Absence Tracking
District
4-37
JB
Job Categories
Personnel
District
4-84
JC
Job Codes
Personnel
District
4-85
LA
Languages
Personnel
District
4-88
LG
Leave Group
Absence Tracking
District
4-23
LOC
Location
Personnel
District
4-46
LOC
Location Org Levels Field
Personnel
District
4-49
ME
Medical Codes
Personnel
District
4-82
ML
Membership List
Personnel
District
4-83
OMAP
Benefit Object Maps
Payroll
District
4-136
PA
PAF Category
Personnel
District
4-101
PB
Position Control Bonus Codes
Position Control
District
4-162
PC
Pay Codes
Payroll
County
4-106
PD
PAF Dictionary
Personnel
County
4-104
PE
Payroll Edit Rule
Payroll
District
4-127
PF
PAF Actions
Personnel
District
4-103
PG
Program of Graduation
Personnel
District
4-89
PN
Pending Retirement Status Codes
Payroll
District
4-131
PP
Payroll Profiles
Payroll
District
4-116
PR
Deduction Rule Code
Payroll
District
4-128
PS
Pay Schedules
Payroll
County
4-109
PT
Pay Types
Payroll
County
4-111
PYN
Payroll Names
Payroll
County
4-107
RC
Report Codes
Personnel
District
4-92
RE
Retirement Edits
Payroll
County
4-114
RO
Roll Codes
Absence Tracking
District
4-31
RR
Refusal Reason
Personnel
District
4-91
RS
Retirement Systems
Payroll
County
4-113
RTAL
Accumulator Limits
Retirement - CA
District
4-249
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
Personnel Action Files
Personnel Action Files
Personnel Action Files
Absence Tracking Accruals
4-11
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-3: Master files by code - continued
CODE
MASTER FILE
FOLDER
SUBFOLDER
LEVEL
PAGE
RTDB
District Master File by Group
Retirement - CA
Retirement Group Files
District
4-255
RTDI
District Master File
Retirement - CA
District
4-247
RTPE
PERS Rates
Retirement - CA
District
4-251
RTPS
Pay Schedule Controls
Retirement - CA
District
4-253
RTST
STRS Rates
Retirement - CA
District
4-250
SD
Statutory Deduction Codes
Payroll
County
4-118
SK
Skill Code
Personnel
District
4-95
SM
SMF Status Codes
Payroll
District
4-129
SN
Seniority Class
Personnel
District
4-93
SP
Statutory Deduction Profiles
Payroll
County
4-119
SS
Salary Schedules
Position Control
District
4-193
SSN
New Salary Schedules
Position Control
District
4-193
SU
Subject Codes
Personnel
District
4-96
TE
Termination Code
Personnel
District
4-98
TM
Test Master Codes
Personnel
District
4-100
TRPG
PERS Rates by Group
Retirement - CA
Retirement Group Files
District
4-257
TT01
Federal Income Tax
Payroll
Tax Tables
County
4-140
TT03
OASDI/Medicare
Payroll
Tax Tables
County
4-140
TT05
Workers Compensation
Payroll
Tax Tables
County
4-140
TT07
SUI California
Payroll
Tax Tables
County
4-140
TT08
PERS California
Payroll
Tax Tables
County
4-140
TT09
STRS California
Payroll
Tax Tables
County
4-140
Statutory Deductions
Statutory Deductions
TT10
California Retirement Setup
Payroll
Tax Tables
County
4-140
TT11
California State Disability Insurance
Payroll
Tax Tables
County
4-140
VD
Voluntary Deductions
Payroll
County
4-133
VF
Vol-ded Frequency Codes
Payroll
County
4-132
VMAP
Benefit H/W Maps
Payroll
District
4-138
WC
Work Calendars
Position Control
District
4-209
4-12
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Master File Descriptions
Overview
Master File Descriptions
This heading describes the master file descriptions in this chapter. It includes the
following:
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
Overview
Sample Table
Box Label Column
R/O/D Column
Contents Column
Overview
The description of each master file includes the following:
♦ A screen shot of the dialog box for adding a record.
♦ Pointers to instructions for maintaining records in the master file and for launching
a report.
♦ A table that lists the boxes for each master file, whether it is required or optional,
and the kind of data to type in it. For a description of when, why, or how to use a
master file, see the documentation for a particular software system, such as Personnel, Payroll, or Absence Tracking.
♦ A sample report when one is available.
Sample Table
Table 4-4 illustrates the format for the table of boxes for a master file record. The
remainder of the heading explains the contents of each column.
Table 4-4: Sample master file
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (2 characters)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-13
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
If you are using Adobe Reader or Acrobat to view the document, click the blue text in
the R/O/D and Contents columns for more information. To return to the table, click
the Previous View button or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
Previous View
Next View
Figure 4-1: Previous View and Back View buttons for Adobe Reader and Acrobat
Adobe Reader and Acrobat keep track of the pages that you have viewed just like a
Web browser does. You can press ALT+LEFT ARROW instead of clicking the Preview View button. You can press ALT+RIGHT ARROW instead of clicking the Next
View button.
Box Label Column
The box label column lists the labels of the boxes in bold type. For cryptic box names,
the column includes an explanation in parentheses.
R/O/D Column
Each box is one of the following: Required, Optional, or Display.
Required
All required boxes must be filled in before you can update a record.
Key
Each record in a master file must have a key value that is not used for any other record
in the master file.
♦ When you are adding a master file record, the code is required. You must assign
the new record to a code that is not already used.
♦ After you save a master file record, the code becomes display-only. You can
change anything for a master file record except its code value.
For many master files, the Code box is the key value. For other master files, the key
may have a different name.
Optional
You can leave optional boxes blank and still update the text box. However, some of
the optional boxes may contain information that is important for setting up the system
properly.
4-14
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Master File Descriptions
Contents Column
Display
Some master files have display fields. Typically, display fields occur on master files
where you type or select a code from another master file, then the dialog box displays
the name for the master file code in a display-only text box.
Contents Column
When adding or changing master file records, type the following kinds of data in the
dialog box:
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
Date
Dollar Amount
Fiscal Year
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Selection from List
Text
Date
Figure 4-2: Date box
These instructions tell how to type a date, change a date, select a date from the calendar, and select today from the calendar.
To type a date:
1 Make the date box the active box and highlight the date in either of the following
ways:
◊ Press the TAB or ALT+TAB key.
◊ Click the label for the date field.
2 Type the date as an 8-digit number.
Make sure that the entire date field is highlighted. If it is not, use the mouse to
highlight all 8 digits of the date.
The month and day are always 2 digits, and the year is 4 digits. For example, type
February 4, 2008 like this: 02042008.
As you type the date, the box automatically inserts the / characters that separate the
month, day, and year. You cannot type the / (or any other separator between parts
of the date).
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-15
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
To change part of a date:
1 Select the part of the date that you want to change, such as the day or the month,
with the mouse pointer.
2 Type the changes you want to make.
To select a date from the calendar:
1 To display the calendar, click the drop-down arrow for a date box.
2 On the top of the calendar, click the left arrow to display the previous month or the
right arrow to display the next month.
3 To select a date, double-click the date. The calendar closes, and the date field contains the selected date.
4 To close the calendar without selecting a date, press the ESC key.
To select the current date from the calendar:
1 Click the drop-down arrow for a date box.
2 Click Today: dd/mm/yy on the bottom of the calendar.
The calendar displays the current month with today’s date circled in red.
3 Double-click the circled date on the calendar.
The calendar closes, and today’s date displays in the date field.
Dollar Amount
When typing dollar amounts, you can type the following:
♦ The digits 0 through 9
♦ A decimal point between whole dollars and cents
♦ Optional commas to separate thousands of dollars
After you are finished typing a dollar amount, the system adds any commas between
thousands of dollars and cents after the decimal point for dollar amounts that include
cents.
Fiscal Year
In QSS/OASIS, fiscal years are a 2-digit number for the year in which the fiscal year
ends, such as 09 for FY 2008-2009.
4-16
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Master File Descriptions
Contents Column
Fixed Decimal Point
The table includes a notation like this: "Implied decimal point (4 digits nn.nn)." The
box automatically inserts the decimal point as you type the digits 0 through 9.
Numerals
The table includes notations like this:
♦ (n digits). The n stands for the maximum number of digits you can type in the box.
For example, the PR (payroll number) box allows typing any 2-digit number. Type
only the digits 0 through 9. You cannot type commas, periods, letters, or other
characters.
♦ (nnn.nn to nnn.nn). Some boxes require that the number you type fall within a certain range. For example, the Rate Pay box requires that you type a daily rate of
pay from 0.00 to 999.99 dollars. You can type the digits 9 through 9 and a decimal
point.
Numeric Code
Some master files have a numeric Code, such as a 4-digit job category or 6-digit job
code. These text boxes accept only the digits 0 through 9 with no spaces, commas, or
other characters. Most numeric codes are right justified and zero filled. For example,
you type the following in a 6-digit code: 304. The system displays the code like this:
000304.
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
QCC uses check boxes for cases where there are only 2 choices:
♦ Selected for yes
♦ Cleared for no
You can make a check box alternate between selected and cleared in any of the following ways:
♦ Clicking the check box.
♦ Clicking the label for the check box, then pressing the space bar.
In the following example, the Manually Enter check box is cleared, and the Loaded
from Position Control check box is selected.
Figure 4-3: Examples of cleared and selected check boxes
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-17
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Selection from Option Buttons
Option buttons (also called radio buttons) are for situations where there are several
options from which you can select only one. Option buttons are groups of rounded
buttons. You can select only one button in each group, just as you can select only one
preset radio station at a time on a car radio. For example, the following figure illustrates a set of option buttons that require selecting interim period 1, 2, or 3.
Figure 4-4: Option buttons for selecting Interim Period 1, 2, or 3 in a row
Sometimes option buttons are in a vertical group with a name above it. In the following example, you can select Global Site, Global Leave Group, or Site/Leave Group
under Record Type.
Figure 4-5: Options buttons for selecting one of the options under Record Type
To select an option, do either of the following:
♦ Click the option button that you want to select. All other options in the group are
cleared.
♦ When an option button is the active field, press the LEFT ARROW key to select
the next option button or the RIGHT ARROW key to select the previous one.
Selection from List
List boxes force you to select from a list of items, such as reporting approved transactions only, unapproved only, or both. After you click the drop-down arrow, a list displays the items from which you can choose. The box displays the option that you have
chosen. In most lists, you cannot type text to define your own items.
Lists can make choices either optional or required:
♦ For an optional list, the first item is blank. You can select blank to mean "none of
the below."
♦ For a required list, you must select one of the items. There is no blank item.
Drop-down arrow
Figure 4-6: List box
4-18
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Master File Descriptions
Contents Column
To make a selection from a list:
1 Click the drop-down arrow or anywhere in the box. The list drops down to display
the options from which you can choose.
Figure 4-7: List box with options expanded after clicking the drop-down arrow
2 Select an item from the list in any of the following ways:
◊ Click the item.
◊ Type the first letter of an item, then move to another box by clicking another
box or pressing the TAB key.
◊ Press the UP ARROW or DOWN ARROW key to highlight an item, then click
another box or press any of the following keys: ENTER, TAB, or SHIFT+TAB.
◊ Click the label for a box, then press the UP ARROW or DOWN ARROW key
to highlight another item. When the item you want is highlighted, click another
box or press the TAB key.
Text
The table includes a notation like this: "Text (xx characters)." The xx refers to the
maximum length of the field. You can type the letters A-Z, the numerals 0-9, special
characters. You can type spaces within a text box, as in this: "100 Main Street."
The description can have one of the following characteristics: case sensitive and
upshifted.
♦ Case sensitive means that capitalization matters. Some master file codes are case
sensitive. For example, the Absence FTE Codes master file has a 2-character code.
All of the following are different codes: aa, Aa, aA, and AA. For case-sensitive
codes, QSS suggests that you use a consistent convention, such as using only
upper-case letters.
♦ Upshifted means that all lower-case letters are turned into upper-case letters. For
example, you type the following in a box: "Peoria, IL". The dialog box makes the
box read like this: "PEORIA, IL".
Time Stamp
The Change and Inspect dialog boxes display Audit Information for the most recent
change to the master file records.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-19
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
♦ The ID is the 4-character ID linked to each QCC logon name.
♦ The Date and Time identify the most recent change to the record.
For most master files, the Audit Information area does not display on the Add
windows.
4-20
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Absence Tracking Master Files
Absence Reasons (AR) Master File
Absence Tracking Master Files
The Absence Tracking folder contains the master files for the HR Absence Tracking
window and its related reports and processes. This heading lists the master files and
subfolders in the same order that they display in the tree view.
Table 4-5: Master files in the Absence Tracking folder
MASTER FILE
CODE
Absence Reasons
SUBFOLDER
LEVEL
PAGE
AR
District
4-21
Leave Group
LG
District
4-23
Absence Indices
AI
District
4-27
Absence FTE Codes
AF
District
4-29
Roll Codes
RO
Absence Tracking Accruals
District
4-31
Accrual Rules
AC
Absence Tracking Accruals
District
4-32
Accrual Schedules
AS
Absence Tracking Accruals
District
4-36
Absence Interface Rules
IR
District
4-37
For additional lists of master files documented in the chapter, see:
♦ "Table 4-1: Master files by folder on tree view" on page 4-4
♦ "Table 4-2: Master files by name" on page 4-7
♦ "Table 4-3: Master files by code" on page 4-10
Absence Reasons (AR) Master File
Figure 4-8: Add dialog box for the Absence Reasons (AR) master file
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-21
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
This heading describes the boxes for the Absence Reasons (AR) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-6: Absence Reasons (AR) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (2 characters)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
SAMPLE FOR DOCUMENTATION
J8436
PP0100
Absence reasons
H.00.02
05/14/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------A0 ACCRUAL BUCKET #10
AC-B-10
A1 ACCRUAL BUCKET #1
AC-B-01
A2 ACCRUAL BUCKET #2
AC-B-02
A3 ACCRUAL BUCKET #3
AC-B-03
A4 ACCRUAL BUCKET #4
AC-B-04
A5 ACCRUAL BUCKET #5
AC-B-05
A6 ACCRUAL BUCKET #6
AC-B-06
A7 ACCRUAL BUCKET #7
AC-B-07
A8 ACCRUAL BUCKET #8
AC-B-08
A9 ACCRUAL BUCKET #9
AC-B-09
B0 BALANCE FORWARD BUCKET #10
BF-B-10
B1 BALANCE FORWARD BUCKET #1
BF-B-01
B2 BALANCE FORWARD BUCKET #2
BF-B-02
B3 BALANCE FORWARD BUCKET #3
BF-B-03
B4 BALANCE FORWARD BUCKET #4
RES BER
B5 BALANCE FORWARD BUCKET #5
BF-B-05
B6 BALANCE FORWARD BUCKET #6
BF-B-06
B7 BALANCE FORWARD BUCKET #7
BF-B-07
B8 BALANCE FORWARD BUCKET #8
BF-B-08
B9 BALANCE FORWARD BUCKET #9
BF-B-09
C1 COMPELLING PERSONAL IMPORTANT
CPI
4-22
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Absence Tracking Master Files
Leave Groups (LG) Master File
Leave Groups (LG) Master File
The instructions for this master file focus on the following areas:
♦
♦
♦
♦
General Instructions
Leave Buckets Tab
Service Years Tab
Paystub Mapping Tab
General Instructions
This heading describes the boxes for the Leave Groups (LG) master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
Leave Buckets Tab
Figure 4-9 illustrates the Add window with the Leave Buckets tab active. This tab is
active when you first open a window for maintaining the Leave Groups (LG) master
file.
Table 4-7: Leave Groups (LG) master file (Leave Buckets tab)
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Leave Group Codes
Display
Selection from List
Leave Group
Key
Text (2 characters)
Copy From
Optional
Selection from List
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbr
Required
Text (8 characters)
Pay Rate
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 999.99)
Hrs/Day
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 24.00)
Accrual in
Required
Selection from Option Buttons
Bucket Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbr
Required
Text (8 characters)
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-23
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Figure 4-9: Add dialog box for the Leave Groups (LG) master file (Leave Buckets tab)
Table 4-7: Leave Groups (LG) master file (Leave Buckets tab) - continued
4-24
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Positive
Required
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Accrual
Required
Selection from List
Reset
Required
Selection from List
Balance
Required
Selection from List
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Absence Tracking Master Files
Leave Groups (LG) Master File
Service Years Tab
Figure 4-10 illustrates the Service Years tab.
Figure 4-10: Service Years tab for the Leave Groups (LG) master file
Table 4-8: Leave Groups (LG) master file (Service Years tab)
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
From
Required
Selection from List
To
Required
Selection from List
YrCode
Required
Text (2 characters)
Paystub Mapping Tab
Figure 4-11 illustrates the Paystub Mapping tab.
Figure 4-11: Paystub Mapping Tab for the Leave Groups (LG) master file
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-25
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-9: Leave Groups (LG) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Sick
Required
Selection from List
Vacation
Required
Selection from List
Pay-stub-3 through Pay-stub-10
Required
Selection from List
07 QSS DEMONSTRATION DISTRICT
J7874
PP1ABT
H.01.00
06/30/09 PAGE
1
Leave groups
Leave group: 01
Hours per day: 8.00
Name: ADMINISTRATIVE
Pay rate: 146.01
Accrual is in: HOURS
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------Bucket name
Abbr
P/N Acr Res Bal Svc yrs Paystub mapping
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
VACATION
SICK LEAVE
PERSONAL NECESSITY
WORKERS COMPENSATION
EXTENDED SICK LEAVE
OTHER
EXCESS SL
VACATION
SICK LV
PERSONAL
WK COMP
EXT SICK
OTHER
EXC SLL
N
P
N
P
N
P
N
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A0
A0
R1
R2
R3
R4
R5
R0
R0
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B0
B0
00-04
05-09
10-14
15-15
16-16
17-17
18-18
19-19
20-20
21-99
05
10
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
Sick
Vacation
Pay-stub-3
Pay-stub-4
Pay-stub-5
Pay-stub-6
Pay-stub-7
Pay-stub-8
Pay-stub-9
Pay-stub-10
2
1
7
Leave group: 02
Hours per day: 8.00
Name: TEACHERS
Pay rate: 22.00
Accrual is in: HOURS
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------Bucket name
Abbr
P/N Acr Res Bal Svc yrs Paystub mapping
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
4-26
VACATION
SICK LEAVE
PERSONAL NECESSITY
WORKERS COMPENSATION
EXTENDED SICK LEAVE
OTHER
VACATION
SICK LV
PERSONAL
WK COMP
EST SICK
OTHER
N
P
P
P
P
N
P
P
P
P
A0
A2
A3
A4
A5
A0
R0
R2
R3
R4
R5
R0
B1 00-30 30 Sick
B2 31-65 65 Vacation
B3
Pay-stub-3
B4
Pay-stub-4
B5
Pay-stub-5
B0
Pay-stub-6
Pay-stub-7
Pay-stub-8
Pay-stub-9
Pay-stub-10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
1
4
5
6
3
01/10
Absence Tracking Master Files
Absence Indices (AI) Master File
Absence Indices (AI) Master File
Figure 4-12: Add dialog box for the Absence Indices (AI) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Absence Indices (AI) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-10: Absence Indices (AI) master file
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Absence Indices
Required
Selection from List
Leave Groups
Required
Selection from List
Absence Reasons
Required
Selection from List
Copy From
Optional
Selection from List
Leave Group Buckets Affected
Display
From Leave Groups (LG) master file
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-27
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-10: Absence Indices (AI) master file - continued
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Y/N
Required
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Borrow From:
Optional
Bucket borrowing rules
Sequence Rule
Optional
Selection from List
[sequence numbers]
Optional
Selection from List
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
07 QSS DEMONSTRATION DISTRICT
J7875
PP1ABT
H.01.00
06/30/09 PAGE
1
Absence indices
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------Leave group: 01 ADMINISTRATIVE
Absence reason: 01 SICK LEAVE CORRECTION
Leave group buckets affected:
Borrow from:
Borrowing sequence:
2. SICK LEAVE
Y
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------Leave group: 02 TEACHERS
Absence reason: SL SICK LEAVE
Leave group buckets affected:
Borrow from:
Borrowing sequence:
2. SICK LEAVE
4-28
Y
3
5
1
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Absence Tracking Master Files
Absence FTE Codes (AF) Master File
Absence FTE Codes (AF) Master File
Figure 4-13: Add dialog box for the Absence FTE Codes (AF) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Absence FTE Codes (AF) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
01/10
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-29
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-11: Absence FTE Codes (AF) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Absence FTE Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code value
Key
Text (2 characters case sensitive)
From
Required
Fixed Decimal Point (n.nnnn)
To
Required
Fixed Decimal Point (n.nnnn)
FTE
Required
Fixed Decimal Point (n.nnnn)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
07 QSS DEMONSTRATION DISTRICT
J7876
PP1ABT
H.01.00
06/30/09 PAGE
1
Absence FTE codes
FTE CODE: 01
FROM
TO
FTE
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------0.0000
0.0025
0.0025
0.0026
0.0035
0.0035
0.0036
0.5000
0.5000
FTE CODE: PR
FROM
TO
FTE
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------0.0000
0.2499
0.2500
0.2500
0.4999
0.5000
0.5000
0.7499
0.7500
0.7500
0.9999
0.9000
1.0000
1.0000
1.0000
FTE CODE: TE
FROM
TO
FTE
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------0.0000
0.2499
0.2500
0.2500
0.4999
0.2500
0.5000
0.7499
0.5000
0.7500
0.9999
0.7500
1.0000
1.0000
1.0000
FTE CODE: TM
FROM
TO
FTE
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------0.0000
0.4999
0.6000
0.5000
1.0000
1.0000
Absence Tracking Accrual Subfolder
The subfolder includes the following master files:
♦ Roll Codes (RO) Master File
♦ Accrual Rules (AC) Master File
♦ Accrual Schedules (AS) Master File
4-30
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Absence Tracking Master Files
Absence Tracking Accrual Subfolder
Roll Codes (RO) Master File
Figure 4-14: Add dialog box for the Roll Codes (RO) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Roll Codes (RO) master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-12: Roll Codes (RO) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (2 characters)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
Times to accrue per year
Required
Numerals (2 digits)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.eu
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-31
Human Resources Master Files Manual
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
SAMPLE FOR DOCUMENTATION
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
J8437
PP1ABT
H.01.00
05/14/08 PAGE
1
Roll codes
Roll code
Name
Abbrev name
Accrue per year
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------AN
ANNUALLY
ANNUALLY
12
MO
MONTHLY
MONTHLY
12
Accrual Rules (AC) Master File
General Instructions
This heading describes the boxes for the Accrual Rules (AC) master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
Page 1
Figure 4-15 illustrates the dialog box after you select it for adding, changing, or deleting records. Page 1 is the active tab.
Table 4-13: Accrual Rules (AC) master file (Page 1)
4-32
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Accrual Rules Codes
Required
Selection from List
Leave Group Codes
Required
Selection from List
Hours/Day
Display
From Leave Group (LG) master file
Accrual is In
Display
From Leave Group (LC) master file
Service Year Codes
Required
Selection from List
Service Years
Display
From Service Year Codes
Bucket Name
Display
From Service Years selection
Accr Rate
Optional
Numerals (0.00 to 999.99)
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Absence Tracking Master Files
Absence Tracking Accrual Subfolder
Figure 4-15: Add dialog box for Accrual Rules master file (Page 1)
Table 4-13: Accrual Rules (AC) master file (Page 1) - continued
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Carry Over
Optional
Numerals (0.00 to 9999.99)
Max Accr
Optional
Numerals (0.00 to 9999.99)
Calc FTE
Optional
Selection from List
FTE Code
Optional
Selection from List
Prob value
Optional
Numerals (0.00 to 999.99)
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-33
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Page 2
Figure 4-16 illustrates the boxes that display after you click the Page 2 tab.
Figure 4-16: Add dialog box for Accrual Rules master file (Page 2)
Table 4-14: Accrual Rules (AC) master file (Page 2)
4-34
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Roll code
Optional
Selection from List
Reset Rule
Optional
Selection from List
Reset Val
Optional
Numerals (0.00 to 999.99)
JASONDJFMAMJ
Required
Y to accrue on month or N for not
Work Calendar
Optional
Selection from List
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Absence Tracking Master Files
Absence Tracking Accrual Subfolder
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
SAMPLE FOR DOCUMENTATION
J7877
PP1ABT
H.01.00
06/30/09 PAGE
12
Accrual rules
Leave group: 2R
Service years: Y4
Hours per day: 8.00
Name: CLASSIFIED
Accrual is in: HOURS
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------Bucket
Accr
Carry
Max
Calc Fte
Prob Reset Reset Roll W o r k
name
rate
over
accr fte code value rule
value code calendar
1. SICK
96.00 9999.99 9999.99
J A S O N D
Y N N N N N
AP
J F
N N
96.00 B
A M J
N N N
AN
M
N
2. VACATION 120.00 9999.99 9999.99
J A S O N D
Y N N N N N
AP
J F
N N
120.00 B
A M J
N N N
AN
M
N
3. PERSONAL
4. EXTRA PE
56.00
J
Y
S
N
O
N
56.00
N D
N N
AP
J F
N N
M
N
56.00 BV
A M J
N N N
AN
A
N
16.00
J
Y
S
N
O
N
16.00
N D
N N
AP
J F
N N
M
N
16.00 BV
A M J
N N N
AN
A
N
AN
00
A
N
S
N
O
N
N
N
D
N
AP
J F
N N
BV
J
Y
M
N
A
N
M
N
J
N
AN
00
A
N
S
N
O
N
N
N
D
N
AP
J F
N N
BV
J
Y
M
N
A
N
M
N
J
N
AN
00
A
N
S
N
O
N
N
N
D
N
AP
J F
N N
BV
J
Y
M
N
A
N
M
N
J
N
AN
00
A
N
S
N
O
N
N
N
D
N
AP
J F
N N
BV
J
Y
M
N
A
N
M
N
J
N
AN
00
A
N
S
N
O
N
N
N
D
N
AP
J F
N N
BV
J
Y
M
N
A
N
M
N
J
N
AN
00
A
N
S
N
O
N
N
N
D
N
AP
J F
N N
BV
J
Y
M
N
A
N
M
N
J
N
5. INDUSTRI
6. BEREAVEM
7. JURY DUT
8. WITHOUT
9. DIFFEREN
10. OTHER LE
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
99
99
4-35
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Accrual Schedules (AS) Master File
Figure 4-17: Add dialog box for the Accrual Schedule (AS) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Accrual Schedule (AS) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-15: Accrual Schedule (AS) master file
4-36
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Schedule Code
Required
Text (2 characters)
Copy From
Optional
Selection from List
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbr
Required
Text (8 characters)
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Absence Tracking Master Files
Absence Interface Rules (IR) Master File
Table 4-15: Accrual Schedule (AS) master file - continued
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Roll code
Required
Text (2 characters)
Accrues per year
Display
Numerals (2 digits)
Leave Groups (up to 20)
Required
Selection from List
Accrue for (J A S O N D J F M A M J)
Required
Selection from List
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
SAMPLE FOR DOCUMENTATION
J7878
PP1ABT
H.01.00
06/30/09 PAGE
1
Accrual schedules
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------Schedule code: 91 CERTIFICATED
Roll code: MO MONTHLY
Accrues per year: 12
Leave groups: 9R RS T7 1M 1R 1S 2C 2M 2R
J
Accrue for: Y
A
Y
S
N
O
N
N
N
D
N
J
N
F
N
M
N
A
N
M
N
J
N
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------Schedule code: CE CERTIFICATED
Roll code: AN ANNUALLY
Accrues per year: 1
Leave groups: 1R D1
J
Accrue for: Y
A
N
S
N
O
N
N
N
D
N
J
N
F
N
M
N
A
N
M
N
J
N
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------Schedule code: CL CLASSIFIED
Roll code: AR
Accrues per year:
Leave groups: 10 05 11 12 09
J
Accrue for: Y
A
N
S
N
O
N
N
N
D
N
J
N
F
N
M
N
A
N
M
N
J
N
Absence Interface Rules (IR) Master File
The instructions for this master file focus on the following areas:
♦
♦
♦
♦
General Instructions
Global Site
Global Leave Group
Site/Leave Group Rules
General Instructions
This heading describes the boxes for the Absence Interface Rules (IR) master file.
The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-37
Human Resources Master Files Manual
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
Global Site
Figure 4-18 illustrates the Add dialog box when you click Global Site under Record
Type.
Figure 4-18: Add dialog box for Absence Interface Rules master file (Global Site)
4-38
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Absence Tracking Master Files
Absence Interface Rules (IR) Master File
Table 4-16: Absence Interface Rules (IR) master file (Global Site)
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Record Type
Required
Selection from Option Buttons
Code
Required
Selection from List
Sites
Required
Selection from List
External site Number
Required
Numerals (4 digits)
Download Demographic Data?
Required
Selection from Option Buttons
Download employee Demographic Data?
Required
Selection from Option Buttons
Ignore employee work day?
Required
Selection from Option Buttons
Use mapping rules table?
Required
Selection from Option Buttons
From Hours
Required
Fixed Decimal Point (nn.nn)
To Hours
Required
Fixed Decimal Point (nn.nn)
Absence Days
Required
Fixed Decimal Point (nn.nn)
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-39
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Global Leave Group
Figure 4-19 illustrates the Add dialog box when you click Global Leave Group
under Record Type.
Figure 4-19: Add dialog box for Absence Interface Rules master file (Global Leave Group)
Table 4-17: Absence Interface Rules (IR) master file (Global Site)
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Record Type
Required
Selection from Option Buttons
Codes
Required
Selection from List
Leave Groups
Required
Selection from List
Use mapping rules table?
Required
Selection from Option Buttons
From Hours
Required
Fixed Decimal Point (nn.nn)
To Hours
Required
Fixed Decimal Point (nn.nn)
Absence Days
Required
Fixed Decimal Point (nn.nn)
Site/Leave Group Rules
Figure 4-20 illustrates the Add dialog box when you click Site/Leave Group under
Record Type.
4-40
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Absence Tracking Master Files
Absence Interface Rules (IR) Master File
Figure 4-20: Add dialog box for Absence Interface Rules master file (Site/Leave Groups)
Table 4-18: Absence Interface Rules (IR) master file (Site/Leave Group)
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Record Type
Required
Selection from Option Buttons
Codes
Required
Selection from List
Sites
Required
Selection from List
Leave Groups
Required
Selection from List
Download employee Demographic Data?
Required
Selection from Option Buttons
Ignore employee work day?
Required
Selection from Option Buttons
Use mapping rules table?
Required
Selection from Option Buttons
From Hours
Required
Fixed Decimal Point (nn.nn)
To Hours
Required
Fixed Decimal Point (nn.nn)
Absence Days
Required
Fixed Decimal Point (nn.nn)
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-41
Human Resources Master Files Manual
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
SAMPLE FOR DOCUMENTATION
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
J7879
PP1ABT
H.01.00
06/30/09 PAGE
1
Absence Interface rules
KEY
SOURCE EXT
LOAD LOAD IGNORE
USE - - HOURS MAP - - - DAYS MAP - DI/SITE/LG
SITE
SITE SITE EMPL MAX HRS MAP
FROM
TO
ABS
FROM
TO
ABS
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------82
Y
Y
Y
Y
24.50 25.00 25.00
4-42
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Absence Interface Rules (IR) Master File
Personnel Master Files
The Personnel folder contains the master files necessary for implementing Human
Resources, Position Control, Benefits Management, and Payroll. This heading lists
the master files and subfolders in the same order that they display in the tree view.
Table 4-19: Personnel master files
01/10
MASTER FILE
CODE
District Master
SUBFOLDER
LEVEL
PAGE
DP
County
4-44
Location
LOC
District
4-46
Location Org Levels Field
LOC
District
4-49
Bargaining Units
BU
District
4-50
Board Dates
BD
District
4-51
Certificate Level
CL
County
4-52
Certificate Types
CT
County
4-54
Comment Types
CO
District
4-55
Contract Types
CN
District
4-56
Control Groups
CG
District
4-57
County/State Codes
CS
County
4-59
Credentials
CR
Credentials
County
4-61
Credential Authorizations
CA
Credentials
County
4-62
Credential Renewals Codes
CW
Credentials
County
4-64
Credential Subject Codes
CB
Credentials
County
4-65
Credential Level Codes
CV
Credentials
County
4-66
Degree Type
DT
District
4-67
Employee Types
EM
District
4-69
Ethnic Codes
ET
County
4-70
Experience Type
ET
District
4-71
Freeze Placement Reasons
FP
District
4-73
Handicap
HA
District
4-74
Hospital codes
HO
District
4-75
Institutions (Colleges)
IN
District
4-77
Immunizations
IM
District
4-78
Inservice Ed Component
IE
District
4-79
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-43
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-19: Personnel master files - continued
MASTER FILE
CODE
Insurance Carrier
SUBFOLDER
LEVEL
PAGE
IC
District
4-81
Medical Codes
ME
District
4-82
Membership List
LM
District
Job Categories
JB
District
4-84
Job Codes
JC
District
4-85
Languages
LA
District
4-88
Program of Graduation
PG
District
4-89
Refusal Reason
RR
District
4-91
Seniority Class
SN
District
4-93
Skill Code
SK
District
4-95
Subject Codes
SU
District
4-96
Termination Code
TE
District
4-98
Test Master Codes
TM
District
4-100
PAF Category
PA
Personnel Action Files
District
4-101
PAF Actions
PF
Personnel Action Files
District
4-103
PAF Dictionary
PD
Personnel Action Files
County
4-104
Report Codes
RC
District
4-92
For additional lists of master files documented in the chapter, see:
♦ "Table 4-1: Master files by folder on tree view" on page 4-4
♦ "Table 4-2: Master files by name" on page 4-7
♦ "Table 4-3: Master files by code" on page 4-10
District Master (DP) Master File
This heading describes the boxes for the District Master (DP) master file. The instructions
for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
4-44
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
District Master (DP) Master File
Figure 4-21: Add dialog box for the District Master (DP) master file
Table 4-20: District Master (DP) master file
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
District Codes
Display
Selection from List
District Number
Key
Numeric Code (2 digits)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Address
Optional
Text (30 characters)
[address line 2]
Optional
Text (30 characters)
City
Optional
Text (18 characters)
State
Required
Selection from List
Zip
Optional
Text (10 characters)
SUI ID
Required
Text (8 characters)
FICA ID
Required
Text (14 characters)
Workers Comp Rate
Optional
Fixed Decimal Point (n.nnnn)
SIT ID
Required
Text (14 characters)
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-45
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-20: District Master (DP) master file - continued
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Ret-system 1/3 Option
Optional
Selection from List
Percent
Optional
Fixed Decimal Point (n.nnnn)
Ret-system 2/4 Option
Optional
Selection from List
Percent
Optional
Fixed Decimal Point (n.nnnn)
FICA Option
Required
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available in the QCC version. Use the
Report option in the traditional version of Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes (PP0010).
Locations (LOC) Master File
Figure 4-22: Add dialog: Add dialog box for the Locations (LOC) master file
4-46
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Locations (LOC) Master File
This heading describes the boxes for the Locations (LOC) master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-21: Locations (LOC) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Location Codes
Display
Selection from List
Location Number
Key
Numeric Code (4 digits)
Type
Required
Selection from List
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbrev
Required
Text (8 characters)
Street
Optional
Text (30 characters)
City
Optional
Text (30 characters)
State
Optional
Selection from List
Zip
Optional
Text (10 characters)
Contact
Optional
Text (30 characters)
Phone
Optional
Numerals (3-digit area code and 7-digit
phone number)
Ext
Optional
Numerals (4 digits)
Organization Levels
Optional
Selection from List
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-47
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Detail Format
07 QSS DEMONSTRATION DISTRICT
SAMPLE FOR DOCUMENTATION
J5826
LO0100
H.00.00
04/16/00
PAGE
LOCATION MASTER REPORT
NUMBER
TYPE
NAME
ABBREVIATION
----------------------------------------------------------------------0001
W
AMANDA JONES MIDDLE SCHOOL
AMANDA
100 MARSHALL STREET
REDWOOD CITY
CA
94063
WOODROW WILSON
PHONE: (415) 111-1111 EXT: 1111
0002
W
ASTER HEIGHTS SCHOOL
4003 ASTRA ROAD
REDWOOD CITY
ALEXANDRIA COPERNI
PHONE: (415) 111-1111
ASTER
CA
94063
EXT: 1111
0004
W
BARNES HIGH SCHOOL
1003 ALAMEDA DEL PUEBLO
REDWOOD CITY
ALEXANDER POPE
PHONE: (415) 111-1111
BARNES
CA
94063
EXT: 1111
0023
W
MAINTENANCE FACILTY NORT
1003 CENTER STREET
REDWOOD CITY
HECTOR TROY
PHONE: (415) 111-1111
MAINT N
CA
94063
EXT: 1111
0045
W
ADULT EDUCATION CENTER
1889 EXISTENTIAL WAY
REDWOOD CITY
JEAN-PAUL SARTRE
PHONE: (415) 111-1111
ADULT
CA
94063
EXT: 1111
0047
W
THOMAS PAINE ELEMENTARY
39 CONSTITUTION AV
REDWOOD CITY
THOMAS STARR KING
PHONE: (415) 111-1111
PAINE
CA
94063
EXT: 1111
Abbreviated Format
07 QSS DEMONSTRATION DISTRICT
SAMPLE FOR DOCUMENTATION
J5827
LO0100
H.00.00
04/16/00
PAGE
1
LOCATION MASTER REPORT
NUMBER
TYPE
NAME
ABBREVIATION
----------------------------------------------------------------------0001
W
AMANDA JONES MIDDLE SCHOOL
AMANDA
0002
W
ASTER HEIGHTS SCHOOL
ASTER
0004
W
BARNES HIGH SCHOOL
BARNES
0023
W
MAINTENANCE FACILTY NORT
MAINT N
0045
W
ADULT EDUCATION CENTER
ADULT
0047
W
THOMAS PAINE ELEMENTARY
PAINE
4-48
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Location Org Levels Fields (LO) Master File
Location Org Levels Fields (LO) Master File
Figure 4-23: Add dialog box for the Location Org Level Fields (LO) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Location Org Level Fields (LO) master file.
The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-22: Location Org Level Fields (LO) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Location Org Levels Code
Display
Selection from List
Code value
Optional
Text (30 characters)
Organization Levels Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Organization Levels Abbr
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available in the QCC version. Use the
Report option in the traditional version of Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes (PP0010).
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-49
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Bargaining Units (BU) Master File
Figure 4-24: Add dialog box for the Bargaining Units (BU) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Bargaining Units (BU) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-23: Bargaining Units (BU) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Code
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Numeric Code (2 digits)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
4-50
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Board Dates (BD) Master File
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
Sample for Documentation
J342
PP0100
Bargaining units
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------00 NONE
NONE
01 TEACHERS
TEACH
02 CLASSFIED
CSEA
03 MANAGEMENT
MGMT
04 CONFIDENTIAL
CONF
Board Dates (BD) Master File
Figure 4-25: Add dialog box for the Board Dates (BD) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Board Dates (BD) master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
01/10
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-51
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-24: Board Dates (BD) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Fiscal Year
Required
Fiscal Year
Board Dates (Maximum allowed: 50)
Required
Optional
Date (1 required, remaining 49 optional)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
Certificate Level (CL) Master File
Figure 4-26: Add dialog box for the Certificate Level (CL) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Certificate Level (CL) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
4-52
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Certificate Level (CL) Master File
Table 4-25: Certificate Level (CL) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Numeric Code (2 digits)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available in the QCC version. Use the
Report option in the traditional version of Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes (PP0010).
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
Sample for Documentation
J343
PP0100
Certificate level
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------00 MISSING
MISSING
01 PRESCHOOL
PRESCHOL
02 KINDERGARTEN - 3
K-3
03 KINDERGARTEN - 8
K-8
04 KINDERGARTEN - 9
K-9
05 KINDERGARTEN - 12
K-12
06 7 - 9
7-9
07 7 - 12
7-12
08 7 - 14
7-14
09 COMMUNITY COLLEGE
COM COLL
10 PRESCHOOL - ADULT
PRE-ADLT
11 ADULT
ADULT
12 VOCATIONAL
VOC ED
13 MIDDLE SCHOOL 5-8
MID 5-8
14 K-14
K-14
15 KINDERGARTEN - 6
K-6
16 SPECIAL CENTER
SPEC CTR
17 6 - 9
6 - 9
18 PRESCHOOL-3
PRE-3
20 9 & BELOW
k - 9
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-53
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Certificate Type (CT) Master File
Figure 4-27: Add dialog box for the Certificate Type (CT) Master File
This heading describes the boxes for the Certificate Type (CT) Master File. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-26: Certificate Type (CT) Master File
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Code
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (2 characters)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
4-54
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Comments Types (CO) Master File
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
Sample for Documentation
J344
PP0100
Certificate type
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
----------------------------------------------------------------------AN ANNUAL
ANNUAL
BR BOARD RESOLUTION
BD RES
CA COMMITTEE ON ASSIGNMENTS
COM/ASGN
CL CLEAR
CLEAR
EM EMERGENCY
EMERGNCY
EX EXPIRED
EXPIRED
IN INTERNSHIP
INTRNSHP
LA LIMITED ASSIGNMENT AUTH.
LIM AUTH
LD LIFE DEPENDENT
LIFE DEP
LE LIMITED ASSIGNMENT EMERGENCY
LIM/EMER
LI LIFE CREDENTIAL
LIFE CRD
NK NOT KNOWN
NOTK
P1 PRELIMINARY 1 YEAR
PREL 1YR
P2 PRELIMINARY 2 YEAR
P2
P3 PRELIMINARY 3 YEAR
PREL 3YR
P4 PRELIMINARY 4 YEAR
P4
P5 PRELIMINARY 5 YEAR
PREL 5YR
PA PARTIAL
PARTIAL
PC PROFESSIONAL CLEAR
PROF CLR
PP POSTPONEMENT
POSTPONE
PR PROFESSIONAL (ADMIN)
PROFESS
PV PROVISIONAL
PV
RE REGULAR
RE
TC TEMPORARY COUNTY CERTIFICATE
TEMP CRT
WA WAIVER
WAIVER
Comments Types (CO) Master File
Figure 4-28: Add dialog box for the Comments Types (CO) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Comments Types (CO) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
01/10
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-55
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-27: Comments Types (CO) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (2 characters)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
Sample for Documentation
Comment type
J345
PP0100
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------AB ABSENCE COMMENTS
ABT
CD Credential Comment
Cred
MA Main Demographic comments
MA
PR Payroll screen comments
PR
TE Termination comments
TE
Contract Types (CN) Master File
Figure 4-29: Add dialog box for the Contract Types (CN) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Contract Types (CN) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
4-56
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
Control Groups (CG) Master File
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-28: Contract Types (CN) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (2 characters)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
Sample for Documentation
J346
PP0100
Contract type
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------0
NONE
NONE
1
TEACHERS
APLE
2
CLASSFIED
CSEA
3
MANAGEMENT
MGMT
4
CONFIDENTIAL
CONF
Control Groups (CG) Master File
Figure 4-30: Add dialog box for the Control Groups (CG) master file
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-57
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
This heading describes the boxes for the Control Groups (CG) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-29: Control Groups (CG) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (4 characters)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the v ALT+LEFT ARROW.
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
Sample for Documentation
J347
PP0100
Control group
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------0002 GROUP 2
GRP 2
1
THE 1 CONTROL GROUP
1 CG
TEST TEST CONTROL GROUP
TEST
4-58
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
County/State Codes (CS)
County/State Codes (CS)
Figure 4-31: Add dialog box for the County/State Codes (CS) Master File
This heading describes the boxes for the County/State Codes (CS) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-30: County/State Codes (CS) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (2 characters)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-59
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
Sample for Documentation
J348
PP0100
Country/state codes
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
TYPE
-------------------------------------------------------------------------AK ALASKA
ALASKA
ST
AL ALABAMA
ALABAMA
ST
AP AP
AP
ST
AR ARKANSAS
ARKANSAS
ST
AS AMERICAN SAMOA
SAMOA
ST
AZ ARIZONA
AZ
ST
CA CALIFORNIA
CA
ST
CO COLORADO
COLORADO
ST
CT CONNECTICUT
CONN
ST
DC DISTRICT OF COLUMBIA
DC
ST
DE DELAWARE
DELAWARE
ST
FL FLORIDA
FLORIDA
ST
GA GEORGIA
GEORGIA
ST
GU GUAM
GUAM
ST
HI HAWAII
HI
ST
IA IOWA
IA
ST
ID IDAHO
IDAHO
ST
IL ILLINOIS
ILLINOIS
ST
IN INDIANA
INDIANA
ST
KS KANSAS
KANSAS
ST
KY KENTUCKY
KENTUCKY
ST
LA LOUISIANA
LOUISANA
ST
MA MASSACHUSETTS
MASS
ST
MD MARYLAND
MARYLAND
ST
ME MAINE
MAINE
ST
MF ANY STATE/COUNTRY
ANY/STAT
ST
MI MICHIGAN
MICH
ST
MN MINNESOTA
MINN
ST
MO MISSOURI
MISSOURI
ST
MS MISSISSIPPI
MISS
ST
MT MONTANA
MONTANA
ST
NC NORTH CAROLINA
NO CAROL
ST
ND NORTH DAKOTA
N DAKOTA
ST
NE NEBRASKA
NEBRASKA
ST
NH NEW HAMPSHIRE
N HAMPSH
ST
NJ NEW JERSEY
N JERSEY
ST
NM NEW MEXICO
NM
ST
NV NEVADA
NV
ST
NY NEW YORK
NEW YORK
ST
OH OHIO
OHIO
ST
OK OKLAHOMA
OKLA
ST
OR OREGON
OR
ST
PA PENNSYLVANNIA
PENN
ST
PR PUERTO RICO
P RICO
ST
RI RHODE ISLAND
RHODE IS
ST
SC SOUTH CAROLINA
SO CAROL
ST
SD SOUTH DAKOTA
S DAKOTA
ST
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
Sample for Documentation
J348
PP0100
Country/state codes
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
2
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
TYPE
-------------------------------------------------------------------------TN TENNESSEE
TENN
ST
TT FED STATES OF MICRONESIA
MICRONES
ST
TX TEXAS
TX
ST
US UNITED STATES OF AMERICA
USA
CO
UT UTAH
UT
ST
VA VIRGINIA
VIRGINIA
ST
VI VIRGIN ISLANDS
VIRGIN I
ST
VT VERMONT
VERMONT
ST
WA WASHINGTON
WA
ST
WI WISCONSIN
WIS
ST
WV WEST VIRGINIA
W VIRGIN
ST
WY WYOMING
WYOMING
ST
XX ANY-STATE/COUNTRY
ANYST/CO
ST
4-60
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Credentials Subfolder
Credentials Subfolder
This subfolder includes the following master files:
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
Credentials (CR) Master File
Credential Authorizations (CA) Master File
Credential Renewal Codes (CW) Master File
Credential Subject Codes (CB) Master File
Credential Level Codes (CV) Master File
Credentials (CR) Master File
Figure 4-32: Add dialog box for the Credentials (CR) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Credentials (CR) master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
01/10
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-61
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-31: Credentials (CR) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Credential Code
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (8 characters)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
Certificate Type
Required
Selection from List
Certificate Level
Required
Selection from List
Authorized Teaching Subjects
Optional
Selection from List
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available in the QCC version. Use the
Report option in the traditional version of Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes (PP0010).
Credential Authorizations (CA) Master File
Figure 4-33: Add dialog box for the Credential Authorizations (CA) master file
4-62
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Credentials Subfolder
This heading describes the boxes for the Credential Authorizations (CA) master file.
The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-32: Credential Authorizations (CA) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Credential Authorization Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code value
Key
Text (4 characters case sensitive)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Optional
Text (8 characters)
Lock
Required
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Expanded Descriptions
Optional
Text (96 lines with 60 characters each)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available in the QCC version. Use the
Report option in the traditional version of Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes (PP0010).
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-63
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Credential Renewal Codes (CW) Master File
Figure 4-34: Add dialog box for the Credential Renewal Codes (CW) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Credential Renewal Codes (CW) master file.
The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-33: Credential Renewal Codes (CW) master file
4-64
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Credential Authorization Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code value
Key
Text (4 characters case sensitive)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Optional
Text (8 characters)
Lock
Required
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Expanded Descriptions
Optional
Text (96 lines with 60 characters each)
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Credentials Subfolder
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available in the QCC version. Use the
Report option in the traditional version of Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes (PP0010).
Credential Subject Codes (CB) Master File
Figure 4-35: Add dialog box for the Credential Subject Codes (CB) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Credential Subject Codes (CB) master file.
The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
01/10
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-65
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-34: Credential Subject Codes (CB) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Credential Subject Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code value
Key
Text (4 characters case sensitive)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Optional
Text (8 characters)
Lock
Required
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Expanded Descriptions
Optional
Text (96 lines with 60 characters each)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available in the QCC version. Use the
Report option in the traditional version of Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes (PP0010).
Credential Level Codes (CV) Master File
o
Figure 4-36: Add dialog box for the Credential Level Codes (CB) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Credential Level Codes (CB) master file.
The instructions for maintaining records are 7in Chapter 2.
4-66
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
Degree Type (DT) Code
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-35: Credential Level Codes (CB) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Credential Level Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code value
Key
Text (2 characters case sensitive)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Optional
Text (8 characters)
Lock
Required
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Expanded Descriptions
Optional
Text (96 lines with 60 characters each)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available in the QCC version. Use the
Report option in the traditional version of Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes (PP0010).
Degree Type (DT) Code
Figure 4-37: Add dialog box for the Degree Type (DT) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Degree Type (DT) master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-67
Human Resources Master Files Manual
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-36: Degree Type (DT) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (2 characters case sensitive)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
Sample for Documentation
J349
PP0100
Degree types
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------BA BACHELOR OF ARTS
BA
MA MASTER OF ARTS
MA
MS MASTER OF SCIENCE
MS
OT Other
Other
PH DOCTORATE
PHD
4-68
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Employee Types (EM) Master File
Employee Types (EM) Master File
Figure 4-38: Add dialog box for the Employee Types (EM) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Employee Types (EM) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
Table 4-37: Employee Types (EM) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (2 characters)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-69
Human Resources Master Files Manual
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
Sample for Documentation
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
J350
PP0100
Employee type
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------A1 CE TENURE
TENURE
A2 CE HOME TEACHER
HOME TCH
A3 CE TEMPORARY
CE TEMP
A4 CE PROBATION
CE PROB
A5 CE MANAGEMENT
CE MGMT
A8 FMLA LEAVE
FMLA LVE
A9 LEAVE OF ABSENCE
LVE ABS
B1 CL FULL TIME
CL FULL
B2 CLASSIFIED >= 50% FTE
CL>=50%
B3 CL <50% FTE
CL <50%
B4 CL CONFIDENTIAL
CL CONFD
B5 CLASSIFIED MANAGEMENT
CL MGMT
B8 FMLA LEAVE
FMLA LVE
CA COBRA CERTIFICATED BENEFITS
COBRA A
CB COBRA CLASSIFIED BENEFITS
COBRA B
SA SUBS-CERTIFICATED
CE SUBS
SB SUBS-CLASSIFIED
CL SUBS
SH SUB-CERT HOURLY
CE HRLY
SR RETIREE SUBBING
CRTSUB-R
Ethnic Codes (ET) Code Master Files
Figure 4-39: Add dialog box for the Ethnic Codes (ET) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Ethnic Codes (ET) master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
4-70
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Experience Types (ET) Master Files
Table 4-38: Ethnic Codes (ET) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (2 characters)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
Sample for Documentation
J351
PP0100
Ethnic codes
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------AS ASIAN
ASIAN
BL BLACK
BLACK
FI FILIPINO
FILIPINO
HI HISPANIC
HISPANIC
IN AMERICAN INDIAN
INDIAN
NO NO ANSWER TO ETHNIC QUERY
NOANSWER
OT Other
Other
PI PACIFIC ISLANDER
Pac
WH WHITE
WHITE
Experience Types (ET) Master Files
Figure 4-40: Add dialog box for the Experience Types (ET) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Experience Types (ET) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-71
Human Resources Master Files Manual
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-39: Experience Types (ET) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (2 characters upshifted)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
Sample for Documentation
J352
PP0100
Experience type
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------AD ADMISTRATIVE
ADMIN
DP DATA-PROCESSING
DATA PRO
DR BUS DRIVER
BUS DRVR
EL ELEMENTARY SCHOOL
ELEM SCH
HS HIGH SCHOOL
HIGH SCH
MS MIDDLE SCHOOL
MID SCH
T1 TEACHING 1-4 YEARS
TEACH-4
T5 TEACHING +5 YEARS
TEACH+5
4-72
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Freeze Placement Reasons (FP)
Freeze Placement Reasons (FP)
Figure 4-41: Add dialog box for the Freeze Placement Reasons (FP) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Freeze Placement Reasons (FP) master file.
The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-40: Freeze Placement Reasons (FP) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (2 characters upshifted)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available in the QCC version. Use the
Report option in the traditional version of Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes (PP0010).
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-73
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Handicap (HA) Master File
Figure 4-42: Add dialog box for the Handicap (HA) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Handicap (HA) master file. The instructions
for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-41: Handicap (HA) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (4 characters upshifted)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
4-74
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
Sample for Documentation
Handicap
Hospital Codes (HO) Master File
J354
PP0100
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------1
BLIND/SIGHT IMPAIRED
BLD/SIGT
2
DEAF/HEARING IMPARIED
DEAF
Hospital Codes (HO) Master File
Figure 4-43: Add dialog box for the Hospital Codes (HO) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Hospital Codes (HO) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
01/10
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-75
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-42: Hospital Codes (HO) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Hospital Codes
Display
Selection from List
Hospital Code
Key
Text (4 characters case sensitive)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbr
Optional
Text (8 characters)
City
Optional
Text (30 characters)
State
Optional
Selection from List
Zip
Optional
Text (10 characters)
Adm. Phone
Optional
Numerals (3-digit area code and 7-digit
phone number with no hyphen)
Em. Phone
Optional
Numerals (3-digit area code and 7-digit
phone number with no hyphen)
Contact Phone
Optional
Numerals (3-digit area code and 7-digit
phone number with no hyphen)
Contact Person
Optional
Text (20 characters)
Comments
Optional
Text (30 characters)
Type
Optional
Selection from List
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available in the QCC version. Use the
Report option in the traditional version of Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes (PP0010).
4-76
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Institutions (Colleges) (IN) Master File
Institutions (Colleges) (IN) Master File
Figure 4-44: Add dialog box for the Institutions (Colleges) (IN) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Institutions (Colleges) (IN) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-43: Institutions (Colleges) (IN) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Numeric Code
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
State
Optional
Text (2 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-77
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
Sample for Documentation
J355
PP0100
Institutions (Colleges)
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
STATE
-------------------------------------------------------------------------000000 OTHER INSTITUTIONS
OTH INST
CA
000001 SONOMA STATE
SONSTATE
CA
000003 SACRAMENTO STATE
SACST
CA
000004 UNIV OF CALIF DAVIS
UCDAV
CA
000005 CAL STATE UNIV EAST BAY
CSUEB
CA
000006 UNIV OF CALIF BERKELEY
UCBERK
CA
000007 UNIV OF CALIF SAN FRANCISCO
UCSF
CA
000008 SAN FRANCISCO STATE
SFSTATE
CA
000009 STANFORD UNIVERSITY
STAN
CA
000010 SAN JOSE STATE
SJSTATE
CA
Immunization (IM) Master File
Figure 4-45: Add dialog box for the Immunizations (IM) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Immunizations (IM) master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
4-78
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Inservice Ed Component (IE) Master File
Table 4-44: Immunizations (IM) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (4 characters upshifted)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
Sample for Documentation
J356
PP0100
Immunization
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------HEPA HEPATITIS A
HEP A
HEPB HEPATITIS B
HEP B
HEPC HEPATITIS C
HEPC
IM1
TESITNG IM 1
TEST IM1
TB
TUBERCULOSIS
TUB
Inservice Ed Component (IE) Master File
Figure 4-46: Add dialog box for the Inservice Ed Component (IE) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Inservice Ed Component (IE) master file.
The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-79
Human Resources Master Files Manual
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-45: Inservice Ed Component (IE) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Numeric Code (8 digits)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
Max Hours
Optional
Text (4 digits)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
Sample for Documentation
J357
PP0100
Inservice ed component
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
------------------------------------------------------------------------00082900 BACK TO SCHOOL - SPEC ED
SPEC ED
01010701 GOVERNOR'S PROPOSED BUDG
GOVR BUD
01020301 CLASSROOM CLEANING TECHN
CLS TECH
01091500 USING THEATER IN CLASSRO
THEATER
01111500 COUNTY-WIDE INSERVICE DA
COUNTYDA
4-80
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Insurance Carrier (IC) Master File
Insurance Carrier (IC) Master File
Figure 4-47: Add dialog box for the Insurance Carrier (IC) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Insurance Carrier (IC) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-46: Insurance Carrier (IC) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (4 characters upshifted)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-81
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
Sample for Documentation
J359
PP0100
Insurance carrier
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
MAX HOURS
-------------------------------------------------------------------------BLUE Blue Cross
BlueCr
DEAM
DLTA Delta Dental
Delta
DEAM
FIDO Security Fidelity Assurance
Secfid
DEAM
KAIS Kaiser Northern California
Kaiser
DEAM
SUTT Sutter Health Care Foundation
Sutter
DEAM
Medical Codes (ME) Master File
Figure 4-48: Add dialog box for the Medical Codes (ME) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Medical Codes (ME) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-47: Medical Codes (ME) master file
4-82
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (4 characters upshifted)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Membership List (LM) Master File
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
12 QSS*DEMONSTRATION*DISTRICT
Sample for Documentation
J360
PP0100
Medical codes
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------1112 MEDICAL 1112
MED1112
BRET TEST
TEST
DIAB DIABETES
DIABETES
DROP DROPSY
DROPSY
EPIL EPILEPSY
EPILE
Membership List (LM) Master File
Figure 4-49: Add dialog box for the Membership List (LM) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Membership List (LM) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available. You can use the Grid
Output command to get a listing of codes.
♦ For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-83
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-48: Membership List (LM) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (6 characters)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
Misc Flags
Optional
Text (10 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
Job Categories (JB) Master File
Figure 4-50: Add dialog box for the Job Categories (JB) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Job Categories (JB) master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
4-84
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Job Codes (JC) Master File
Table 4-49: Job Categories (JB) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Numeric Code (4 digits)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
12 QSS*DEMONSTRATION*DISTRICT
Sample for Documentation
J362
PP0100
Job categories
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------0001 SUPERINTENDENT
SUPT
0002 CERTIFICATED ADMINISTRATORS
CERT ADM
0004 CONFIDENTIAL SUPERVISORY
CONF SUP
0005 TEACHERS
TEACHERS
0006 COUNSELOR/PSYCHOLIGIST/NURSE
CN/P/NRS
0007 FOOD SERVICE
FD SERV
0008 MAINTEN/OPER/TRANSPORTATION
MOT
0010 CLERICAL
CLERICAL
0011 INSTRUCTIONAL AIDES
INST AID
0012 SUBSTITUTE TEACHER
SUB TCHR
0013 SUBSTITUTE INSTRUCTIONAL AIDE
SUB AIDE
0014 OTHER CLASSIFIED
OTH CLS
0015 OTHER CLASSIFIED SUBS/EXTRAS
SUB/XTRA
Job Codes (JC) Master File
General Instructions
This heading describes the boxes for the Job Codes (JC) master file. The instructions
for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Code Definition and Credentials/Education Tab
When the dialog box for the Job Codes (JC) master file opens, the Credentials/Education tab is the active tab. You can click the other two tabs to make one of them the
active tab.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-85
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Figure 4-51: Code definition and Credentials/Education tab for the Job Codes (JC) master file
Table 4-50: Job Codes (JC) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Job Codes
Display
Selection from List
Job Code
Key
Numeric Code
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
EEO(1)
Optional
Text (6 characters)
EEO(2)
Optional
Text (6 characters)
Required
Optional
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Code
Optional
Selection from List
Required
Optional
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Degree Type
Optional
Selection from List
Program
Optional
Selection from List
Credentials
Education
4-86
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Job Codes (JC) Master File
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
Subject/Skills Tab
Figure 4-52: Subjects/Skills tab for the Job Codes (JC) master file
Table 4-51: Job Codes (JC) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Required
Optional
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Code
Optional
Selection from List
Required
Optional
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Code
Optional
Selection from List
Subjects
Skills
Test Information/Experience Tab
Figure 4-53: Test Information/Experience tab for the Job Codes master file
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-87
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-52: Job Codes (JC) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Required
Optional
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Code
Optional
Selection from List
Required
Optional
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Code
Optional
Selection from List
Test Information
Experience
Sample Master File Report
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available in the QCC version. Use the
Report option in the traditional version of Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes (PP0010).
Language Codes (LA) Master File
Figure 4-54: Add dialog box for the Language Codes (LA) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Language Codes (LA) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
4-88
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Program of Graduation (PG) Master File
Table 4-53: Language Codes (LA) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (2 characters upshifted)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
QSS DEMONSTRATION DISTRICT
Sample for Documentation
J363
PP0100
Language codes
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------BA BASQUE
BASQUE
CA CANTONESE
CANTONES
EN ENGLISH
ENGLISH
JA JAPANESE
JAPANESE
MA MANX
MANX
SP SPANISH
SPANISH
TA TAGALOG
TAGALOG
Program of Graduation (PG) Master File
Figure 4-55: Add dialog box for the Program of Graduation (PG) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Program of Graduation (PG) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-89
Human Resources Master Files Manual
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-54: Program of Graduation (PG) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Numeric Code (4 digits)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
12 QSS*DEMONSTRATION*DISTRICT
Sample for Documentation
J379
PP0100
Program of graduation
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------0001 BUSINESS EDUCATION
BUS ED
0002 PUBLIC SPEAKEING
PUB SPK
0003 PHYSICAL EDUCATION
PE
0004 HEALTH EDUCATION
HE
0005 DRIVER TRAINING
DRIVE
0006 ENGLISH
ENGLISH
0007 SPANISH
SPANISH
0008 PHILOSPHY
PHIL
0009 LIBRARY SCIENCE
LIBRARY
0010 ZOOLOGY
ZOOLOGY
0011 SCIENCE EDUCATION
SCIENCE
4-90
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Refusal Reason (RR) Master File
Refusal Reason (RR) Master File
Figure 4-56: Add dialog box for the Refusal Reason (RR) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Refusal Reason (RR) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-55: Refusal Reason (RR) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (2 characters)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-91
Human Resources Master Files Manual
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
Sample for Documentation
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
J367
PP0100
Refusal reason
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------1
REFUSE
REFU
AS ASSIGNMENT NOT PREFERRED
ASSIGN
BE BENEFITS NOT ADEQUATE
BENEFITS
HE HEALTH REASONS
HEALTH
HR HOURS NOT ADEQUATE
HOURS
OJ ACCEPTED ANOTHER JOB
OTHERJOB
SA SALARY NOT ADEQUATE
SALARY
SC SCHEDULE CONFLICT
SCHEDCON
Report Codes (RC) Master File
Figure 4-57: Add dialog box for the Report Codes (RC) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Report Codes (RC) master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
4-92
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Seniority Class (SN) Master File
Table 4-56: Report Codes (RC) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Numeric Code (2 digits)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
Sample for Documentation
J375
PP0100
Report codes
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------00 UNKNOWN
UNKNOWN
10 CERTIFICATED
CE
20 CLASSIFIED
CL
Seniority Class (SN) Master File
Figure 4-58: Add dialog box for the Seniority Class (SN) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Seniority Class (SN) master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-93
Human Resources Master Files Manual
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-57: Seniority Class (SN) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (2 character upshifted)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
07 QSS DEMONSTRATION DISTRICT
Sample for Documentation
J381
PP0100
Seniority class
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------01 ACCOUNT CLERK I
ACTCLKI
02 ACCOUNT CLERK II
ACTCLKII
03 ATTENDANCE CLERK I
ATNCLKI
04 ATTENDANCE CLERK II
ATNCLKII
05 CAMPUS SUPERVISOR
CAMPSUP
06 CAREER CENTER ADVISOR
CARADV
07 COMMUITY LIAIASON
COMLIA
08 COMPUTER DATA PROCESSOR
COMP-DP
09 CUSTODIAN, HEAD 1
CUSHDI
10 CUSTODIAN, HEAD II
CUSHDII
11 CUSTODIAN I
CUSTI
12 CUSTODIAN II
CUSTII
37 SECRETARY I
SECT I
4-94
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Skill Codes (SK) Master File
Skill Codes (SK) Master File
Figure 4-59: Add dialog box for the Sill Codes (SK) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Sill Codes (SK) master file. The instructions
for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-58: Skill Codes (SK) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (4 characters upshifted)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-95
Human Resources Master Files Manual
07 QSS DEMONSTRATION DISTRICT
Sample for Documentation
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
J384
PP0100
Skill codes
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------APE
ADAPTIVE PE
APE
BADM BADMINTON COACH
BADMINTN
BASE BASKETBALL COACH
BASKETBA
CLUB SPECIAL INTEREST CLUBS
CLUB
CO
COMPUTER OPERATOR
CO
NURS NURSE
NURSE
SOCC SOCCER COACH
SOCC
SOFT SOFTBALL COACH
SOFT
SPED SPECIAL EDUCATION
SPEC ED
Subject Codes (SU) Master File
Figure 4-60: Add dialog box for the Subject Codes (SU) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the xxx master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
4-96
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Subject Codes (SU) Master File
Table 4-59: Subject Codes (SU) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Numeric Code (4 digits)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
07 QSS DEMONSTRATION DISTRICT
Sample for Documentation
J382
PP0100
Subject codes
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------0001 CBEST WAIVER
CBEST WA
0023 ACCOUNTING
ACCNTING
0028 ACCIDENT PREVENTION
ACC PREV
0030 ADAPTIVE PE SPECIALIZATION
ADAPT PE
0034 Adult Basic Education
Adult Ed
0035 ADULT CITIZENSHIP
ADLT CIT
0067 AGRICULTURE
AGRICLTR
0068 AGRICULTURE SERVICES & PROCESS
AG SRVCS
0069 AGRICULTURAL MECHANICS
AG MECH
0070 AGRICULTURE MANAGEMENT
AG MGT
0099 ACCOUNTING
ACCT
0122 ALGEBRA
ALGEBRA
0125 ALL SUBJECTS
ALL SUBJ
0133 AMERICAN GOVERNMENT & POLITICS
AM GVNMT
0144 ANIMAL PRODUCTION
ANML PRD
0147 ANIMAL SCIENCE
ANML SCI
0151 ANTHROPOLOGY
ANTHRO
0170 ANY K-8 SUBJECT
K-8 SUBJ
0188 ARCHITECTURAL, ENGINEERNG TECH
ARCH/ENG
0189 ARCHITECTURE
ARCH
0194 ART
ART
0195 ART AND DESIGN, WITH PHOTOGPHY
ART/DSGN
0196 ART APPRECIATION AND THEORY
ART APPR
0197 Arts and Crafts
Art/Crft
0198 ART HISTORY
ART HIST
0203 ASTRONOMY
ASTRNOMY
0221 AUDIOLOGY
AUDIOLGY
0227 Automotive & Power Mechanics
Auto/Mch
0250 BAND
BAND
0301 BANKING AND FINANCE
BANK/FIN
0303 Basic Skills
Basic sk
0304 Basic Education
Basic Ed
0305 BASIC
BASIC
0388 BIOLOGICAL SCIENCES
BIO SCI
0389 BIOLOGY
BIOLOGY
0422 BLIND
BLIND
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-97
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Termination Code (TE) Master File
Figure 4-61: Add dialog box for the Termination Code (TE) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Termination Code (TE) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-60: Termination Code (TE) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (2 characters upshifted)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
4-98
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Termination Code (TE) Master File
07 QSS DEMONSTRATION DISTRICT
Sample for Documentation
J383
PP0100
Termination codes
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------01 MOVED
MOVED
02 MARRIED
MARRIED
03 PREGNANCY
PREGNANC
04 NEEDED AT HOME
NEED/HOM
05 QUIT WITHOUT NOTICE
Q W/O NT
06 SICKNESS
SICKNESS
07 INJURED
INJURED
08 STARTED OWN BUSINESS
OWN BUSI
09 RETURN TO OLD JOB
RET OJOB
10 SEEK BETTER JOB testing
SK BRJOB
11 MILITARY SERVICE
MILITARY
12 RETURN TO SCHOOL
RET SCH
13 DIFFICULT TRANSPORTATION
NO TRANS
14 RATE OF PAY
PAY RATE
15 RATE ADJUSTMENTS
RT ADJ
16 OBJECTED TO HOURS
OBJ HOUR
17 OBJECTED TO SCHEDULE
OBJ SCHD
18 OBJECTED TO SHIFT
OBJ SHFT
19 OBJECTED TO OVERTIVE
OBJ OVTM
20 UNPLEASANT WORKING CONDITIONS
UNP WKCD
21 UNSETTLED GRIEVANCES
UNS GREV
22 TOO HARD
TOO HARD
23 TO MUCH TO LEARN
MCH LRN
24 TOO MUCH RESPONSIBILITY
MCH RESP
25 NO SECURITY
NO SECUR
26 NO FUTURE
NO FUTRE
27 NO JOB SATISFACTION
NO JBSAT
28 DISLIKED SUPERVISOR
DSLK SPV
29 DISLIKED EMPLOYEES
DSL EMPE
30 JOB ELIMINATED
JOB ELIM
31 TEMPORARY LAYOFF
TEMP LAF
32 TEMPORARY OF RELIEF EMPLOYMENT
TEMP EMP
33 EXCESSIVE ABSENTEEISM
EXC ABST
34 EXCESSIVE TARDINESS
EXC TARD
35 INSUBORDINATION
INSUBDTN
36 WILLFUL VIOLATION OF DIST RULE
VIOL RUL
37 WILLFUL CARELESSNESS OR NEG
CRLS/NEG
38 DISGRD OF FAILRE CARRYOUT INST
DISG INS
39 UNEXCUSED ABSENCE FROM WORK
UNEX ABS
40 MALINGERING ON THE JOB
MALG JOB
41 AT WORK IN IMPROPER CONDITION
IMP COND
42 POOR WORK PERFORMANCE-UNSAFTY
POOR WRK
43 INABILITY TO WORK (HEALTH)
INABL WK
44 OFF-DUTY MISCONDUCT AFFECT JOB
O/D MSCD
45 OTHER (INCLUDING DISHONESTY)
OTHERS
46 VOLUNTARY RET W/PENSION
VOL W/PE
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-99
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Test Master Codes (TM) Master File
Figure 4-62: Add dialog box for the Test Master Codes (TM) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Test Master Codes (TM) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-61: Test Master Codes (TM) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (4 characters upshifted)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
4-100
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Personnel Action Files
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
Sample for Documentation
J374
PP0100
Test master codes
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------10KY TEN-KEY SPEED TEST
TEN-KEY
BUS
BUS DRIVER'S TEST
BUS DRVR
ENG
ENGLISH-INST. AIDE TEST
ENG-I.A.
MATH MATH-INST. AIDE TEST
TESTING
MATH I.A
RDG
READING-INST. AIDE TEST
RDG-I.A.
TEST TESTING
TESTING
TYPE TYPING TEST
TYPING
Personnel Action Files
The Personnel Action Files folder includes the following master files:
♦ PAF Category (PA) Master File
♦ PAF Actions (PF) Master File
♦ PAF Dictionary (PD) Master File
PAF Category (PA) Master File
Figure 4-63: Add dialog box for the PAF Category (PA) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the PAF Category (PA)PAF Category (PA) master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-101
Human Resources Master Files Manual
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-62: PAF Category (PA) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
PAF Category Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code value
Key
Text (2 characters case sensitive)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbr
Required
Text (8 characters)
Check Each Distribution Group to Receive
PAF
Required
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Print Preset Data on PAF?
Required
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available in the QCC version. Use the
Report option in the traditional version of Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes (PP0010).
4-102
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Personnel Master Files
Personnel Action Files
PAF Actions (PF) Master File
Figure 4-64: Add dialog box for the PAF Actions (PF) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the PAF Actions (PF) master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-63: PAF Actions (PF) master file
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
PAF Action Code
Display
Selection from List
PAF Action
Key
Text (4 characters case sensitive)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbr
Required
Text (8 characters)
Additional Description
Optional
Text (150 characters)
Board Agenda Locator
Optional
Selection from List
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-103
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-63: PAF Actions (PF) master file - continued
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
PAF Category
Required
Selection from List
Field Name
Optional
Selection from List
PAF Title
Optional
Text (24 characters)
Field Description
Display
Based on Field Name selection
Additional Fields to Report
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available in the QCC version. Use the
Report option in the traditional version of Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes (PP0010).
PAF Dictionary (PD) Master File
As of July 2009, the PAF Dictionary (PD) master file is locked. The grid displays
records created with the traditional program Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes
(PP0010). You cannot inspect or maintain this master file from the HR Code Maintenance window.
4-104
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Personnel Action Files
Payroll Master Files
The Payroll folder contains the master files for the Payroll System. This heading lists
the master files and subfolders in the same order that they display in the tree view.
Table 4-64: Master files for the Payroll folder
01/10
MASTER FILE
CODE
Pay Codes
SUBFOLDER
LEVEL
PAGE
PC
County
4-106
Payroll Names
PYN
County
4-107
Pay Schedules
PS
County
4-109
Pay Types
PT
County
4-111
Retirement Systems
RS
County
4-113
Retirement Edits
RE
County
4-114
Payroll Profiles
PP
District
4-116
Statutory Deduction Codes
SD
Statutory Deductions
County
4-118
Statutory Deduction Profiles
SP
Statutory Deductions
County
4-119
Deduction Schedules
DS
County
4-121
Deduction Rate Table
DR
District
4-123
Bonus Code
BC
District
4-125
Payroll Edit Rule
PE
District
4-127
Deduction Rule Code
PR
District
4-128
SMF Status Codes
SM
District
4-129
Pending Retirement Status Codes
PN
District
4-131
Vol-ded Frequency Codes
VF
County
4-132
Voluntary Deductions
VD
County
4-133
Benefit Control
BCT
County
4-135
Benefit Object Maps
OMAP
District
4-136
Benefit H/W Maps
VMAP
District
4-138
Benefit Group Maps
GMAP
District
4-139
Federal Income Tax
TT01
Tax Tables
County
4-140
OASDI/Medicare
TT03
Tax Tables
County
4-140
Workers Compensation
TT05
Tax Tables
District
4-140
SUI California
TT07
Tax Tables
County
4-140
PERS California
TT08
Tax Tables
County
4-140
STRS California
TT09
Tax Tables
County
4-140
California Retirement Setup
TT10
Tax Tables
County
4-140
California State Disability Insurance
TT11
Tax Tables
County
4-140
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-105
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
For additional lists of master files documented in the chapter, see:
♦ "Table 4-1: Master files by folder on tree view" on page 4-4
♦ "Table 4-2: Master files by name" on page 4-7
♦ "Table 4-3: Master files by code" on page 4-10
Pay Codes (PC) Master File
Figure 4-65: Add dialog box for the Pay Codes (PC) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Pay Codes (PC) master file. The instructions
for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-65: Pay Codes (PC) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Numeric Code (2 digits)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
4-106
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Payroll Name (PYN) Master File
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
Sample for Documentation
J376
PP0100
Pay codes
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------00 NO CODE
NO CODE
01 CERTIFICATED
C1
02 CLASSIFIED
CLASS
03 CERTIFICATED SUPPLEMENTAL
CERT.SUP
04 CLASSIFIED SUPPLEMENTAL
CL SUPP
05 CLASSIFIED NON-MEMBERS
CLASSNON
06 CLASSIFIED STRS MEMBERS
CLASSTRS
07 STUDENTS
STUDENTS
08 BOARD MEMBERS
BOARD
09 RETIREES
RETIREES
Payroll Name (PYN) Master File
Figure 4-66: Add dialog box for the Payroll Name (PYN) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Payroll Name (PYN) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦ For inspecting, see page 2-23.
♦ For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
♦ For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-107
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
♦ For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
♦ For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-66: Payroll Name (PYN) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Payroll Name Codes
Display
Selection from List
Fiscal Year
Key
Fiscal Year
Pay Name
Key
Text (6 characters)
Cancel direct deposit (APD)?
Required
Selection from List
Ignore W4 special tax rule?
Selection from List
User-defined fields
Selection from List
PAYROLL NAME and DEFERRED PAY
SCHEDULE tabs
Pay-Sch (Pay Schedules)
Required
Optional
Selection from List
First required for SCHEDULE NAME or
DEFERRED PAY SCHEDULE tabs.
The remaining Pay-Sch boxes are
optional.
Description
Display
Description of Pay-Sch selection
Pay-Codes
Required
Optional
Selection from List
For each Pay-Sch selected, the first PayCodes selection is required, and the
remainder are optional.
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available in the QCC version. Use the
Report option in the traditional version of Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes (PP0010).
4-108
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Pay Schedules (PS) Master File
Pay Schedules (PS) Master File
Header information for the
pay schedule.
Edit Entry area for
maintaining payroll
numbers in the grid. This
area displays the contents
of the selected row in the
grid.
Grid that displays the
payrolls for the pay
schedule. Each pay
schedule can include up
to 65 payrolls.
Figure 4-67: Change dialog box for the Pay Schedules (PS) master file
The procedure for maintaining the Pay Schedules (PS) master file differs from that for
most master file. Follow the instructions below.
To define header information for a pay schedule:
♦ Type the header information for the pay schedule.
To add a row to the grid:
1 Click the
(Add Entry) icon to open a new row at the bottom of the grid.
2 In the Edit Entry area, type a Payroll number that has not been used in the Payroll column of the grid.
3 Fill in the rest o the Edit Entry area. The following boxes are required: Deferred,
Start, End and Paid. The remainder are optional.
4 Click the
(Commit) icon to add the payroll to the end of the grid.
To change a row in the grid:
1 Click a row in the gird to display its contents in the Edit Entry area. You may
need to use the scroll bar to locate the desired row.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-109
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
2 In the Edit Entry area, make any changes to the payroll. The following boxes are
required: Deferred, Start, End and Paid. The remainder are optional.
3 Click the
area.
(Commit) icon to update the grid with the changes in the Edit Entry
To delete a row from the grid:
1 Click the row in grid that you want to delete.
2 Click the
(Delete Entry) icon to remove the payroll from the grid.
To delete an entire pay schedule:
1 Click the
(Delete Record [Ctrl+F8]) icon to delete the entire pay schedule.
To close the dialog box after you are through adding, changing, or deleting pay
schedules:
♦ Click the
(Save [F9]) icon to save your changes before closing the dialog box.
♦ Click the
changes.
(Cancel/Close [F12]) icon to close the dialog box without saving your
Table 4-67: Pay Schedules (PS) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Pay Schedule Codes
Display
Selection from List
Fiscal Year
Key
Fiscal Year
Pay Schedule Code
Key
Text (6 characters)
Pay Schedule Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Cycle
Required
Selection from List
Use Cycle for Tax
Required
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Class
Required
Selection from Option Buttons
Payroll
Required
Numerals (2 digits)
Deferred
Required
Selection from List
Start
Required
Date
End
Required
Date
Paid
Required
Date
Days
Optional
Fixed Decimal Point (nn.nn)
Edit Entry
4-110
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Pay Types (PT) Master File
Table 4-67: Pay Schedules (PS) master file - continued
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Hours
Optional
Fixed Decimal Point (nnn.nn)
Weeks
Optional
Fixed Decimal Point (n.nn)
Local Use
n/a
Not used.
Payrolls
Display
Number of payrolls in pay schedule
Payroll
Display
Numerals (2 digits)
Deferred
Display
Selection from List
Start
Display
Date
End
Display
Date
Paid
Display
Date
Days
Display
Fixed Decimal Point (nn.nn)
Hours
Display
Fixed Decimal Point (nnn.nn)
Weeks
Display
Fixed Decimal Point (n.nn)
Audit Information
Display
Time Stamp
Pay Types (PT) Master File
Figure 4-68: Add dialog box for the Pay Types (PT) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Pay Types (PT) master file. The instructions
for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-111
Human Resources Master Files Manual
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-68: Pay Types (PT) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (4 characters upshifted)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
Type
Optional
Text (2 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
Sample for Documentation
J377
PP0100
Pay type
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
TYPE
-------------------------------------------------------------------------ADLT ADULT EDUCATION
ADLT ED
ADMN ADMINISTRATION
ADMIN
ADOT ADULT EDUCATION OVERTIME
ADLT OT
ADV
ADVISOR
ADVISOR
NN
ADVN ADVISOR - NORMAL
ADVISORN
YY
ARR
ARREARS
ARREARS
BEN
BENEFITS (125 CASH OPTION)
BENEFITS
BRD
BOARD MEMBER
BOARD
BRDN BOARD MEMBER - NORMAL PAY
BRDPAYN
YY
CALL CALL OUTS (N/C)
CALL OUT
CAR
CAR ALLOWANCE
CAR
CCH
COACHING PAY
COACHING
NN
CCHN COACHING PAY - NORMAL
COACHNML
YY
CHLD CHILDREN CENTER
CHLDCNT
COA
COACHING PAY - CREDITABLE
COA-CR
COA1 COACHING PAY NON CREDITABLE
COA-NON
CRED CREDENTIAL BONUS
CREDENTL
NN
CSH
CASHBACK/CASHOUT
CASHBACK
NY
CSHR CASHBACK/CASHOUT - RETIREMENT
CASHRET
NY
CSHS CASHBACK - NON-NORMAL
CASHNON
NN
CTO
COMP TIME PAYOFF
COMP PAY
NN
CTOD COMP TIME PAYOFF - DEDUCTIONS
COMPPAYD
NY
CTPO CONTRACT PAYOFF
CONT P/O
DBS
DEFINED BENEFIT SUPPLEMENT
DBS
NN
DBSD DEFINED BENEFIT - DEDUCTIONS
DBSD
NY
DCK
DOCK (AFFECTS SERVICE CREDIT)
DOCK
DGRE DEGREE STIPEND (MA, PHD)
DGRESTIP
DIF
DIFFERENTIAL PAY
DIFF PAY
DLY
DAILY
DAILY
NN
DLYN DAILY NORMAL
DLY NML
YY
4-112
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Retirement Systems (RS) Master File
Retirement Systems (RS) Master File
Figure 4-69: Add dialog box for the Retirement Systems (RS) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Retirement Systems (RS) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-69: Retirement Systems (RS) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Numeric Code (2 digits)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
Coding
Not used
Leave blank
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-113
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
Sample for Documentation
J378
PP0100
Retirement system
H.00.02
06/04/08 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------01 CERTIFICATED RETIREMENT SYSTEM
STRS
02 CLASSIFIED RETIREMENT
PERS
03 RETIRED CERTIFICATED
RET STRS
04 RETIRED CLASSIFIED
RET PERS
05 NO RETIREMENT SYSTEM
NONE
Retirement Edits (RE) Master File
Figure 4-70: Change dialog box for the Retirement Edits (RE) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Retirement Edits (RE) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
4-114
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Retirement Edits (RE) Master File
Table 4-70: Retirement Edits (RE) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Field
Display
Selection from List
RS
Key
Selection from List
Ac
Key
Numerals (2 digits)
Pc
Key
Numerals (2 digits)
Cc
Key
Numerals (2 digits)
Statutory Deduction Codes
Optional
Selection from List
Audit Information
Display
Time Stamp
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available in the QCC version. Use the
Report option in the traditional version of Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes (PP0010).
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-115
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Payroll Profiles (PP) Master File
Figure 4-71: Add dialog box for the Payroll Profiles (PP) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Payroll Profiles (PP) master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-71: Payroll Profiles (PP) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Payroll Profile Codes
Display
Selection from List
User
Key
Selection from List or 8-character MPE
logon ID
Job Category
Key
Selection from List
Pay Code
Optional
Selection from List
4-116
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Statutory Deductions Subfolder
Table 4-71: Payroll Profiles (PP) master file - continued
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Retirement System
Optional
Selection from List
Retirement Coding
Not used
Leave blank
SUI
Optional
Selection from List
FICA
Optional
Selection from List
Pay Schedule
Optional
Selection from List
Statutory Deduction
Optional
Selection from List
Deduction
Not used
Leave blank
OT rate (1)
Not used
Leave blank
OT rate (2)
Not used
Leave blank
Pay data defaults ’D’ ’U’
Not used
Leave blank
Group
Optional
Selection from List
Range (start and end)
Optional
Text (4 characters)
Control Group Definition
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available in the QCC version. Use the
Report option in the traditional version of Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes (PP0010).
Statutory Deductions Subfolder
This subfolder includes the following master files:
♦ Statutory Deduction Codes (SD) Master File
♦ Statutory Deduction Profiles (SP) Master File
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-117
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Statutory Deduction Codes (SD) Master File
Figure 4-72: Statutory Deduction Codes master file
QSS maintains this master file. It defines the procedure number to be used for calculating each type of statutory deduction. These codes are a building block for the Statutory Deduction Profiles (SP) master file
WARNING: Do not change this master file unless QSS explicitly tells you to do so. Changing or deleting
this master file will cause payroll calculations to stop working properly at your site.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available in the QCC version. Use the
Report option in the traditional version of Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes (PP0010).
4-118
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Statutory Deductions Subfolder
Statutory Deduction Profiles (SP) Master File
Figure 4-73: Change dialog box for the Statutory Deduction Profiles (SP) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Statutory Deduction Profiles (SP) master
file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-72: Statutory Deduction Profiles (SP) master file
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Profile Names
Display
Selection from List
Profile Name
Key
Text (6 characters)
Description
Required
Text (30 characters)
Where is this profile used?
Required
Selection from List
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-119
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-72: Statutory Deduction Profiles (SP) master file - continued
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Statutory Deduction
Required
Display
Selection from List
Description from Statutory Deductions
(SD) master file
Opt
Required
Numerals (2 digits)
Cy
Not used
Leave blank
Rate
Not used
Leave as is
Audit Information
Display
Time Stamp
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available in the QCC version. Use the
Report option in the traditional version of Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes (PP0010).
4-120
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Deduction Schedule (DS) Master File
Deduction Schedule (DS) Master File
Figure 4-74: Change dialog box for the Deduction Schedule (DS) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Deduction Schedule (DS) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
01/10
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-121
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-73: Deduction Schedule (DS) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Deduction Schedule Codes
Display
Selection from List
Fiscal Year
Key
Fiscal Year
Deduction Schedule Code
Key
Numerals (2 digits)
Deduction Schedule Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Classification
Required
Selection from Option Buttons
Pr (payroll number)
Required
Numerals (2 digits)
Flag
Required
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Employee Factor
Optional
Fixed Decimal Point (nn.nn)
Disable
Optional
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Employer Factor
Optional
Fixed Decimal Point (nn.nn)
Disable
Optional
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Local Use
Optional
Text (8 characters)
Number of Payrolls
Display
Number of lines with the Pr box filled in on
all 5 pages
Audit Information
Display
Time Stamp
Page 1 through Page 5
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available in the QCC version. Use the
Report option in the traditional version of Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes (PP0010).
4-122
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Deduction Rate Table (DR) Master File
Deduction Rate Table (DR) Master File
Figure 4-75: Add dialog box for the Deduction Rate Table (DR) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Deduction Rate Table (DR) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-74: Deduction Rate Table (DR) master file
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Deduction Code
Display
Selection from List
Deduction
Key
Numeric Code (4 digits)
Barg Unit (Bargaining Unit Mode)
Ben Plan (Plan Mode)
Key
Numeric Code (2 digits)
Numeric Code (4 digits)
Usage Code (Bargaining Unit Mode)
Usage Type (Plan Mode)
Key
Text (2 characters upshifted)
Text (1 characters upshifted)
Total Amount
Optional
Dollar Amount ($0.00 to $99,999.99)
EMPR Amount
Optional
Dollar Amount ($0.00 to $10,000.000.00)
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-123
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-74: Deduction Rate Table (DR) master file - continued
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Prorate?
Optional
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Billing Basis
Optional
Numerals (2 digits)
Use EMPE/EMPR Amounts?
Optional
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Low
Display
Auto fill from previous High FTE
High
Optional
Numerals (0.0000 to 1.0000)
Use Actual?
Optional
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
FTE
Optional
Numerals (0.0000 to 1.0000)
Deduction Rate Table Data
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available in the QCC version. Use the
Report option in the traditional version of Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes (PP0010).
4-124
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Bonus Codes (BC) Master File
Bonus Codes (BC) Master File
Figure 4-76: Add dialog box for the Bonus Codes (BC) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Bonus Codes (BC) master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-75: Bonus Codes (BC) master file
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Code Value
Display
Selection from List
Copy From
Display
Selection from List (Add dialog box only)
Year
Display
Fiscal Year
Code Value
Key
Text (6 characters upshifted)
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-125
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-75: Bonus Codes (BC) master file - continued
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Name
Required
Text (30 characters upshifted)
Abbr
Optional
Text (8 characters upshifted)
Stub Name
Optional
Text (40 characters upshifted)
D / P Flag
Optional
Selection from List
Bonus Amount
Optional
Numerals (5 digits)
Use FTE in Bonus Calculation?
Optional
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Pay / Ret Flag
Not used
Leave selection blank
Bonus Rate Type
Optional
Selection from List
Manually Enter Amount
Optional
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Loaded from Position Control
Optional
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Retirement PC (Pay Code)
Optional
Numerals (1 digit)
Retirement CC (Contribution Code)
Optional
Numerals (1 digit)
RFU Flag-09
Not used
Leave blank
RFU Flag-10
Not used
Leave blank
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available in the QCC version. Use the
Report option in the traditional version of Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes (PP0010).
4-126
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Payroll Edit Rules (PE) Master File
Payroll Edit Rules (PE) Master File
Figure 4-77: Add dialog box for the Payroll Edit Rules (PE) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Payroll Edit Rules (PE) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-76: Payroll Edit Rules (PE) master file
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
PE Rule Type-ID Codes
Display
Selection from List
Rule Type
Key
Selection from List
Rule ID
Key
Text (6 characters case sensitive)
District
Key
Selection from List
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-127
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-76: Payroll Edit Rules (PE) master file - continued
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Error Type
Required
Selection from Option Buttons
Disable
Required
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Default Error Msg
Optional
Text (60 characters)
Field
Optional
Selection from List
Q
Optional
Selection from List
Op
Optional
Selection from List
Low
Optional
Text (length varies with Field selection)
High
Optional
Text (length varies with Field selection)
Page 1 through Page 6
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available in the QCC version. Use the
Report option in the traditional version of Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes (PP0010).
Deduction Rule Codes (PR) Master File
Figure 4-78: Add dialog box for the Deduction Rule Codes (PR) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Deduction Rule Codes (PR) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
4-128
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-77: Deduction Rule Codes (PR) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (2 characters upshifted)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
65 QSS UNIFIED SCHOOL DISTRICT
SAMPLE FOR DOCUMENTATION
J1493
Pay Deduction Rule Codes
PP0100
H.00.09
02/03/04 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------AB ALL BASE - EXCLUDES BONUS PAY
ALLBASE
AG ALL GROSS
ALLGROSS
NB NORMAL BASE-EXCLUDES BONUS PAY
NMLBASE
NG NORMAL GROSS
NMLGROSS
SMF Status Codes (SM) Master File
Figure 4-79: Add dialog box for the SMF Status Codes (SM) master file
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-129
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
This heading describes the boxes for the SMF Status Codes (SM) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-78: SMF Status Codes (SM) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Numeric Code (2 digits)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
Corresponding Ret Sys Code
Required
Numerals (2 digits)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
4-130
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
65 QSS UNIFIED SCHOOL DISTRICT
SMF Status Codes
J8093
PP0100
H.00.09
09/03/03 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION RET-SYS EQUIVALENT
-------------------------------------------------------------------------01 STRS MEMBER
STRS MBR
01
02 STRS NON-MEMBER
NON-MBR
05
07 STRS REFUND
05
08 STRS DECEASED
05
21 RETIRED STRS MEMBER
RETIRED
03
22 DISABLED STRS MEMBER
DISABLED
01
42 DISABLED & RETIRED STRS MEMBER
RETDISBL
03
98 DECEASED RETIRED STRS MEMBER
RETDECSD
03
Pending Retirement Status Codes (PN) Master File
Figure 4-80: Add dialog box for the Pending Retirement Status Codes (PN) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Pending Retirement Status Codes (PN) master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-79: Pending Retirement Status Codes (PN) master file
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (2 characters upshifted)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-131
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
90 QSS COUNTY OFFICE OF EDUCATION
J6133
Pending Ret Status Codes
PP0100
H.00.09
08/19/04 PAGE
1
CODE SORT
CODE NAME
ABBREVIATION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------01
STRS MEMBER
STRS
02
STRS NON-MEMBER
NON-MBR
07
STRS REFUND
REFUND
08
STRS DECEASED
DECEASE
21
RETIRED STRS MEMBER
RETIRED
22
DISABLED STRS MEMBER
DISABLED
42
DISABLED AND RETIRED STRS MEMBER RETDISBL
98
DECEASED RETIRED STRS MEMBER
RETDECSD
Vol-Ded Frequency Codes (VD) Master File
Figure 4-81: Add dialog box for the Vol-Ded Frequency Codes (VD) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Vol-Ded Frequency Codes (VD) master file.
The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦ For inspecting, see page 2-23.
♦ For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
♦ For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
4-132
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Voluntary Deductions (VD) Master File
♦ For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
♦ For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-80: Vol-Ded Frequency Codes (VD) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Vol-ded Frequency Codes
Display
Selection from List
Vol-ded Frequency Code
Key
Numeric Code (2 digits)
Vol-ded Frequency Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
Optional
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Process Deduction on Checked Payrolls
1. through 52.
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available in the QCC version. Use the
Report option in the traditional version of Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes (PP0010).
Voluntary Deductions (VD) Master File
Figure 4-82: Add dialog box for the Voluntary Deductions (VD) master file
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-133
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
This heading describes the boxes for the Voluntary Deductions (VD) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-81: Voluntary Deductions (VD) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Vol-Ded Codes
Display
Selection from List
Vol-Ded Code
Key
Numeric Code (4 digits)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Optional
Text (8 characters)
Payee Name
Optional
Text (30 characters)
Address
Optional
Text (30 characters)
Line 2
Optional
Text (30 characters)
Line 3
Optional
Text (30 characters)
City
Optional
Text (18 characters)
State
Optional
Text (2 characters)
Zip
Optional
Text (10 characters)
Class
Optional
Selection from List
Global Default Subjectivity
Optional
Selection from List
Other vol-ded number for payment
Optional
Selection from List
Benefit Mapping Group
Optional
Selection from List
Payment Cycle
Optional
Selection from List
VLD Override Processing Rule
Optional
Selection from List
VLD System will print separate checks for
each district/vol-ded
or
VLD System will print one check for each
vol-ded (collapse districts)
Display
Depends on choice in VLD Override
Processing Rule list
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
4-134
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Benefit Controls (BC) Master File
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available in the QCC version. Use the
Report option in the traditional version of Update Per/Pay Chart of Codes (PP0010).
Benefit Controls (BC) Master File
Figure 4-83: Add dialog box for the Benefit Controls (BC) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Benefit Controls (BC) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
For this master file, use the Add command only once to create the Benefit Names for
a county. After adding, use the Change command to alter the benefit names or mask
for districts.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-135
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-82: Benefit Controls (BC) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Districts
Display
Selection from List
Masks
Required
Selection from List
Benefit Names
Required
Text (8 characters)
Audit Information
Display
Time Stamp
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, this report is not available from QCC. For a report sample, see
Chapter 27 of the QSS/OASIS Enhanced Payroll Manual.
Benefit Object Maps (OMAP) Master File
Figure 4-84: Add dialog box for the Benefit Object Maps (OMAP) master file
4-136
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Benefit Object Maps (OMAP) Master File
This heading describes the boxes for the Benefit Object Maps (OMAP) master file.
The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-83: Benefit Object Maps (OMAP) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Codes
Display
Selection from List
District
Key
Selection from List
Name
Display
From Benefit Control (BCT) master file
DR
Required
Selection from List
CR
Required
Selection from List
1-12 and 13 - 24 tabs
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, this report is not available from QCC. For a report sample, see
Chapter 27 of the QSS/OASIS Enhanced Payroll Manual.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-137
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Health/Welfare Benefit Maps (VMAP) Master File
Figure 4-85: Add dialog box for the Health/Welfare Benefit Maps (VMAP) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Health/Welfare Benefit Maps (VMAP) master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-84: Health/Welfare Benefit Maps (VMAP) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Codes
Display
Selection from List
District
Key
Selection from List
Object
Key
Numeric Code (8 digits)
Display
1 to 120 (12 per page)
Page 1 through Page 10
No
4-138
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Benefit Group Maps (GMAP) Master File
Table 4-84: Health/Welfare Benefit Maps (VMAP) master file - continued
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Vd (Voluntary deduction)
Optional
Selection from List
Name
Display
Name of selected voluntary deduction
Dr
Optional
Selection from List
Cr
Optional
Selection from List
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, this report is not available from QCC. For a report sample, see
Chapter 27 of the QSS/OASIS Enhanced Payroll Manual.
Benefit Group Maps (GMAP) Master File
Figure 4-86: Add dialog box for the Benefit Group Maps (GMAP) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Benefit Group Maps (GMAP) master file.
The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-139
Human Resources Master Files Manual
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-85: Benefit Group Maps (GMAP) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Codes
Display
Selection from List
District
Key
Selection from List
Object
Key
Numeric Code (8 digits)
No.
Display
1. through 120. (12 per page)
Group
Optional
Numerals (4 digits)
Dr
Optional
Selection from List
Cr
Optional
Selection from List
Page 1 through Page 10
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, this report is not available from QCC. For a report sample, see
Chapter 27 of the QSS/OASIS Enhanced Payroll Manual.
Tax Tables Subfolder
To define tax tables, use the HR Code Maintenance 2 window, described in Chapter 3.
As of August 2009, the Tax Tables subfolder allows you to define the following tax
tables:.
Table 4-86: Master files for the Position Control folder
4-140
MASTER FILE
CODE
LEVEL
PAGE
Federal Income Tax
TT01
County
4-141
OASDI/Medicare
TT03
County
4-147
Workers Compensation
TT05
District
4-148
State Tax California
TT06
County
4-150
SUI California
TT07
County
4-153
PERS California
TT08
County
4-155
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Tax Tables Subfolder
Table 4-86: Master files for the Position Control folder - continued
MASTER FILE
CODE
LEVEL
PAGE
STRS California
TT09
County
4-156
California Retirement Setup
TT10
County
4-158
California State Disability Insurance
TT11
County
4-159
To define tax tables for Arizona, Oregon, Utah, and Ohio, use the traditional software.
For details, see Chapter 6 of the QSS/OASIS Enhanced Payroll Manual.
NOTE: The HR Code Maintenance window allows you to list the tax tables that have been defined, but it
does not allow you to define the master files.
Federal Income Tax (TT01) Master File
The instructions for this master file focus on the following areas:
♦
♦
♦
♦
Overview
EIC Tab
Withholding Tabs
New EIC Tab
Overview
This heading describes the boxes for the Federal Income Tax (TT01) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 3.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting or changing, see page 3-23.
For adding, see page 3-25.
For deleting, see page 3-27.
For InstaPrint reports, see page 3-28.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, tax table reports are not available from QCC. For a report sample, see Chapter 6 of the QSS/OASIS Enhanced Payroll Manual. To get a printable
version of the tax table you are maintaining, click the
(Instaprint [Ctrl+F11]) icon.
For instructions, see page 3-28.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-141
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
EIC Tab
Figure 4-87: Change dialog box for the Federal Income Tax (TT01) master file (EIC tab)
4-142
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Tax Tables Subfolder
Table 4-87: Federal Income Tax (TT01) master file (EIC tab)
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
xx records
Display
Selection from List
Effective Date
Key
Date
Description
Required
Text (30 characters)
Name
Display
From Benefit Control (BCT) master file
Over
Display
Dollar Amount (0 to 999,999)
But not over
Required
Dollar Amount (0 to 999,999)
% of wages
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 99.99)
less % of wages in excess of
Required
Dollar Amount (0 to 999,999)
Over
Display
Dollar Amount (0 to 999,999)
But not over
Required
Dollar Amount (0 to 999,999)
% of wages
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 99.99)
less % of wages in excess of
Required
Dollar Amount (0 to 999,999)
(a) SINGLE or MARRIED Without Spouse
Filing Certificate
(b) MARRIED With Both Spouses Filing
Certificate
Withholding Tabs
The following tabs have the same boxes:
♦ Withholding SINGLE
♦ Withholding MARRIED
♦ Withholding HEAD OF HOUSEHOLD
Table 4-88: Federal Income Tax (TT01) master file (withholding tabs)
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Not over
Required
Dollar Amount (0 to 999,999)
Over
Display
Dollar Amount (0 to 999,999)
But not over
Required
Dollar Amount (0 to 999,999)
[withholding amount]
Required
Dollar Amount (0 to 999,999)
%
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 99.99)
amount over
Display
Dollar Amount (0 to 999,999)
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-143
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Figure 4-88: Change dialog box for the Federal Income Tax (TT01) master file (withholding tabs)
4-144
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Tax Tables Subfolder
New EIC Tab
Figure 4-89: Change dialog box for the Federal Income Tax (TT01) master file (New EIC tab)
Table 4-89: Federal Income Tax (TT01) master file (new EIC tab)
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Use New EIC Tables
Required
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Over
Display
Dollar Amount (0 to 999,999)
But not over
Required
Dollar Amount (0 to 999,999)
% of wages
Required
Numerals (0.0000 to 99.9999)
less %
Required
Numerals (0.0000 to 99.9999)
of wages in excess of
Display
Dollar Amount (0 to 999,999)
Over
Display
Dollar Amount (0 to 999,999)
But not over
Required
Dollar Amount (0 to 999,999)
% of wages
Required
Numerals (0.0000 to 99.9999)
less %
Required
Numerals (0.0000 to 99.9999)
of wages in excess of
Display
Dollar Amount (0 to 999,999)
(a) SINGLE or HEAD OF HOUSEHOLD
(b) MARRIED Without Spouse Filing
Certificate
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-145
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-89: Federal Income Tax (TT01) master file (new EIC tab) - continued
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Over
Display
Dollar Amount (0 to 999,999)
But not over
Required
Dollar Amount (0 to 999,999)
% of wages
Required
Numerals (0.0000 to 99.9999)
less %
Required
Numerals (0.0000 to 99.9999)
of wages in excess of
Display
Dollar Amount (0 to 999,999)
(c) MARRIED With Both Spouses Filing
Certificate
4-146
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Tax Tables Subfolder
OASDI/Medicare (TT03) Master File
Figure 4-90: Change dialog box for the OASDI/Medicare (TT03) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the OASDI/Medicare (TT03) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 3.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
01/10
For inspecting or changing, see page 3-23.
For adding, see page 3-25.
For deleting, see page 3-27.
For InstaPrint reports, see page 3-28.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-147
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-90: OASDI/Medicare (TT03) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
[xx] Records
Display
Selection from List
Effective Date
Key
Date
Description
Required
Text (30 characters)
OASDI tax rate employee
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 99.99)
OASDI tax rate employer
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 99.99)
OASDI buyout rate
Optional
Numerals (0.00 to 9.999999)
Maximum wages subject to OASDI
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 999,999.99)
MEDICARE tax rate employee
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 99.99)
MEDICARE tax rate employer
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 99.99)
MEDICARE buyout rate
Optional
Numerals (0.00 to 9.999999)
Maximum wages subject to MEDICARE
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 999,999.99)
OASDI (Social Security) Rates and LImits
MEDICARE Rates and Limits
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, tax table reports are not available from QCC. For a report sample, see Chapter 6 of the QSS/OASIS Enhanced Payroll Manual. To get a printable
version of the tax table you are maintaining, click the
(Instaprint [Ctrl+F11]) icon.
For instructions, see page 3-28.
Workers Compensation (TT05) Master File
This heading describes the boxes for the Workers Compensation (TT05) master file.
The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 3.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
4-148
For inspecting or changing, see page 3-23.
For adding, see page 3-25.
For deleting, see page 3-27.
For InstaPrint reports, see page 3-28.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Tax Tables Subfolder
Figure 4-91: Change dialog box for the Workers Compensation (TT05) master file
Table 4-91: Workers Compensation (TT05) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
x records for District xx
Display
Selection from List
For District
Key
Numerals (2 digits)
Effective date
Key
Date
Description
Required
Text (30 characters)
Rate #1
Optional
Numerals (0.0000 to 99.9999)
Max
Optional
Numerals (0.00 to 999,999.99)
Rate #2 through Rate #6
Optional
Numerals (0.0000 to 99.9999)
Max
Optional
Numerals (0.00 to 999,999.99)
Workers Compensation Rates
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-149
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, tax table reports are not available from QCC. For a report sample, see Chapter 6 of the QSS/OASIS Enhanced Payroll Manual. To get a printable
version of the tax table you are maintaining, click the
(Instaprint [Ctrl+F11]) icon.
For instructions, see page 3-28.
State Tax California (TT06) Master File
The samples for the State Tax California (TT06) master file focus on the following
areas:
♦ Overview
♦ Tables 1/2, 3/4 Tab
♦ Method B Tabs
Overview
This heading describes the boxes for the State Tax California (TT06) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 3.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting or changing, see page 3-23.
For adding, see page 3-25.
For deleting, see page 3-27.
For InstaPrint reports, see page 3-28.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, tax table reports are not available from QCC. For a report sample, see Chapter 6 of the QSS/OASIS Enhanced Payroll Manual. To get a printable
version of the tax table you are maintaining, click the
(Instaprint [Ctrl+F11]) icon.
For instructions, see page 3-28.
4-150
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Tax Tables Subfolder
Tables 1/2, 3/4 Tab
Figure 4-92: Change dialog box for the State Tax California (TT06) master file (Tables 1/2, 3/4 tab)
Table 4-92: State Tax California (TT06) master file (Tables 1/2, 3/4 tab)
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
x Records
Display
Selection from List
Effective Date
Key
Date
Description
Required
Text (30 characters)
Supplemental tax rate
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 99.99)
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-151
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-92: State Tax California (TT06) master file (Tables 1/2, 3/4 tab) - continued
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Single
Required
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 99,999.99)
Married with a ’0’ or ’1’ allowance
Required
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 99,999.99)
Unmarried head of household
Required
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 99,999.99)
Amount for ’1’ additional allowance
Required
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 99,999.99)
Single
Required
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 99,999.99)
Married with a ’0’ or ’1’ allowance
Required
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 99,999.99)
Unmarried head of household
Required
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 99,999.99)
Amount for ’1’ additional allowance
Required
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 99,999.99)
Tables 1/2 - Low income Exemption Table
/ Estimated Education Table (Annual)
Tables 3/4 - Standard Deduction Table /
Personal Exemption Credit (Annual)
4-152
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Tax Tables Subfolder
Method B Tabs
Figure 4-93: Change dialog box for the State Tax California (TT06) master file (Method B tabs)
The following tabs have the same boxes:
♦ Method B SINGLE
♦ Method B MARRIED
♦ Method B Head of Household
Table 4-93: State Tax California (TT06) master file (Method B tabs)
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Over
Display
Dollar Amount
But not over
Required
Dollar Amount (0 to 999,999)
[percentage]
Required
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 99.99)
Of amount over
Display
Dollar Amount
Plus
Required
Dollar Amount
SUI California (TT07) Master File
This heading describes the boxes for the SUI California (TT07) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 3.
♦ For inspecting or changing, see page 3-23.
♦ For adding, see page 3-25.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-153
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Figure 4-94: Change dialog box for the SUI California (TT07) master file
♦ For deleting, see page 3-27.
♦ For InstaPrint reports, see page 3-28.
♦ For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-94: SUI California (TT07) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
x records
Display
Selection from List
Effective Date
Key
Date
Description
Required
Text (30 characters)
Regularly funded employees
Required
Numerals (0.0000 to 99.9999)
Federally funded employees
Required
Numerals (0.0000 to 99.9999)
Alternate Sui plan
Required
Numerals (0.0000 to 99.9999)
Maximum amount
Required
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 999,999.99)
4-154
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Tax Tables Subfolder
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, tax table reports are not available from QCC. For a report sample, see Chapter 6 of the QSS/OASIS Enhanced Payroll Manual. To get a printable
version of the tax table you are maintaining, click the
(Instaprint [Ctrl+F11]) icon.
For instructions, see page 3-28.
PERS California (TT08) Master File
Figure 4-95: Change dialog box for the PERS California (TT08) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the PERS California (TT08) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 3.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
01/10
For inspecting or changing, see page 3-23.
For adding, see page 3-25.
For deleting, see page 3-27.
For InstaPrint reports, see page 3-28.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-155
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-95: PERS California (TT08) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
xx records
Display
Selection from List
Effective Date
Key
Date
Description
Required
Text (30 characters)
PERS employee rate
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 99.999)
PERS employer rate
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 99.999)
Survivor benefit payment
Required
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 999,999.99)
Earnings less than
Required
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 999,999.99)
Earnings X
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 99.999)
Earnings equal or more than
Display
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 999,999.99)
Earnings Minus
Required
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 999,999.99)
Revenue limit rate
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 99.999)
Revenue limit reduction rate
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 99.999)
PERS Rates and Control Values (Monthly
Reporting Cycle)
OASDI Modification Chart (See the PERS
Manual for this Chart)
Revenue Limit Calculations
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, tax table reports are not available from QCC. For a report sample, see Chapter 6 of the QSS/OASIS Enhanced Payroll Manual. To get a printable
version of the tax table you are maintaining, click the
(Instaprint [Ctrl+F11]) icon.
For instructions, see page 3-28.
STRS California (TT09) Master File
This heading describes the boxes for the STRS California (TT09) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 3.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
4-156
For inspecting or changing, see page 3-23.
For adding, see page 3-25.
For deleting, see page 3-27.
For InstaPrint reports, see page 3-28.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
Tax Tables Subfolder
Figure 4-96: Change dialog box for the STRS California (TT09) master file
Table 4-96: STRS California (TT09) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
xx records
Display
Selection from List
Effective date
Key
Date
Description
Required
Text (30 characters)
STRS employee rate
Required
Numerals (0.0000 to 99.9999)
STRS employer rate
Required
Numerals (0.0000 to 99.9999)
STRS reduced workload employer rate
Required
Numerals (0.0000 to 99.9999)
STRS Employee/Employer Rates (Current)
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-157
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-96: STRS California (TT09) master file - continued
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Fiscal Year
Optional
Fiscal Year
Employer Rate%
Optional
Numerals (0.0000 to 99.9999)
Employee Rate%
Optional
Numerals (0.0000 to 99.9999)
STRS Employer Rate (Historical)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, tax table reports are not available from QCC. For a report sample, see Chapter 6 of the QSS/OASIS Enhanced Payroll Manual. To get a printable
version of the tax table you are maintaining, click the
(Instaprint [Ctrl+F11]) icon.
For instructions, see page 3-28.
California Retirement Setup (TT10) Master File
Figure 4-97: Change dialog box for the California Retirement Setup (TT10) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the California Retirement Setup (TT10) master
file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 3.
4-158
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Payroll Master Files
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
Tax Tables Subfolder
For inspecting or changing, see page 3-23.
For adding, see page 3-25.
For deleting, see page 3-27.
For InstaPrint reports, see page 3-28.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-97: California Retirement Setup (TT10) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Description
Required
Text (30 characters)
Effective date of rates for payroll/benefits
Required
Date or Selection from List
Effective date of rates for final PERS report
Required
Date or Selection from List
Effective date of rates for payroll/benefits
Required
Date or Selection from List
Effective date of rates for final STRS
reports
Required
Date or Selection from List
PERS Rate Setup
STRS Rate Setup
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, tax table reports are not available from QCC. For a report sample, see Chapter 6 of the QSS/OASIS Enhanced Payroll Manual. To get a printable
version of the tax table you are maintaining, click the
(Instaprint [Ctrl+F11]) icon.
For instructions, see page 3-28.
California State Disability Insurance (TT11) Master File
This heading describes the boxes for the California State Disability Insurance (TT11)
master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 3.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
01/10
For inspecting or changing, see page 3-23.
For adding, see page 3-25.
For deleting, see page 3-27.
For InstaPrint reports, see page 3-28.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-159
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Figure 4-98: Add dialog box for the California State Disability Insurance (TT11) master file
Table 4-98: California State Disability Insurance (TT11) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
xx records
Display
Selection from List
Effective date
Key
Date
Description
Required
Text (30 characters)
SDI rate
Required
Numerals (0.0000 to 99.9999)
Maximum wages subject to SDI
Required
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 999,999.99)
State Disability Insurance Tax Rates
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, tax table reports are not available from QCC. For a report sample, see Chapter 6 of the QSS/OASIS Enhanced Payroll Manual. To get a printable
version of the tax table you are maintaining, click the
(Instaprint [Ctrl+F11]) icon.
For instructions, see page 3-28.
4-160
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
Tax Tables Subfolder
Position Control Master Files
The Position Control folder contains the master files required for implementing Position Control. This heading lists the master files and subfolders in the same order that
they display in the tree view.
Table 4-99: Master files for the Position Control folder
MASTER FILE
CODE
LEVEL
PAGE
Position Control Bonus Codes
PB
District
4-162
Benefit Projected Rates
BPR
District
4-164
District Authorized Positions
DAP
District
4-166
New District Authorized Positions
DAPN
District
4-177
Salary Schedules
SS
District
4-193
New Salary Schedules
SSN
District
4-193
Work Calendars
WC
District
4-209
For additional lists of master files documented in the chapter, see:
♦ "Table 4-1: Master files by folder on tree view" on page 4-4
♦ "Table 4-2: Master files by name" on page 4-7
♦ "Table 4-3: Master files by code" on page 4-10
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-161
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Position Bonus Codes (PB) Master File
Figure 4-99: Add dialog box for the Position Bonus Codes (PB) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Position Bonus Codes (PB) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
The selection in the Type list determines which boxes are required, optional, or to be
left blank. Some boxes have labels that change depending on the selection in the Type
list.
4-162
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
Position Bonus Codes (PB) Master File
Table 4-100: Position Bonus Codes (PB) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Code
Display
Selection from List
Year
Key
Selection from List
Code Value
Key
Text (6 characters upshifted)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbr
Optional
Text (8 characters)
Type
Optional or
Required
Selection from List
D-P Flag
Optional or
Required
Selection from List
Rule
Optional or
Required
Selection from List
Bonus Class
Optional
Selection from List
Prorate
Optional or
Required
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Use FTE
Optional or
Required
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Payroll Load
Optional
Selection from List
Load Pay Type
Optional
Text (4 characters upshifted)
Default Payroll Bonus Code
Optional
Text (6 characters upshifted)
1. through 20.
Display
Line numbers
Level or Month or Year
Display or
Required
Numerals (2 digits if required for choice in
the Type list)
Amount or Percent
Optional or
Required
Numerals (10 digits)
Bonus Code
Optional or
Required
Text (6 characters upshifted)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-163
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Benefit Projected Rates (BPR) Master File
Figure 4-100: Add dialog box for the Benefit Projected Rate (BPR) master file
4-164
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
Benefit Projected Rates (BPR) Master File
This heading describes the boxes for the Benefit Projected Rate (BPR) master file.
The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27.
For adding, changing, or deleting rows from the grid, see 4-166.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available. You can use the Grid
Output command to get a listing of codes.
♦ For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-101: Benefit Projected Rate (BPR) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Year
Key
Fiscal Year
Line
Display
Numerals (1 through 64)
Base Type
Required
Selection from List
Benefit Name
Required
Text (8 characters)
Base Amt/%
Required
Numerals (dollar amount or percentage)
Limit Amount
Optional
Dollar Amount
PT
Optional
Selection from List
Project Amt/%
Optional
Numerals (dollar amount or percentage)
Reference #
Optional
Selection from List
Name
Optional
Text (benefit class name for Reference #)
Ln
Display
Numerals (1 through 64)
Base Type
Display
Text (8 characters)
Base Amt
Display
Numerals (dollar amount or percentage)
Limit Amt
Display
Dollar Amount
PT
Display
Text
Projection Amt
Display
Numerals (dollar amount or percentage)
Reference #
Display
Text
Reference Name
Display
Text (benefit class name for Reference #)
Add New/Edit
[grid]
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-165
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
8
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
To add or change a row in the grid:
1 While the dialog box is in Add or Change mode, click the row to add or change.
2 The Add New/Edit area displays the contents of the row.
3 Type or select the Benefit Name, Base Type, Base Amt/%, Limit Amount, PT,
Project Amt/%, and Reference #.
4 Click the [Accept] button to update the row in the grid with the changes made in
the Add New/Edit area.
To delete a row from the grid:
1 While the dialog box is in Change mode, click the row in the grid that you want to
delete.
2 On the Options menu, click Clear Row or press Ctrl+R.
District Authorized Positions (DAP) Master File
Figure 4-101: Add mode for District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file
4-166
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
District Authorized Positions (DAP) Master File
The instructions for this master file focus on the following:
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
Maintaining District Authorized Positions
Header Information
Description Tab
Requirements 1 Tab
Requirements 2 Tab
Account Distribution Tab
Benefits Tab
Employee List Tab
Maintaining District Authorized Positions
Use the HR Code Maintenance 2 window to maintain the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file. For details about this window, see Chapter 3. As of August
2009, the report for this master file is not available from QCC. See the Salary Schedule Matrix Report (PP0300) in Chapter 8 of QSS/OASIS Position Control Manual.
To inspect a record:
1 In the tree view, select the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file. For
detailed instructions, see “Tree View” on page 3-8.
2 If desired, use the filter to select the master file records to display in the grid. For
detailed instructions, see “Filter” on page 3-14.
3 Open a District Auhorized Position (DAP) dialog box in inspect mode in either of
the following ways:
◊ Double-click a row on the grid.
◊ Click a row on the grid, then click the
(Inspect [Ctrl+F5]) icon.
For a detailed description of the grid, see “Grid” on page 3-19.
4 Follow the instructions for the District Auhorized Position (DAP) dialog box on
page 4-169. This dialog box allows you to add, change, inspect, or delete records.
To change a record:
1 In the tree view, select District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file. For
detailed instructions, see “Tree View” on page 3-8.
2 If desired, use the filter to select the master file records to display in the grid. For
detailed instructions, see “Filter” on page 3-14.
3 For Click a row on the grid. For a detailed description of the grid, see “Grid” on
page 3-19.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-167
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
4 Click the
(Change [Ctrl+F9]) icon to open a District Auhorized Position (DAP)
dialog box in Change mode.
5 Follow the instructions for the District Auhorized Position (DAP) dialog box on
page 4-169. This dialog box allows you to add, change, inspect, or delete records.
To add a record:
1 Select the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file from the tree view on
the HR Code Maintenance 2 window.
2 Do any of the following:
◊ Click the
(Add New [Ctrl+F6]) icon in the HR Code Maintenance 2 window
to add a new record based on the one you have selected in the grid.
◊ Click the
(Add New (No Preload) [Shift+F6]) icon in the HR Code Maintenance 2 window to add a new record in a blank District Auhorized Position
(DAP) dialog box.
◊ Follow the instructions in “To inspect a record:” on page 4-167 to open a District Auhorized Position (DAP) dialog box. From that dialog box, click the
(Add New [Ctrl+F6]) icon or the
(Add New (No Preload) [Shift+F6]) icon
in that dialog box.
3 Follow the instructions for the District Auhorized Position (DAP) dialog box on
page 4-169. This dialog box allows you to add, change, inspect, or delete records.
To delete a record:
1 Open a District Auhorized Position (DAP) dialog box as described in “To inspect a
record:” on page 4-167.
The dialog box must be in Inspect mode before you can delete a record. If it is in
Change mode, click the
(Inspect [Ctrl+F5]) icon.
2 Review the District Auhorized Position (DAP) dialog box to be sure it is displaying the record that you want to delete.
You can select the record to display from the Select Position list.
3 To delete, click the
(Delete [Ctrl+F8]) icon.
4 In the HR Code Maintenance dialog box, select the [OK] button to delete or the
[Cancel] button to cancel the deletion.
4-168
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
District Authorized Positions (DAP) Master File
To maintain records with the District Auhorized Position (DAP) dialog box:
1 Do any of the following while the District Auhorized Position (DAP) dialog box is
in Inspect mode:
◊ Select the record that you want to inspect from the Position Number list.
◊ Click the
(Change [Ctrl+F9]) icon to put the dialog box in Change mode so
you can add, change, or delete records.
◊ Add a new record in either of the following ways.
> Click the
(Add New [Ctrl+F6]) icon to add a new record by copying from
the one currently displayed in the dialog box.
> Click the
(Add New (No Preload) [Shift+F6]) icon add a new record in a
blank dialog box.
To save your changes, click the
and Stay [F9]) icon.
(Save and Return [F2]) icon or the
(Save
◊ Delete the record displayed in the dialog box. Click the
(Delete [Ctrl+F8])
icon, then confirm whether to delete the record in the dialog box.
◊ Press F12 to close the dialog box.
2 Do any of the following while the District Auhorized Position (DAP) dialog box is
in Change mode:
◊ Select the record that you want to change from the Position Number list.
◊ Click the
(Inspect [Ctrl+F5]) icon to put the dialog box in Inspect mode.
◊ Change anything about a record but the Position Number. To save your
changes, click the
(Save and Return [F2]) icon or the
(Save and Stay
[F9]) icon.
◊ Press F12 to close the dialog box.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-169
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Header Information
Figure 4-102: Header information for the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file
Table 4-102: Header information for the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Select Position
Display
Selection from List
Position Number
Key
Text (6 digits)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
Supervising Position
Optional
Selection from List
Description Tab
Figure 4-103: Description tab for the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file
Table 4-103: Description for the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Comment
Display
Text
Appr
Optional
Date
Pos Start
Required
Date
End
Optional
Date
4-170
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
District Authorized Positions (DAP) Master File
Table 4-103: Description for the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file master file - continued
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Applicaiton Open
Optional
Date
Close
Optional
Date
Status
Optional
Selection from List
Work Location
Optional
Selection from List
Rollover
Optional
Selection from List
Work Calendar
Optional
Selection from List
FTE
Optional
Numerals (0.000 to 1.000)
Month/Year
Optional
Numerals (0.00 to 12.00)
Days/Year
Optional
Numerals (0.00 to 360.00)
Hours/Day
Optional
Numerals (0.00 to 99.99)
Days/Week
Optional
Numerals (1 to 7)
Work Shift
Optional
Text (1 character)
Placement
[Salary Schedule]
[Range]
[Step]
[Calculation Code]
Optional
Optional
Optional
Optional
Selection from List
Selection from List
Numerals (0 to 99)
Selection from List
Projection Amt
Optional
Dollar Amount (0 to 9,999,999.999)
Position Benefits
Optional
Selection from List
Disallow Job Sharing
Optional
Selection from List
Contract Type
Optional
Selection from List
Experience Type
Optional
Selection from List
Seniority Class
Optional
Selection from List
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-171
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Requirements 1 Tab
Figure 4-104: Requirements 1 tab for the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file
Table 4-104: for the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
[required or optional]
Optional
Selection from List
[credential code]
Optional
Selection from List
Type
Display
Text
Level
Display
Text
[required or optional]
Optional
Selection from List
[educational level]
Optional
Selection from List
Program
Optional
Selection from List
[required or optional]
Optional
Selection from List
[subject code]
Optional
Selection from List
Credentials
Education
Subjects
4-172
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
District Authorized Positions (DAP) Master File
Requirements 2 Tab
Figure 4-105: Requirements 2 tab for the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file
Table 4-105: Requirements 2 tab for the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
[required or optional]
Optional
Selection from List
[code]
Optional
Selection from List
[required or optional]
Optional
Selection from List
[code]
Optional
Selection from List
[score]
Optional
Numerals (0 to 9999)
[required or optional]
Optional
Selection from List
[code]
Optional
Selection from List
Years
Optional
Numerals (0 to 99)
Skills
Test Info
Experience
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-173
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Account Distribution Tab
Figure 4-106: Account Distribution tab for the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file
Table 4-106: Account Distribution tab for the
District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Ln
Display
Numerals (1 to 20)
Percent
Numerals
Numerals (0.00 to 100.00)
FTE
Required
Numerals (0.000 to 1.000)
[account]
Required
Text
Start
Optional
Date
End
Optional
Date
X
Optional
Selection from List
4-174
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
District Authorized Positions (DAP) Master File
Benefits Tab
Figure 4-107: Benefits tab for the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file
Table 4-107: Benefits tab for the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file master file
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Line
Display
Numerals
Benefit Name
Display
Text
Select
Display
Text
Base Type
Display
Text
Base Amount/%
Display
Numerals
Limit Amount
Display
Numerals
Projection Type
Display
Text
Projection Amount
Display
Numerals
Reference #
Display
Numerals
Reference Name
Display
Text
Vol Ded. #
Display
Numerals
Vol Ded Name
Display
Text
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-175
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Employee List Tab
Figure 4-108: Employee List tab for the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file
Table 4-108: Employee List tab for the District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Fiscal Year
Optional
Fiscal Year
SSN
Display
Numeric Code
Name
Display
Text
Start
Display
Date
End
Display
Date
FTE
Display
Numerals
4-176
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) Master File
New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) Master File
Figure 4-109: Add mode for New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) master file
The instructions for this master file focus on the following:
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
Maintaining District Authorized Positions
Header Information
Description Tab
Requirements 1 Tab
Requirements 2 Tab
Account Distribution Tab
Benefits Tab
Employee List Tab
Reports
Maintaining District Authorized Positions
Use the HR Code Maintenance 2 window to maintain the New District Authorized
Positions (DAPN) master file. For details about this window, see Chapter 3.
To inspect a record:
1 In the tree view, select the New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) master
file. For detailed instructions, see “Tree View” on page 3-8.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-177
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
2 If desired, use the filter to select the master file records to display in the grid. For
detailed instructions, see “Filter” on page 3-14.
3 Open a New District Auhorized Position (DAPN) dialog box in inspect mode in
either of the following ways:
◊ Double-click a row on the grid.
◊ Click a row on the grid, then click the
(Inspect [Ctrl+F5]) icon.
For a detailed description of the grid, see “Grid” on page 3-19.
4 Follow the instructions for the New District Auhorized Position (DAPN) dialog
box on page 4-169. This dialog box allows you to add, change, inspect, or delete
records.
To change a record:
1 In the tree view, select New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) master file.
For detailed instructions, see “Tree View” on page 3-8.
2 If desired, use the filter to select the master file records to display in the grid. For
detailed instructions, see “Filter” on page 3-14.
3 For Click a row on the grid. For a detailed description of the grid, see “Grid” on
page 3-19.
4 Click the
(Change [Ctrl+F9]) icon to open a New District Auhorized Position
(DAPN) dialog box in Change mode.
5 Follow the instructions for the New District Auhorized Position (DAPN) dialog
box on page 4-169. This dialog box allows you to add, change, inspect, or delete
records.
To add a record:
1 Select the New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) master file from the tree
view on the HR Code Maintenance 2 window.
4-178
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) Master File
2 Do any of the following:
◊ Click the
(Add New [Ctrl+F6]) icon in the HR Code Maintenance 2 window
to add a new record based on the one you have selected in the grid.
◊ Click the
(Add New (No Preload) [Shift+F6]) icon in the HR Code Maintenance 2 window to add a new record in a blank New District Auhorized Position (DAPN) dialog box.
◊ Follow the instructions in “To inspect a record:” on page 4-167 to open a New
District Auhorized Position (DAPN) dialog box. From that dialog box, click the
(Add New [Ctrl+F6]) icon or the
(Add New (No Preload) [Shift+F6])
icon in that dialog box.
3 Follow the instructions for the New District Auhorized Position (DAPN) dialog
box on page 4-169. This dialog box allows you to add, change, inspect, or delete
records.
To delete a record:
1 Open a New District Auhorized Position (DAPN) dialog box as described in “To
inspect a record:” on page 4-167.
The dialog box must be in Inspect mode before you can delete a record. If it is in
Change mode, click the
(Inspect [Ctrl+F5]) icon.
2 Review the New District Auhorized Position (DAPN) dialog box to be sure it is
displaying the record that you want to delete.
You can select the record to display from the Select Position list.
3 To delete, click the
(Delete [Ctrl+F8]) icon.
4 In the HR Code Maintenance dialog box, select the [OK] button to delete or the
[Cancel] button to cancel the deletion.
To maintain records with the New District Auhorized Position (DAPN) dialog box:
1 Do any of the following while the New District Auhorized Position (DAPN) dialog
box is in Inspect mode:
◊ Select the record that you want to inspect from the Position Number list.
◊ Click the
(Change [Ctrl+F9]) icon to put the dialog box in Change mode so
you can add, change, or delete records.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-179
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
◊ Add a new record in either of the following ways.
> Click the
(Add New [Ctrl+F6]) icon to add a new record by copying from
the one currently displayed in the dialog box.
> Click the
(Add New (No Preload) [Shift+F6]) icon add a new record in a
blank dialog box.
To save your changes, click the
and Stay [F9]) icon.
(Save and Return [F2]) icon or the
(Save
◊ Delete the record displayed in the dialog box. Click the
(Delete [Ctrl+F8])
icon, then confirm whether to delete the record in the dialog box.
◊ Press F12 to close the dialog box.
2 Do any of the following while the New District Auhorized Position (DAPN) dialog
box is in Change mode:
◊ Select the record that you want to change from the Position Number list.
◊ Click the
(Inspect [Ctrl+F5]) icon to put the dialog box in Inspect mode.
◊ Change anything about a record but the Position Number. To save your
changes, click the
(Save and Return [F2]) icon or the
(Save and Stay
[F9]) icon.
◊ Press F12 to close the dialog box.
To create reports of positions:
1 Click the
(Create Report [Ctrl+R]) icon to open a Position Reports dialog box.
2 Select a report from the Position Reports dialog box.
Figure 4-110: Position Reports dialog box
4-180
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) Master File
For samples of launch windows and report:
◊ See page 4-188 for the Authorized Position Report.
◊ See page 4-189 for the Employee Position Report.
◊ See page 4-190 for the Authorized Position Report (Abbreviated Format).
◊ See page 4-191 for the Position Invalid Account Report.
Header Information
Figure 4-111: Header information for the New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) master file
Table 4-109: Header information for the
New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) master file
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Select Position
Display
Selection from List
Position Number
Key
Text (6 digits)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
Supervising Position
Optional
Selection from List
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-181
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Description Tab
Figure 4-112: Description tab for the New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) master file
Table 4-110: Description for the
New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Comment
Display
Text
Appr
Optional
Date
Pos Start
Required
Date
End
Optional
Date
Applicaiton Open
Optional
Date
Close
Optional
Date
Status
Optional
Selection from List
Work Location
Optional
Selection from List
Rollover
Optional
Selection from List
Work Calendar
Optional
Selection from List
FTE
Optional
Numerals (0.000 to 1.000)
Month/Year
Optional
Numerals (0.00 to 12.00)
Days/Year
Optional
Numerals (0.00 to 360.00)
Hours/Day
Optional
Numerals (0.00 to 99.99)
Days/Week
Optional
Numerals (1 to 7)
Work Shift
Optional
Text (1 character)
4-182
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) Master File
Table 4-110: Description for the
New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) master file - continued
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Placement
[Salary Schedule]
[Range]
[Step]
[Calculation Code]
Optional
Optional
Optional
Optional
Selection from List
Selection from List
Numerals (0 to 99)
Selection from List
Projection Amt
Optional
Dollar Amount (0 to 9,999,999.999)
Position Benefits
Optional
Selection from List
Projected Opening
Optional
Selection from List
Job Sharing
Optional
Selection from List
Contract Type
Optional
Selection from List
Experience Type
Optional
Selection from List
Seniority Class
Optional
Selection from List
Bonus1
Optional
Selection from List
Bonus2
Optional
Selection from List
Bonus3
Optional
Selection from List
Bonus4
Optional
Selection from List
Bonus5
Optional
Selection from List
Requirements 1 Tab
Figure 4-113: Requirements 1 tab for the New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) master file
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-183
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-111: Requirements 1 tab for the
New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
[required or optional]
Optional
Selection from List
[credential code]
Optional
Selection from List
Type
Display
Text
Level
Display
Text
[required or optional]
Optional
Selection from List
[educational level]
Optional
Selection from List
Program
Optional
Selection from List
[required or optional]
Optional
Selection from List
[subject code]
Optional
Selection from List
Credentials
Education
Subjects
Requirements 2 Tab
Figure 4-114: Requirements 2 tab for the New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) master file
4-184
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) Master File
Table 4-112: Requirements 2 tab for the
New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
[required or optional]
Optional
Selection from List
[code]
Optional
Selection from List
[required or optional]
Optional
Selection from List
[code]
Optional
Selection from List
[score]
Optional
Numerals (0 to 9999)
[required or optional]
Optional
Selection from List
[code]
Optional
Selection from List
Years
Optional
Numerals (0 to 99)
Skills
Test Info
Experience
Account Distribution Tab
Figure 4-115: Account Distribution tab for the New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) master file
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-185
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-113: Account Distribution tab for the
New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Ln
Display
Numerals (1 to 20)
Percent
Numerals
Numerals (0.00 to 100.00)
FTE
Required
Numerals (0.000 to 1.000)
[account]
Required
Text
Start
Optional
Date
End
Optional
Date
X
Optional
Selection from List
Benefits Tab
Figure 4-116: Benefits tab for the New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) master file
Table 4-114: Benefits tab for the
New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) master file master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Line
Display
Numerals
Benefit Name
Display
Text
Select
Display
Text
Base Type
Display
Text
Base Amount/%
Display
Numerals
Limit Amount
Display
Numerals
4-186
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) Master File
Table 4-114: Benefits tab for the
New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) master file master file - continued
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Projection Type
Display
Text
Projection Amount
Display
Numerals
Reference #
Display
Numerals
Reference Name
Display
Text
Vol Ded. #
Display
Numerals
Vol Ded Name
Display
Text
Employee List Tab
Figure 4-117: Employee List tab for the New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) master file
Table 4-115: Employee List tab for the
New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) master file
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Fiscal Year
Optional
Fiscal Year
SSN
Display
Numeric Code
Name
Display
Text
Start
Display
Date
End
Display
Date
FTE
Display
Numerals
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-187
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Reports
This heading illustrates the following report launch windows and their reports:
♦
♦
♦
♦
Authorized Position Report
Employee Position Report
Authorized Position Report (Abbreviated Format)
Position Invalid Account Report
Authorized Position Report
After filling in the report launch window, click the
(Send Report [F2]) to launch
the report or the
(Cancel/Close [F12]) icon to close the window without launching
a report.
Figure 4-118: Launch screen for the District Position Report (PCR400)
Table 4-116: Launch window for the District Position Report (PCR400)
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Year
Required
Fiscal Year
Report Title
Optional
Text (30 characters)
Select position of type
Required
Selection from List
Report format
Required
Selection from List
Report sort
Required
Selection from List
Organization Levels
Required
Text
Position selection date
Optional
Date
Account selection date
Optional
Date
4-188
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) Master File
Employee Position Report
After filling in the report launch window, click the
(Send Report [F2]) to launch
the report or the
(Cancel/Close [F12]) icon to close the window without launching
a report.
Figure 4-119: Launch screen for Employee Position Report (PCR405)
Table 4-117: Launch window for the Employee Position Report (PCR405)
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Year
Required
Fiscal Year
Report Title
Optional
Text (30 characters)
Sort Option
Required
Selection from List
Organization Levels
Required
Text
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-189
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Authorized Position Report (Abbreviated Format)
After filling in the report launch window, click the
(Send Report [F2]) to launch
the report or the
(Cancel/Close [F12]) icon to close the window without launching
a report.
Figure 4-120: Launch window for the Abbreviated Position District Report (PCR420)
4-190
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) Master File
Table 4-118: Launch window for the Abbreviated District Position Report (PCR420)
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Year
Required
Fiscal Year
Report Title
Optional
Text (30 characters)
Sort Option
Required
Selection from List
Organization Levels
Required
Text
Position Invalid Account Report
After filling in the report launch window, click the
(Send Report [F2]) to launch
the report or the
(Cancel/Close [F12]) icon to close the window without launching
a report.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-191
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Figure 4-121: Launch window for the Position-Account Report (PCR409)
Table 4-119: Launch window for the Position-Account Report (PCR409)
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Year
Required
Fiscal Year
Report Title
Optional
Text (30 characters)
Sort Option
Required
Selection from List
4-192
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
Salary Schedules (SS) Master File
Salary Schedules (SS) Master File
As of August 2009, this master file is not available in QCC. For instructions, see
Chapter 8 of the QSS/OASIS Position Control Manual.
New Salary Schedules (SSN) Master File
The instructions for this master file focus on the following areas:
♦ Maintaining and Reporting Salary Schedules
♦ Description of the Dialog Box
♦ Sample Salary Schedule Matrix (PP0302)
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-193
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Maintaining and Reporting Salary Schedules
This heading provides instructions for doing the following from the HR Code Maintenance window:
♦ Inspecting and Changing Salary Schedules
♦ Adding a New Salary Schedule
♦ Deleting a Salary Schedule
Inspecting and Changing Salary Schedules
For complex master files, such as salary schedules, the grid displays only the effective
date and description. The Inspect command allows you to open a dialog box that displays the full details of the salary schedule. From here, you can add, change, or delete
salary schedules if your user security allows.
To inspect and maintain salary schedules:
1 In the tree view, open the folder for Position Control and select the New Salary
Schedules (SSN) master file. For detailed instructions, see “Tree View” on page
3-8.
2 If desired, use the filter to select the master file records to display in the grid. For
detailed instructions, see “Filter” on page 3-14.
3 To display a salary schedule, do either of the following:
◊ Double-click its row in the grid.
◊ Select the salary schedule with the command icons.
> Click a row to select it. The
record.
pointer displays to the left of the current
> You can also use the PAGE UP, PAGE DOW, UP ARROW, and DOWN
ARROW keys to move the
pointer.
> Click the
(Inspect [Ctrl+F5]) icon or the
(Change [Ctrl+F9]) icon.
For a detailed description of the grid, see “Grid” on page 3-19.
4-194
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
New Salary Schedules (SSN) Master File
4 The dialog box for maintaining a salary schedule allows you to display and maintain salary schedules.
Menu bar and toolbar
commands for
maintaining records
List for selecting a record
that is already defined.
Tabs for defining a salary
schedule.
Figure 4-122: Dialog box for displaying and maintaining tax tables
Take one of the following actions.
◊ To view another salary schedule, select it from the list at the top of the dialog
box.
◊ To add a salary schedule, click the
(Add New Salary Schedule [Ctrl+F6])
icon. For instructions, see page 4-196.
◊ To change a salary schedule, click the
(Change [Ctrl+F9]) icon. You can
change all aspects of the table except for its effective date.
The boxes that you can change have a white background. Those that you cannot
change have a shaded background.
◊ To delete a salary schedule, click the
tions, see page 4-197.
01/10
(Delete [Ctrl+F8]) icon. For instruc-
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-195
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
◊ To save your changes:
> Click the
(Save All and Return [F2]) icon to save the changes and close
the dialog box.
> Click the
(Save all and Stay [F9]) icon to save the changes and leave the
dialog box open.
You can make changes to multiple salary schedules before saving.
◊ To close the dialog box without saving changes, click the
[F12]) icon.,
(Cancel/Close
Adding a New Salary Schedule
For salary schedules, the
(Add [Ctrl+F6]) icon and the
(Add New (No Preload)
[Shift+F6]) icon work the same. Both commands provide the option to use an existing
salary schedule as the basis for creating a new one.
To add a new salary schedule:
1 Do either of the following:
◊ Click the
(Add [Ctrl+F6]) icon and the
(Add New (No Preload)
[Shift+F6]) icon in the HR Code Maintenance window.
◊ Click the
(Add New Salary Schedule [Ctrl+F6]) icon in the dialog box for
changing or inspecting salary schedules.
2 In the Add dialog box for the salary schedule, select an existing salary schedule
from which to copy.
◊ Select the Schedule, Model, and Bargaining Unit for the salary schedule.
◊ Type an optional Name up to 30 characters long.
◊ For the Use current values... check box, select the box to add from the selected
salary schedule or clear the check box
3 Do any of the following:
◊ Press F12 to cancel the add.
◊ Click the
(Clear Form [Ctrl+F1]) icon to clear the Add dialog box.
◊ Click the
(Save and Return [F2]) icon to open a dialog box for adding the
new salary schedule.
4-196
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
New Salary Schedules (SSN) Master File
Figure 4-123: Add dialog box for creating a new salary schedule from an existing one
4 Fill in the dialog box for adding the salary schedule, as described on page 4-199.
5 Click the
(Save and Return [F2]) icon to add the new salary schedule.
6 In the Confirm Closing dialog box, click the [No] button.
Deleting a Salary Schedule
You can delete a salary schedule from the HR Code Maintenance window or the dialog box for maintaining individual salary schedules.
WARNING: Do not delete a salary schedule unless you are absolutely certain that it
will never be used for payroll processing again.
To delete a salary schedule:
1 In the tree view, open the folder for Position Control and select the New Salary
Schedules (SSN) master file. For detailed instructions, see “Tree View” on page
3-8.
2 If desired, use the filter to select the master file records to display in the grid. For
detailed instructions, see “Filter” on page 3-14.
3 Do either of the following:
◊ Single-click the row for the salary schedule to delete, the click the
[Ctrl+F8]) icon in the HR Code Maintenance 2 window.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
(Delete
4-197
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
◊ Double-click the row for a salary schedule to display it in a dialog box, then
click the
(Delete [Ctrl+F8]) icon in the dialog box. This latter method
allows you to review the salary schedule to confirm it is indeed the one that you
want to delete.
4 In the Delete confirmation box, confirm or cancel the deletion.
Figure 4-124: Dialog box for confirming or cancelling the deletion of a salary schedule
◊ In the Schedule - Model list, select the salary schedule to delete.
◊ In the Range dialog box, do either of the following:
> Select Delete Salary Schedule to delete the entire salary schedule.
> Select an individual range from the list to delete just that range.
◊ To cancel the deletion, press F12.
◊ To confirm the deletion, click the
(Delete [Ctrl+F8]) icon.
In the Confirm Delete dialog message, click the [Yes] button to delete or the
[No] button to cancel the deletion.
Creating Reports
The InstaPrint report on the dialog box for maintaining tax rate tables.
To create a Salary Schedule Matrix (PP0302) report:
1 From the HR Code Maintenance 2 window, click the
icon.
4-198
Copyright © QSS, 2010
(Create Report [Ctrl+R])
01/10
Position Control Master Files
New Salary Schedules (SSN) Master File
2 Fill in the Report for PC Salary Schedules window, then click the
(Send Report
[F2]) icon to launch the report or the
(Cancel/Close [F12]) icon to close the dialog box without launching a report.
For a sample of the Salary Schedule Matrix, see
To create an InstaPrint report:
1 From the HR Code Maintenance 2 window, open a dialog box for a salary schedule as described on page 4-194.
2 Click the
(InstaPrint [Ctrl+F11]) icon to open a dialog box that displays the
current salary schedule.
Figure 4-125: Sample InstaPrint report
This window allows you to save the report to a file or print it to a .pdf, .doc, or .xls
file. For instructions, see Appendix B.
Description of the Dialog Box
The New PC Salary Schedules (SSN) dialog box has the following parts:
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
01/10
Header Information
Schedule Calculation Factors Tab
Payroll Interface Rules Tab
Bonus Calculation Rules Tab
Steps and Ranges Tab
Benefits Tab
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-199
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Header Information
Figure 4-126: Header information for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN) master file
Table 4-120: Header information for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Di
Display
Numerals (2 digits)
Fy
Display
Fiscal Year
Start Date
Display
Date
End Date
Display
Date
xx Schedules in yyyy
Optional
Selection from List (Inspect mode only)
Schedule
Display
Selection from List
Model
Display
Selection from List
Name
Optional
Text (30 characters)
Bargaining Unit
Optional
Selection from List (Bargaining Units
master file)
Schedule Calculation Factors Tab
Table 4-121: Schedule Calculation factors tab
for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
First Step
Display
Numeric Code (2 digits)
Last Step
Required
Numeric Code (2 digits)
Range Type
Required
Selection from Option Buttons
Direction of Advancement
Required
Selection from Option Buttons
Use FTE as a factor in annual base
calculation
Required
Selection from Option Buttons
Default Work Calendar
Required
Selection from List (Work Calendar
master file)
Advance On
Required
Selection from List
Cutoff Date
Required
Date
Calculate Increase
Required
Selection from List
4-200
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
New Salary Schedules (SSN) Master File
Figure 4-127: Schedule Calculation Factors tab for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN) master file
Table 4-121: Schedule Calculation factors tab
for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN) master file - continued
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Step Delta
Required
Selection from Option Buttons
Range Delta
Required
Selection from Option Buttons
Schedule Type
Required
Selection from List
Rounding Rule
Optional
Selection from List
Bonus Rounding Rule
Optional
Selection from List
Effective Date 1
Optional
Date
Effective Date 2
Optional
Date
Effective Date 3
Optional
Date
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-201
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Payroll Interface Rules Tab
Figure 4-128: Payroll Interface tab for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN) master file
Table 4-122: Payroll Interface Rules tab
for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Pay Schedule
Optional
Selection from List (Pay Schedule master
file)
Pay Cycle
Display
Text (2 characters)
Pay Rate
Optional
Selection from List
Pay Type
Optional
Selection from List (Pay Type master file)
Retirement Base Rate
Optional
Selection from List
Calculation Rule
Optional
Selection from List
Bonus Calculation Rules Tab
Table 4-123: Bonus Calculation Rules tab
for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Shift Diff $
Optional
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 999999.99)
Masters $
Optional
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 999999.99)
Doctorate $
Optional
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 999999.99)
Special $
Optional
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 999999.99)
Priority
Required
Selection from Option Buttons
4-202
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
New Salary Schedules (SSN) Master File
Figure 4-129: Bonus Calculation Rules tab for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN) master file
Table 4-123: Bonus Calculation Rules tab
for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN) master file - continued
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Degree Bonus Code
Optional
Selection from List (Bonus Codes master
file)
Longevity Bonus Code
Optional
Selection from List (Longevity Bonus
Codes master file)
Longevity Type
Optional
Selection from List
Longevity Rule
Optional
Text
Longevity Plateau Values (yr/amt)
Optional
Fiscal Year (yr)
Numerals (amt)
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-203
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Steps and Ranges Tab
Figure 4-130: Steps and Ranges tab for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN) master file
Table 4-124: Steps and Ranges tab for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Range
Required
Selection from List
Range Name
Optional
Text (30 characters)
Abbr
Optional
Text (8 characters)
Rank Order
Required
Selection from List
Step Delta for Range
Required
Selection from Option Buttons
Numerals (dollar amount or percentage)
Required
Dollar Amount
Iteration 00 through Iteration 03 subtabs
[grid of ranges and steps]
After making changes to ranges and steps, click the
Save Ranges [Ctrl+Shift+S]
command. The following commands on the toolbar are available only when you are
using the Steps and Ranges tab:
Figure 4-131: Commands used only on the Steps and Ranges tab
4-204
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
New Salary Schedules (SSN) Master File
Clear selected ranges second through last steps [Ctrl+Shift+F1]
Click a row in the salary schedule grid, then click this icon to
zero out the amounts for Step 2 through the last cell in the row.
Calculate all Ranges [Shift+F4]
Apply the Step Delta for Range to all ranges for which Step 2
through the final step are all zeros. To clear out a row for recalculation, use the Clear selected ranges... command before
recalculating all ranges.
Calculate Current Range [Ctrl+Shift+F4]
Apply the Step Delta for Range to the range that you have
selected in the grid. This command works only when Step 2
through the final step are all zeros. To clear out a row for recalculation, use the Clear selected ranges... command.
Select $/Deltas [Ctrl+Shift+F5]
This command is available when you select one of the cumulative methods in the Calculate Increase list on the Schedule Calculation Factors tab. Click this icon to open a row above each
range so that you can specify the delta for each step in a range.
Click again to remove the extra row so you can type dollar
amounts in each cell.
Add Range [Ctrl+Shift+F6]
Add a range to the salary schedule as a new row in the grid. This
command opens an Add Range dialog box. The Range is
required. All other boxes are optional.
♦ Type a Range, which can be either 4 characters or 4 digits
based on the Range Type selection in the Schedule Calculation Factors tab.
♦ Type a Range Name up to 30 characters long and a Range
Abbreviation up to 8 characters long.
♦ For the Step Delta, select the radio button for a dollar percentage and type the delta between steps.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-205
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
♦ For First Step Amount $, type the dollar amount for the Step
1 cell in the salary schedule grid. If you type in both a Step
Delta and a First Step Amount $, the system fills in all steps
in the range after you add it.
♦ Do any of the following:
◊ Click the
(Save and Return [F2]) icon to add the range
and close the dialog box.
◊ Click the
(Save and Stay [F9]) icon to add the range
and leave the dialog box open so you can add another
range.
◊ Click the
(Clear Screen [Ctrl+F1) icon to clear the
boxes in the dialog box.
◊ Press F12 to close the dialog box without adding a range.
Move Range Down [Ctrl+Down]
Move the selected row for a range down to the bottom of the
grid.
Move Range Up [Ctrl+Up]
Move the selected range up one row in the grid.
Delete Newly Added Range [Ctrl+Delete]
Delete the range that you just added with the Add Range
command.
Benefits Tab
Table 4-125: Benefits tab for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Line
Display
Numerals
Benefit Name
Display
Text
Select
Display
Text
Base Type
Display
Text
Base Amount/%
Display
Numerals
4-206
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
New Salary Schedules (SSN) Master File
Figure 4-132: Benefits tab for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN) master file
Table 4-125: Benefits tab for the New PC Salary Schedules (SSN) master file - continued
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Limit Amount
Display
Numerals
Projection Type
Display
Text
Projection Amount
Display
Numerals
Reference #
Display
Numerals
Reference Name
Display
Text
Vol Ded. #
Display
Numerals
Vol Ded Name
Display
Text
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-207
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Sample Salary Schedule Matrix (PP0302)
07 QSS DEMONSTRATION DISTRICT
Sample for Documentation
ADDITIONAL PAY FOR MASTERS:
YEAR: 97
1,000.00
SALARY SCHEDULE MATRIX
5-00 cERTIFICATED
FOR DOCTORATE:
1,000.00
J8690
MISCELLANEOUS BONUS:
PP0302
H.00.01 07/22/09 PAGE
16
2,359.00
LONGEVITY BONUSES($)/YEARS:
$
$
$
BEGINNING STEP:
\STEP
RANGE\
11
1
MAXIMUM STEP: 29
12
13
STEP INCREMENT: $
14
.00
15
RANGE INCREMENT: $
16
17
.00
18
VALUES ARE YEARLY
19
ADV. TYPE: NO ADVA
20
0000
35,860.00
37,016.00 38,173.00 39,330.00
RANGE 0000 STEP INCREMENT: $
39,330.00 39,330.00
0.00 RANK ORDER:
39,330.00 39,330.00
0.00 NAME:
39,330.00
39,330.00
ABRV:
0001
36,969.00
38,161.00 39,353.00 40,547.00
RANGE 0001 STEP INCREMENT: $
40,547.00 40,547.00
0.00 RANK ORDER:
40,547.00 40,547.00
1.00 NAME:
40,547.00
40,547.00
ABRV:
0002
38,161.00
39,353.00 40,547.00 41,740.00
RANGE 0002 STEP INCREMENT: $
41,740.00 41,740.00
0.00 RANK ORDER:
42,933.00 42,933.00
2.00 NAME:
42,933.00
44,125.00
ABRV:
0003
39,353.00
40,547.00 41,740.00 42,933.00
RANGE 0003 STEP INCREMENT: $
42,933.00 42,933.00
0.00 RANK ORDER:
44,125.00 44,125.00
3.00 NAME:
44,125.00
45,318.00
ABRV:
0004
40,547.00
41,740.00 42,933.00 44,125.00
RANGE 0004 STEP INCREMENT: $
44,125.00 44,125.00
0.00 RANK ORDER:
45,318.00 45,318.00
4.00 NAME:
45,318.00
46,510.00
ABRV:
4-208
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
Work Calendars (WC) Master File
Work Calendars (WC) Master File
The instructions for this master file focus on the following areas:
♦
♦
♦
♦
Overview
Maintaining Work Calendars
Changing Days on the Calendar
Report Sample
Overview
Table 4-126: Work Calendars (WC) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Calendar Codes
Display
Selection from List
Fiscal Year
Key
Fiscal Year
Code Value
Key
Numeric Code (4 digits)
Using Calendar
Optional
Selection from List
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Hrs/Day
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 24.00)
Mo/Yr
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 12.00)
Payroll Days
Optional
Numerals (0.00 to 365.00)
July - December yy
January - June yy
Display
Graphic display of calendar
Contract Days
Required
Selection from List
Calendar Days
Display
Start and end of fiscal year
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-209
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Figure 4-133: Change Work Calendars dialog box
Maintaining Work Calendars
The instructions for work calendars are different from other master files:
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 4-210.
For changing or deleting, see page 4-211.
For adding, see page 4-212.
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
To inspect a work calendar:
1 In the tree view, open the folder for Position Control. For detailed instructions,
see “Tree View” on page 2-8.
2 If desired, use the filter to select the master file records to display in the grid. For
detailed instructions, see “Filter” on page 2-13.
3 Click a work calendar on the search results grid.
4 Click the
4-210
(Inspect [Ctrl+F5]) icon to open a View Work Calendar dialog box.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
Work Calendars (WC) Master File
Key to codes for
each type of day
on the calendar.
Tabs for selecting
the month to view.
Each tab displays
the calendars for 4
months.
Figure 4-134: View Work Calendars dialog box
5 Do any of the following:
◊ Click the
(Cancel/Close [F12]) icon to close the dialog box.
◊ Click a VCR button to display another work calendar.
Display the first item in the search list.
Display the previous item in the search list.
Display the last item in the search list.
Display the next item in the search list.
◊ Click the
(Print Screen [F11]) icon to print a copy of the dialog box on the
default Windows printer for your PC.
To add a work calendar:
1 Click the
(Add [Ctrl+F6]) icon or the
(Add New (No Preload) [Shift+F6])
icon to open an Add Work Calendars dialog box.
2 Type a 4-digit Code Value that has not been used for another work calendar.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-211
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
3 In the Using Calendar list, leave the selection blank to build a work calendar from
scratch or select an existing work calendar as the basis for building a new one.
4 Type the Name, Hrs/Day, Mo/Yr, optional Payroll Days, and the range of dates
in the Contract Dates.
5 The Calendar Dates are the start and end of the fiscal year.
6 Click [Merge Holidays] to insert the standard holidays for you site into the
calendar.
7 To define the work calendar for a month, click the tab for July - October,
November - February, or March - June.
8 To set up the days for a month click a month button above a calendar to open a dialog box for setting up the month. For instructions, see page 4-213.
Click the button above a
calendar to change the
designations for its days.
Figure 4-135: Button for modifying the days in a monthly calendar
To change or delete a work calendar:
1 In the tree view, open the folder for Payroll and the subfolder for Tax Tables. For
detailed instructions, see “Tree View” on page 3-8.
2 If desired, use the filter to select the master file records to display in the grid. For
detailed instructions, see “Filter” on page 3-14.
3 Click a work calendar on the search results grid.
4 Click the
(Change [Ctrl+F9]) icon.
5 In the Calendar Codes list, select the calendar to change.
6 The Fiscal Year, Code value, and Using Calendar boxes are not available for
Change mode.
7 Type the Name, Hrs/Day, Mo/Yr, optional Payroll Days, and the range of dates
in the Contract Dates.
8 The Calendar Dates are the start and end of the fiscal year.
4-212
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
Work Calendars (WC) Master File
9 Click [Merge Holidays] to insert the standard holidays for you site into the
calendar.
10To define the work calendar for a month, click the tab for July - October,
November - February, or March - June.
11 To set up the days for a month click a month button above a calendar to open a dialog box for setting up the month. For instructions, see page 4-213.
Click the button above a
calendar to change the
designations for its days.
Figure 4-136: Button for modifying the days in a monthly calendar
Changing Days on the Calendar
While you are adding or changing a work calendar you can change the designations
for each day in the calendar.
To change days on a calendar:
1 In the Legend area, click the colored box for a type of day.
The box indicates the
selection that you have
clicked, and the Current
Selection changes to
the color of the day you
have selected.
Figure 4-137: Legend area after clicking Paid Holiday (PH)
To clear the selection, click Release Selection.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-213
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
2 Drag the mouse pointer over the day that you want to change in the calendar.
The box follows the arrow as
it points to a date on the
calendar.
Figure 4-138: Mouse pointer hovered over August 23
3 Click the day that you want to change.
After you click a box in the calendar,
it changes to the code you have
selected.
Figure 4-139: Calendar after clicking August 23
4 Repeat Steps 1 through 3 to assign codes to additional days on the calendar.
5 Do any of the following:
◊ Select the [Save] button to save your changes to the calendar.
◊ Select the [Undo] button to undo the changes to the calendar.
◊ Select the [Cancel/Close] button to close the dialog box without saving your
changes.
6 In the toolbar, click any of the following commands:
4-214
◊ Click the
(Save [F9]) icon to save the changes to the calendar.
◊ Click the
(Cancel/Close [F12]) icon to close the dialog box.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Position Control Master Files
Work Calendars (WC) Master File
◊ Click the
(Undo Changes [Shift+F1]) icon to clear all changes made since
you opened the dialog box.
◊ Click a VCR button to go to a different month.
Display the last item in the search list.
Display the first item in the search list.
Display the previous item in the search list.
Display the next item in the search list.
◊ Click the
(Print Screen [F11]) icon to print a copy of the dialog box on the
default Windows printer for your PC.
Report Sample
82 QSS DEMO DISTRICT #82
SAMPLE FOR DOCUMENTATION
J8239
PP0350
H.00.04
07/09/09
PAGE
WORK CALENDAR REPORT
CALENDAR: 0000 Default
YEAR: 2006-2007
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 3 3
MONTH
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 #Pai
==============================================================================
JULY
| N N . H . . . N N . . . . . N N . . . . . N N . . . . . N N . 21.0
AUGUST
| . . . . N N . . . . . N N . . . . . N N . . . . . N N . . . . 23.0
SEPTEMBER | . N N H . . . . N N . . . . . N N . . . . . N N . . . . . N
21.0
OCTOBER
| N . . . . . N N . . . . . N N . . . . . N N . . . . . N N . . 22.0
NOVEMBER | . . . N N . . . . H N N . . . . . N N . . . H H N N . . . .
22.0
DECEMBER | . N N . . . . . N N . . . . . N N . . . . . N N H H . . . N N 21.0
JANUARY
| H H . . . N N . . . . . N N H . . . . N N . . . . . N N . . . 23.0
FEBRUARY | . . N N . . . . . N N H . . . . N N H . . . . N N . . .
20.0
MARCH
| . . N N . . . . . N N . . . . . N N . . . . . N N . . . . . N 22.0
APRIL
| N . . . . . N N . . . . . N N . . . . H N N . . . . . N N .
21.0
MAY
| . . . . N N . . . . . N N . . . . . N N . . . . . N N H . . . 23.0
JUNE
| . N N . . . . . N N . . . . . N N . . . . . N N . . . . . N
21.0
==============================================================================
CONTRACT DATES: 07/03/2006-06/29/2007
HOURS/DAY:
CALENDAR DATES: 07/03/2006-06/29/2007 MONTHS/YEAR:
PAYROLL DAYS:
8.00
12.00
0.00
PAID DAYS: 260.0
WORK DAYS: 246.0
HOLIDAY DAYS: 14.0
SYMBOL LEGEND:
.
/
N
H
X
01/10
=
=
=
=
=
REGULAR PAID WORK DAY (FULL)
REGULAR PAID WORK DAY (HALF)
NON WORK DAY
PAID HOLIDAY
SPECIAL NON WORK DAY (NOT PAID)
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-215
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Master File Links
The Master File Links folder allows the county to link codes in linked county master
files to individual districts. This heading lists the master files and subfolders in the
same order that they display in the tree view.
Table 4-127: Master files in the Master File Links folder
MASTER FILE
CODE
LEVEL
PAGE
Pay Code Links
FL01
District
4-216
Voluntary Deduction Code Links
FL02
District
4-217
Vol-Ded Frequency Code Links
FL03
District
4-218
Pay Schedule Code Links
FL04
District
4-219
Stat Ded Profile Code Links
FL05
District
4-220
Deduction Schedule Code Links
FL06
District
4-221
For additional lists of master files documented in the chapter, see:
♦ "Table 4-1: Master files by folder on tree view" on page 4-4
♦ "Table 4-2: Master files by name" on page 4-7
♦ "Table 4-3: Master files by code" on page 4-10
Pay Code Links (FL01) Master File
Figure 4-140: Add dialog box for the Pay Code Links (FL01) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Pay Code Links (FL01) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
4-216
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Master File Links
Voluntary Deduction Code Links (FL02) Master File
♦ For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-128: Pay Code Links (FL01) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Link
Display
Selection from List
For District
Display
Current district for QCC session
M-Pay-Code-Number
Required
Selection from List (30 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
For a sample report, see page 4-221.
Voluntary Deduction Code Links (FL02) Master File
Figure 4-141: Add dialog box for the Voluntary Deduction Code Links (FL02) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Voluntary Deduction Code Links (FL02)
master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
01/10
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-217
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-129: Voluntary Deduction Code Links (FL02) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Link
Display
Selection from List
For District
Display
Numerals (2 digits)
Vol-Deds Number
Required
Numerals (4 digits)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
For a sample report, see page 4-221.
Vol-Ded Frequency Code Links (FL03) Master File
Figure 4-142: Add dialog box for the Vol-Ded Frequency Code Links (FL03) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Vol-Ded Frequency Code Links (FL03) master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-130: Vol-Ded Frequency Code Links (FL03) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Link
Display
Selection from List
For District
Display
Numerals (2 digits)
VolDed-Freq Number
Required
Numerals (2 digits)
4-218
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Master File Links
Pay Schedule Code Links (FL04) Master File
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
For a sample report, see page 4-221.
Pay Schedule Code Links (FL04) Master File
Figure 4-143: Add dialog box for the Pay Schedule Code Links (FL04) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Pay Schedule Code Links (FL04) master file.
The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-131: Pay Schedule Code Links (FL04) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Link
Display
Selection from List
For District
Display
Numerals (2 digits)
Year
Key
Fiscal Year
M-PAY-SCHEDULE Number
Required
Text (6 characters upshifted)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-219
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Stat Ded Profile Code Links (FL05) Master File
Figure 4-144: Add dialog box for the Stat Ded Profile Code Links (FL05) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Stat Ded Profile Code Links (FL05) master
file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-132: Stat Ded Profile Code Links (FL05) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Link
Display
Selection from List
For District
Display
Numerals (2 digits)
M-STA-DED-PROFILE Number
Required
Text (6 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
For a sample report, see page 4-221.
4-220
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Master File Links
Deduction Schedule Code Links (FL06) Master File
Deduction Schedule Code Links (FL06) Master File
Figure 4-145: Add dialog box for the Deduction Schedule Code Links (FL06) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Deduction Schedule Code Links (FL06)
master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-133: Deduction Schedule Code Links (FL06) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Link
Display
Selection from List
For District
Display
Numerals (2 digits)
Year
Key
Fiscal Year
M-DED-SCHEDULE Number
Required
Text (2 characters upshifted)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
For a sample report, see page 4-221.
Link Report
The following sample illustrates the format for link reports. The format is the same
for all linked files.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-221
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
07 CPI DEMONSTRATION DISTRICT
SAMPLE FOR DOCUMENTATION
S1754
PX0100
Payroll: Voluntary Deductions
H.00.00
10/29/00
PAGE
1
Numeric Sort
Number
Name
Abbreviation
-------------------------------------------------------------------------2004
FOUNDATION HELATH PLAN
FNDATION
2009
REGAL
REGAL
2011
DELTA DENTAL PLAN
DENTAL
2045
CALIFORNIA VISION PLAN
VISION
3101
NATIONAL BANKERS LIFE ASSUR.
NAT/LIF
3103
RELIABLE LIFE INSURANCE
REL/LIFE
3106
COLONIAL LIFE & ACCI. INS
CL/LF/AC
3112
PROVIDENCE LIFE INS CO
PROV/LIF
3431
NATIONAL LIFE OF KANSAS
NAT/KAN
3432
NATIONAL TRUST AND LIFE
NAT/TRU
3433
FARMERS DISABILITY
FARM/DIS
3434
CONTINENTAL CASUALTY ACC/LIFE
CONT/CAS
3441
WASHINGTON NATIONAL LIFE INSUR
WASH/NAT
3452
PROVIDENCE INCOME PROTECTION
PROV/IP
4203
AMERICAN FIDELITY ASSURANCE CO
AM/FIDEL
4402
CALIFORNIA CASUALTY
CAL/CAS
4501
KAISER FOUNDATION HEALTH PLAN
KAISER
4501
STATE AND FEDERAL CREDIT UNION
CREDUN
4502
FSP HEALTH PLAN
FSP
4502
TAKE CARE
TAKECARE
4508
CHILDRENS HOSPITAL
CHILD
4601
CHARITY FUND
CHARITY
6803
MEDICAL MANAGEMENT CORP
MEDMAN
9115
UNITED OF OMAHOA LIFE INC
UNITED
9120
UNITED ATLANTIC LIFE
UNATL
9200
USAA LIFE INSURANCE CO
USAA LIF
9303
TWENTIETH CENTURY INVESTORS
TWEN/CEN
9311
UNITED OLYMPIC LIFE INSURANCE
UNI OLYM
9430
WESTERN NATIONAL LIFE INS CO
W NATL
9435
WESTERN LIFE INSURANCE CO
WEST LIF
9535
VARIABLE ANNUITY LIFE INS CO
VAR A L
9763
PACIFIC COAST LIFE AND CASUALTY
PC LIFE
9820
VANGUARD FIDUCIARY TRUST CO
VANG FID
9956
WASHINGTON NATIONAL INS. CO.
WN NATL
4-222
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Benefits Management Master Files
Coverage Level Codes (BMLC) Master File
Benefits Management Master Files
The Absence Tracking folder contains the master files for the HR Absence Tracking
window and its related reports and processes. This heading lists the master files and
subfolders in the same order that they display in the tree view.
Table 4-134: Master files in the Benefits Management folder
MASTER FILE
CODE
LEVEL
PAGE
Coverage Level Codes
BMLC
District
4-223
Deduction Class List
BMCL
District
4-226
Dependent Codes
BDCM
District
4-227
FTE Allocation Table
BMFT
District
4-229
Package Codes
BMPK
District
4-234
Plan/Level Amounts
BMPL
District
4-240
Cap Amounts
BMCA
District
4-242
Benefit Status Codes
BMBS
District
4-243
Package Assignment
BMPA
District
4-244
For additional lists of master files documented in the chapter, see:
♦ "Table 4-1: Master files by folder on tree view" on page 4-4
♦ "Table 4-2: Master files by name" on page 4-7
♦ "Table 4-3: Master files by code" on page 4-10
Coverage Level Codes (BMLC) Master File
Figure 4-146: Add dialog box for the Coverage Level Codes (BMLC) master file
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-223
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
This heading describes the boxes for the Coverage Level Codes (BMLC) master file.
The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-135: Coverage Level Codes (BMLC) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Codes
Display
Selection from List
Level Code
Key
4 characters (upshifted)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbr
Required
Text (8 characters)
Level Type
Optional
Selection from List
Age Range
Optional or
Required
Numerals (2 digits)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
4-224
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Benefits Management Master Files
Coverage Level Codes (BMLC) Master File
65 QSS UNIFIED SCHOOL DISTRICT
SORTED BY CODE
COVERAGE LEVEL CODES
SORT BY CODE
J697
BM0100
H.00.11 06/12/06 PAGE
1
CODE
NAME
ABBR
LEVEL TYPE
AGE LOW
AGE HIGH
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------2529
Age 25-29
25-29
A
25
29
3034
Age 30-34
30-34
A
30
34
3539
Age 35-39
35-39
A
35
39
4044
Age 40-44
40-44
A
40
44
4549
Age 45-49
45-49
A
45
49
5054
Age 50-54
50-54
A
50
54
5559
Age 55-59
55-59
A
55
59
6064
Age 60-64
60-64
A
60
64
6569
Age 65-69
65-69
A
65
69
7070
Age 70
70
A
70
70
7074
Age 70-74
70-74
A
70
74
7579
Age 75-79
75-79
A
75
79
8084
Age 80-84
80-84
A
80
84
ANY
ANY
ANY
CHLD
Child Policy
Child
A
00
99
E
EMPLOYEE ONLY
EMP ONLY
E1
EMPLOYEE PLUS ONE
EMP + 1
E1C
EMPLOYEE + ONE CAPPED
EMP1CAP
E2
EMPLOYEE PLUS TWO OR MORE
EMP + MO
E2C
EMPLOYEE + FAMILY CAPPED
EMP2CAP
EC
EMPLOYEE ONLY - CAPPED
EMPCAP
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-225
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Deduction Class List (BMCL) Master File
Figure 4-147: Add dialog box for the Deduction Class List (BMCL) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Deduction Class List (BMCL) master file.
The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-136: Deduction Class List (BMCL) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Class
Display
Selection from List
Vol Ded
Required
Selection from List
Vol-Ded
Description
Display
Voluntary deduction numbers in the class
4-226
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Benefits Management Master Files
Dependent Codes (BMDC) Master File
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
65 QSS UNIFIED SCHOOL DISTRICT
SAMPLE FOR DOCUMENTATION
J103
DEDUCTION CLASS LIST
BM0100
H.00.05
05/25/05 PAGE
1
SORT BY CLASS
DEDUCTION
CLASS CODE NAME
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------1
0026
MSIA/DENTAL FUND
1
0032
MSIA/VISION FUND
1
0033
MSIA/VISION FD. 34-CLASSIFIED
1
0034
MSIA/VISION FUND 34-CERTIFICAT
1
0134
MSIA/VISION FUND 34 CLASSIFIED
Dependent Codes (BMDC) Master File
Figure 4-148: Add dialog box for the Dependent Codes (BMDC) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Dependent Codes (BMDC) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
01/10
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-227
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-137: Dependent Codes (BMDC) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (2 characters)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
65 QSS Unified School District
FOR CYNTHIA
J850
BM0100
DEPENDENT CODES
H.00.05
01/03/01
PAGE 1
SORT BY CODE
CODE
NAME
ABBR
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------
4-228
CH
CHILD
CHILD
DP
DOMESTIC PARTNER
PARTNER
DS
DISABLED
DISABLED
PA
PARENT - DEPENDENT
PARENT
SC
STEP-CHILD
STEP-CH
SP
SPOUSE
SPOUSE
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Benefits Management Master Files
FTE Allocation Table (BMFT) Master File
FTE Allocation Table (BMFT) Master File
Header information
for the FTE
Allocation table
The Add New/Edit
area allows you add
or insert rows in the
grid of FTE ranges.
The grid displays up
to 10 FTE ranges
created with the
Add New/Edit
area.
Figure 4-149: Change dialog box for the FTE Allocation Table (BMFT) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the FTE Allocation Table (BMFT) master file.
The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
01/10
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no prefill available).
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, changing, and deleting ranges on the grid, see page 4-231.
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-229
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-138: FTE Allocation Table (BMFT) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Code
Display
Selection from List
Allocation
Key
Numeric Code (2 characters)
Text (2 characters)
Text (2 characters)
Type
Required
Selection from List
Plan/level/start date
Required
Selection from List (Plan/Level/Amount
master file)
Amounts are
Required
Selection from List
Premium Amount
Display
Dollar Amount
FTE Low
Required
Numerals (.0000 to 1.0000)
FTE High
Display
Numerals (.0000 to 1.0000)
Employee Amount
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 100.00 percent or 0.00
to 9999.99 dollars)
Employer Amount
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 100.00 percent or 0.00
to 9999.99 dollars)
Replace
Insert
Required
Selection from Option Buttons
[line number]
Display
Numerals (1 to 20)
FTE Low
Display
Numerals (.0000 to 1.0000)
FTE High
Display
Numerals (.0000 to 1.0000)
Employee Amount
Display
Numerals (0.00 to 100.00 percent or 0.00
to 9999.99 dollars)
Employer Amount
Display
Numerals (0.00 to 100.00 percent or 0.00
to 9999.99 dollars)
Add New/Edit
[table of FTE ranges]
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
These instructions tell how to add, change, and delete ranges from the grid on the bottom of the dialog box. Each allocation table can have up to 20 rows. The definition
must completely cover all FTEs from 0.0000 to 1.0000.
4-230
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Benefits Management Master Files
FTE Allocation Table (BMFT) Master File
To add a row:
1 Do either of the following:
◊ To add to the end, click the blank row below existing rows.
◊ To insert a row, click the row above the one that you want to insert.
2 Change the information in the Add New/Edit area.
◊ In the FTE Low box, type the low end of the FTE range as a number from
.0000 to 1.0000 FTE.
> The FTE Low must be more than that in the row above it and less than in the
row below it.
> The system automatically fills in the FTE High based on the FTE Low for
the next row on the grid.
◊ Type the Employee Amount and Employer Amount for each party’s contributions to the cost of the benefit.
The Amounts are box determines what to type. For Dollars type the dollar
amount of employee and employer contributions. For Percentage, type the percentages of the benefit costs.
3 Do either of the following:
◊ Select the Replace radio to replace the selected row.
◊ Select the Insert radio button to insert a new row below the one that you have
selected.
4 Click the [Accept] button to change the row in the grid.
To change a row:
1 Click the row that you want to change.
2 Change the information in the Add New/Edit area.
◊ In the FTE Low box, type the low end of the FTE range as a number from
.0000 to 1.0000 FTE.
> The FTE Low must be more than that in the row above it and less than in the
row below it.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-231
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
> The system automatically fills in the FTE High based on the FTE Low for
the next row on the grid.
◊ Type the Employee Amount and Employer Amount for each party’s contributions to the cost of the benefit.
The Amounts are box determines what to type. For Dollars type the dollar
amount of employee and employer contributions. For Percentage, type the percentages of the benefit costs.
◊ Make sure the Replace radio button is selected.
3 Click the [Accept] button to change the row in the grid.
To delete a row from the grid:
1 Click the row to delete.
2 Point to the Options menu, then select Clear Row.
4-232
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Benefits Management Master Files
FTE Allocation Table (BMFT) Master File
65 QSS UNIFIED SCHOOL DISTRICT
BY START DATE--2000, 2001
J67
BM0100
FTE ALLOCATION TABLE
H.00.05
04/12/01 PAGE
1
SORT BY START DATE
ALLOCATION
START
---FTE RANGE--EMPLOYEE
EMPLOYER
CODE
TYPE PLAN LEVEL DATE
LOW
HIGH
AMOUNT
AMOUNT
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------
01/10
01-E -01
L
KS1
E
07/01/2001
0.0000
0.2500
0.5000
0.7500
-
0.2499
0.4999
0.7499
1.0000
$ 170.32
$ 130.32
$ 85.16
$
0.00
$
0.00
$ 40.00
$ 85.16
$ 170.32
01-E1-01
L
KS1
E1
07/01/2001
0.0000
0.2500
0.5000
0.7500
-
0.2499
0.4999
0.7499
1.0000
$ 347.58
$ 267.58
$ 173.79
$
0.00
$
0.00
$ 80.00
$ 173.79
$ 347.58
01-E2-01
L
KS1
E2
07/01/2001
0.0000
0.2500
0.5000
0.7500
-
0.2499
0.4999
0.7499
1.0000
$ 479.43
$ 359.43
$ 239.71
$
0.00
$
0.00
$ 120.00
$ 239.72
$ 479.43
02-E -01
L
KS2
E
07/01/2001
0.0000
0.2500
0.5000
0.7500
-
0.2499
0.4999
0.7499
1.0000
$ 175.04
$ 135.04
$ 87.52
$
0.00
$
0.00
$ 40.00
$ 87.52
$ 175.04
02-E1-01
L
KS2
E1
07/01/2001
0.0000
0.2500
0.5000
0.7500
-
0.2499
0.4999
0.7499
1.0000
$ 367.22
$ 277.22
$ 183.61
$
0.00
$
0.00
$ 90.00
$ 183.61
$ 367.22
02-E2-01
L
KS2
E2
07/01/2001
0.0000
0.2500
0.5000
0.7500
-
0.2499
0.4999
0.7499
1.0000
$ 504.44
$ 384.44
$ 252.22
$
0.00
$
0.00
$ 120.00
$ 252.22
$ 504.44
01-E -00
L
KS1
E
07/01/2000
0.0000
0.2500
0.5000
0.7500
-
0.2499
0.4999
0.7499
1.0000
$ 153.57
$ 115.18
$ 76.78
$
0.00
$
0.00
$ 38.39
$ 76.79
$ 153.57
01-E1-00
L
KS1
E1
07/01/2000
0.0000
0.2500
0.5000
0.7500
-
0.2499
0.4999
0.7499
1.0000
$ 325.07
$ 243.80
$ 162.53
$
0.00
$
0.00
$ 81.27
$ 162.54
$ 325.07
01-E2-00
L
KS1
E2
07/01/2000
0.0000
0.2500
0.5000
0.7500
-
0.2499
0.4999
0.7499
1.0000
$ 446.79
$ 335.09
$ 223.39
$
0.00
$
0.00
$ 111.70
$ 223.40
$ 446.79
02-E -00
L
KS2
E
07/01/2000
0.0000 - 0.2499
0.2500 - 0.4999
0.5000 - 0.7499
$ 164.84
$ 123.63
$ 82.42
$
$
$
Copyright © QSS, 2010
0.00
41.21
82.42
4-233
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Package Codes (BMPK) Master File
Figure 4-150: Add dialog box for the Package Codes (BMPK) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Package Codes (BMPK) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no prefill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-139: Package Codes (BMPK) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Package codes
Display
Selection from List
Package code
Key
Text (2 characters)
Package name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbr
Required
Text (8 characters)
4-234
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Benefits Management Master Files
Package Codes (BMPK) Master File
Table 4-139: Package Codes (BMPK) master file - continued
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Default coverage level
Optional
Selection from List (Coverage Level
[BMCL] master file)
FTE
Optional
Selection from List
FTE lock rule
Optional
Selection from List
Amounts
Optional
Selection from List
Salary
Optional
Selection from List
Salary lock
Optional
Selection from List
Sect 125
Optional
Selection from List
Primary coverage
Optional
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Cobra flag
Optional
Selection from List
M
Optional
Text (2 characters)
D
Optional
Text (1 character)
Optional
Selection from List (Plan Codes [BMPC]
master file)
Plan
Display
Text (4 characters)
Description
Display
Text (30 characters)
Default rules:
Default flags
Add/Remove Plan
Plan
[list of plans]
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-235
Human Resources Master Files Manual
65 QSS UNIFIED SCHOOL DISTRICT
ALL PACKAGE CODES
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
PACKAGE CODES
SORT BY CODE
J707
BM0100
H.00.11 06/19/06 PAGE
1
DFT
FTE AMT
SAL
SEC PRI COB
CODE
NAME
ABBR
LEVEL RULE RULE RULE 125 MARY RA M
D
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------1L
MED-LIFE
PLANS:
MED-LIFE
AP L
KAISER - CLASSIFIED
JOHN HANCOCK MUTUAL LIFE
L
N
Y
N
5L
KAISER - CLASSIFIED BASIC
KS CL BA
AP L
PLANS:
KS2
KAISER - CLASSIFIED
DDCL DELTA DENTAL - CLASSIFIED
$USR ** User Defined Plans **
L
Y
Y
Y
5T
KAISER - CERTIFICATED BASIC
KS CT BA
BN F
PLANS:
KS1
KAISER -CERTIFICATED
DDCT DELTA DENTAL - CERTIFICATED
$USR ** User Defined Plans **
L
Y
Y
Y
6L
BLUE CROSS - CLASSIFIED BASIC BC CL BA E
PP L
PLANS:
BCCL BLUE CROSS - CLASSIFIED
DDCL DELTA DENTAL - CLASSIFIED
O
Y
Y
Y
6T
BLUE CROSS CERTIFICATED BASIC BC CT BA
PP F
PLANS:
BCCT BLUE CROSS - CERTIFICATED
DDCT DELTA DENTAL - CERTIFICATED
L
Y
Y
Y
CB
COBRA
PLANS:
N
Y
Y
Y
KS2
JHL
$USR
COBRA
E
** User Defined Plans **
KC
KAISER CAPPED OPEN ENDED
KAISOPEN
AP L
PLANS:
KS2
KAISER - CLASSIFIED
DDCL DELTA DENTAL - CLASSIFIED
$USR ** User Defined Plans **
L
Y
Y
RT
RETIREMENT HEALTH COVERAGE
RTRMHEAL E
AP L
PLANS:
KSRT KAISER - RETIREE
$USR ** User Defined Plans **
L
Y
Y
UD
USER-DEFINED
PLANS:
USER-DEF
PP L
** User Defined Plans **
L
Y
N
N
WAIVED HEALTH CARE - CLASS
WAIVEDCL E
AP L
PLANS:
DDCL DELTA DENTAL - CLASSIFIED
JHL
JOHN HANCOCK MUTUAL LIFE
AFDS AMERICAN FIDELITY-DISABILITY
TSA
EMPLOYER PURCHASED TSA
L
N
N
N
WL
4-236
$USR
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Benefits Management Master Files
Plan Codes (BMPC) Master File
Plan Codes (BMPC) Master File
Figure 4-151: Add dialog box for the Plan Codes (BMPC) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Plan Codes (BMPC) master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no preload available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-140: Plan Codes (BMPC) master file
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Code
Display
Selection from List
Plan Code
Key
Text (4 characters)
Plan Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbr
Required
Text (8 characters)
Plan Type
Optional
Selection from List
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-237
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-140: Plan Codes (BMPC) master file - continued
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Default Coverage Level
Optional
Selection from List (Coverage Level
[BMCL] master file)
Vendor Number
Optional
Numeric Code (6 digits)
Vol Ded Number
Optional
Numeric Code (4 digits)
Name
Optional
Text (30 characters)
Address Line 1
Optional
Text (30 characters)
Address Line 2
Optional
Text (30 characters)
Address Line 3
Optional
Text (30 characters)
City
Optional
Text (18 characters)
State
Optional
Text (2 characters)
Zip
Optional
Numerals (5 digits + 4 digits)
Start Date
Required
Date
End Date
Optional
Date
Section 125
Required
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Billing Basis
Optional
Numerals (2 digits)
Min Benefit
Required
Numerals (7 digits)
Max Benefit
Required
Numerals (7 digits)
Increment
Required
Numerals (7 digits)
Max X Salary
Required
Numerals (2 digits)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
4-238
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Benefits Management Master Files
Plan Codes (BMPC) Master File
65 QSS UNIFIED SCHOOL DISTRICT
ALL PLAN CODES
PLAN CODES
SORT BY CODE
J700
BM0100
H.00.11 06/13/06 PAGE
1
DFT START
END
SECT B PLAN
MINIMUM
MAXIMUM MAXIMUM
CODE
NAME
ABBR
LVL DATE
DATE
125 B TYPE
BENEFIT
BENEFIT MAX X SAL INCREMENT
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------AFDS
AMERICAN FIDELITY-DISABILITY
AM DISAB E
01/01/2000
VOLDED: 0050
AMERICAN FIDELITY-DISABILITY
P.O. BOX 268805
OKLAHOMA CITY
OK 73126--880
VENDOR: 020043 AMERICAN FIDELITY - DISABILITY
Y 12
BCCL
BLUE CROSS - CLASSIFIED
BC CLASS
07/01/1997
VOLDED: 1103
BLUE CROSS
P. O. BOX 629
WOODLAND HILLS
CA 91365
VENDOR: 020044 BLUE CROSS
Y 12
BCCT
BLUE CROSS - CERTIFICATED
BC CERT
07/01/1997
VOLDED: 1103
BLUE CROSS
P. O. BOX 629
WOODLAND HILLS
CA 91365
VENDOR: 020044 BLUE CROSS
Y 12
BLIF
BASIC LIFE INSURANCE
BAS LIFE ANY 01/01/2005
VOLDED: 0035
GENERAL LIFE INSURANCE
P. O. BOX 28445
SAN DIEGO
CA 93123
Y 00
CAP
CAP AMOUNT APPLIED TO TOTAL
VENDOR:
01/01/2001
N 00
KS2C
KAISER CLASSIFIED CAPPED
KSRCLCAP
07/01/1994
VOLDED: 0002
KAISER FOUNDATION HEALTH PLAN
FILE #73029/P.O.BOX 60000
SAN FRANCISCO
CA 94160--302
VENDOR: 020051 KAISER FOUNDATION HEALTH PLAN
Y 12
KSRT
KAISER - RETIREE
KSRRETRE E
07/01/2000
VOLDED: 0002
KAISER FOUNDATION HEALTH PLAN
FILE #73029/P.O.BOX 60000
SAN FRANCISCO
CA 94160--302
VENDOR: 020051 KAISER FOUNDATION HEALTH PLAN
Y 12
OTLC
Opt Term Life-Child Policy
OTL Ch
CHLD 01/01/2005
VOLDED: 0035
GENERAL LIFE INSURANCE
P. O. BOX 28445
SAN DIEGO
CA 93123
VENDOR: 020048 GENERAL LIFE INSURANCE
OTLE
OTLS
01/10
LB
12,000
100,000
1,000
Y 12
LC
2,000
10,000
1,000
Opt Term Life-Employee Policy OTL Emp
01/01/2005
VOLDED: 0035
GENERAL LIFE INSURANCE
P. O. BOX 28445
SAN DIEGO
CA 93123
VENDOR: 020048 GENERAL LIFE INSURANCE
Y 12
LE
20,000
250,000
Opt Term Life-Spouse Policy
OTL Sp
01/01/2005
VOLDED: 0035
GENERAL LIFE INSURANCE
P. O. BOX 28445
SAN DIEGO
CA 93123
VENDOR: 020048 GENERAL LIFE INSURANCE
Y 12
LS
5,000
100,000
TOTALCAP
Copyright © QSS, 2010
5
10,000
5,000
4-239
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Plan/Level Amounts (BMPL) Master File
Figure 4-152: Add dialog box for the Plan/Level Amounts (BMPL) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Plan/Level Amounts (BMPL) master file.
The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no preload available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-141: Plan/Level Amounts (BMPL) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Plan
Key
Text (4 characters)
Level
Key
Text (2 characters)
Start Date
Required or
Optional
Date
End Date
Optional
Date
Employee Amount
Optional
Numerals (9 digits)
as
Optional
Selection from List
Employer Amount
Optional
Numerals (9 digits)
4-240
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Benefits Management Master Files
Plan/Level Amounts (BMPL) Master File
Table 4-141: Plan/Level Amounts (BMPL) master file - continued
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
as
Optional
Selection from List
FTE Allocation
Optional
Text (4 characters)
Billing Basis
Required
Numerals (2 digits)
Age
Optional
Numerals (2 digits)
Min Ben
Optional
Numerals (9 digits)
Max Ben
Optional
Numerals (9 digits)
Incr
Optional
Numerals (9 digits)
Max X Sal
Optional
Numerals (2 digits)
Ded Code
Optional
Numeric Code (4 digits)
Type
Optional
Selection from List
Limit
Optional
Numerals (9 digits)
Balance
Optional
Numerals (9 digits)
Subject
Optional
Selection from List
Ignore E
Optional
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
R
Optional
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Invoice Cycle
Required
Selection from List
Amount
Display
Numerals (9 digits)
Override
Optional
Numerals (9 digits)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
65 QSS UNIFIED SCHOOL DISTRICT
USING EMPLOYEE-TYPE FTE TABLE
J110
PLAN/LEVEL AMOUNTS
BM0100
H.00.05
06/13/01 PAGE
1
SORT BY CODE
START
END
EMPLOYEE EMPLOYER --VOLUNTARY DEDUCTION INFO-PLAN LVL DATE
DATE
AMOUNT
AMOUNT
NUM T LIM AMT BAL AMT SB BB
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------
01/10
KAIS E
07/01/2000 06/30/2001 $ 200.00
$ 200.00
0002
12
KAIS E1
07/01/2000 06/30/2001 $ 300.00
$ 300.00
0002
12
KAIS E2
07/01/2000 06/30/2001
10.00%
10.00% 0002 P 1500.00
Copyright © QSS, 2010
12
4-241
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Cap Amounts (BMCA) Master File
Figure 4-153: Change dialog box for the Cap Amounts (BMCA) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Cap Amounts (BMCA) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27.
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-142: Cap Amounts (BMCA) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Codes
Display
Selection from List
District
Key
Numeric Code (2 characters)
Barg Unit
Required
Selection from List
Start Date
Required
Date
End Date
Optional
Date
Cap Amount
Required
Dollar Amount
Pro-rate by FTE
Required
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Cash out
Required
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Basis
Optional
Numerals (2 digits)
4-242
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Benefits Management Master Files
Benefit Status Codes (BMBS) Master File
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
Master File:
Sort by:
65 QSS UNIFIED SCHOOL DISTRICT
CA - CAP AMOUNTS
1 - CODE
CAP AMOUNTS
J41
BM0100
H.00.10 02/03/06 PAGE
1
SORT BY CODE
START
END
CAP
DI BARG UNIT
DATE
DATE
AMOUNT P BA
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------65 40 CERTIFICATED EMPLOYEES ASSOC.
01/01/2005
6,000.00 Y 01
Benefit Status Codes (BMBS) Master File
Figure 4-154: Add dialog box for the Benefit Status Codes (BMBS) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Benefit Status Codes (BMBS) master file.
The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
01/10
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-243
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-143: Benefit Status Codes (BMBS) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Selected Codes
Display
Selection from List
Code
Key
Text (2 characters upshifted)
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
Master File:
BS - BENEFIT STATUS CODES
Sort by:
65 QSS UNIFIED SCHOOL DISTRICT
DOCUMENTATION SAMPLE
1 - CODE
BENEFIT STATUS CODES
SORT BY CODE
J38
BM0100
H.00.10 02/02/06 PAGE
1
CODE
NAME
ABBR
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------AD
BM
CE
CL
CM
HO
SE
SL
ADMINSTRATOR
BOARD MEMBER
CERTIFICATED TEACHING STAFF
CLASSIFIED STAFF
CLASSIFIED MANAGEMENT
HOURLY WORKER
CERTIFICATED SUBSTITUTE
CLASSIFIED SUBSTITUTE
ADMIN
BOARD
CERTTCHR
CLASS
CLSSMGMT
HOURLY
CERTSUB
CLASSSUB
Package Assignment (BMPA) Master File
Figure 4-155: Add dialog box for the Package Assignment (BMPA) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Package Assignment (BMPA) master file.
The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
4-244
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Benefits Management Master Files
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
Package Assignment (BMPA) Master File
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27.
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-144: Package Assignment (BMPA) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Deduction Code
Display
Selection from List
Salary Schedule
Required
Selection from List
Package Code
Required
Selection from List
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
Master File:
Sort by:
65 QSS UNIFIED SCHOOL DISTRICT
SAMPLE FOR DOCUMENTATION
PA - PACKAGE ASSIGNMENT
1 - CODE
PACKAGE ASSIGNMENT
SORT BY CODE
J47
BM0100
H.00.10 02/03/06 PAGE
1
SALARY SCHEDULE
PACKAGE
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------01 TEACHERS
5T KAISER - CERTIFICATED BASIC
12 CERTIFICATED MANAGEMENT
7T KAISER - CERTIFICATED PLUS
14 CLASSIFIED MANAGEMENT
7L KAISER - CLASSIFIED PLUS
50 CLASSIFIED
5L KAISER - CLASSIFIED BASIC
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-245
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Retirement - CA Master Files
The Retirement - CA folder contains the master files required for implementing California Retirement. This heading lists the master files and subfolders in the same
order that they display in the tree view.
Table 4-145: Master files in the Retirement - CA folder
MASTER FILE
CODE
District Master File
SUBFOLDER
LEVEL
PAGE
RTDI
District
4-247
Accumulator Limits
RTAL
District
4-249
STRS Rates
RTST
District
4-250
PERS Rates
RTPE
District
4-251
Pay Schedule Controls
RTPS
District
4-253
District Master File by Group
RTDB
Retirement Group Files
District
4-255
PERS Rates by Group
TRPG
Retirement Group Files
District
4-257
For additional lists of master files documented in the chapter, see:
♦ "Table 4-1: Master files by folder on tree view" on page 4-4
♦ "Table 4-2: Master files by name" on page 4-7
♦ "Table 4-3: Master files by code" on page 4-10
4-246
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Retirement - CA Master Files
District Master File (RTDI) Master File
District Master File (RTDI) Master File
Figure 4-156: Add dialog box for the District Master File (RTDI) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the District Master File (RTDI) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-146: District Master File (RTDI) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Codes
Display
Selection from List
District
Display
Current district for QCC session
Unit Code
Required
Numerals (3 digits)
Report Overtime for Members
Optional
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Pickup/Buyout Option
Optional
Selection from List
Buyout Rate
Optional
Numerals (0.0000 to 9.9999 percent)
STRS District Specific Values
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-247
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-146: District Master File (RTDI) master file - continued
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Unit Code
Required
Numerals (3 digits)
Office Code
Required
Numerals (5 digits)
Strip Control Records from Tape
Optional
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Default Coverage Codes
Optional
Numerals (5 digits)
Monthly
Optional
Numerals (4 digits)
Daily
Optional
Numerals (4 digits)
Hourly
Optional
Numerals (4 digits)
Pickup/Buyout Option
Optional
Selection from List
Buyout Rate
Optional
Numerals (0.0000 to 9.9999 percent)
Control payroll Data Entry for RS
Optional
Numerals (2 digits)
PERS District Specific Values
Default Work Schedules
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
4-248
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Retirement - CA Master Files
Accumulator Limits (RTAL) Master File
Accumulator Limits (RTAL) Master File
Figure 4-157: Add dialog box for the Accumulator Limits (RTAL) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Accumulator Limits (RTAL) master file. The
instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-147: Accumulator Limits (RTAL) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Codes
Display
Selection from List
Ret System
Key
Numerals (2 digits)
Ret Account Code
Key
Numerals (2 digits)
Class
Key
Selection from List
Limit Amount
Required
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 9999.99))
Unit Type
Required
Selection from List
Period Type
Optional
Selection from List
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-249
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available from QCC. For reports, see
Chapter 5 of the QSS/OASIS Retirement Manual.
STRS Rates (RTST) Master File
Figure 4-158: Add dialog box for the STRS Rates (RTST) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the STRS Rates (RTST) master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-148: STRS Rates (RTST) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Codes
Display
Selection from List
Rate ID
Key
Numeric Code (4 digits)
Rate Type
Key
Selection from List
Begin Date
Optional
Date
End Date
Optional
Date
Employee Rate
Required
Numerals (0.0000 to 9.9999 percent)
4-250
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Retirement - CA Master Files
PERS Rates (RTPE) Master File
Table 4-148: STRS Rates (RTST) master file - continued
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Normal Employer Rate
Required
Numerals (0.0000 to 9.9999 percent)
Reduced Workload Employer Rate
Required
Numerals (0.0000 to 99.9999 percent)
Maximum Pay Rate
Optional
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 999999.99)
Type
Optional
Selection from List
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available from QCC. For reports, see
Chapter 5 of the QSS/OASIS Retirement Manual.
PERS Rates (RTPE) Master File
Figure 4-159: Add dialog box for the PERS Rates (RTPE) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the PERS Rates (RTPE) master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-251
Human Resources Master Files Manual
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-149: PERS Rates (RTPE) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Codes
Display
Selection from List
Rate ID
Key
Numeric Code (4 digits)
Rate Type
Key
Selection from List
Begin Date
Optional
Date
End Date
Optional
Date
Employee Rate
Required
Numerals (0.0000 to 99.9999 percent)
FICA Deduction Amount
Required
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 999999.99)
Max Earning Amt
Required
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 999999.99)
Factor
Required
Numerals (0.0000 to 99.9999 percent)
Employer Rate
Required
Numerals (0.0000 to 99.9999 percent)
Revenue Limit Rate
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 999.99 percent)
Revenue Limit Reduction Rate
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 999.99 percent)
Maximum Pay Rate
Optional
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 999999.99)
Type
Optional
Selection from List
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available from QCC. For reports, see
Chapter 5 of the QSS/OASIS Retirement Manual.
4-252
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Retirement - CA Master Files
Pay Schedule Controls (RTPS) Master File
Pay Schedule Controls (RTPS) Master File
Figure 4-160: Add dialog box for the Pay Schedule Controls (RTPS) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the Pay Schedule Controls (RTPS) master file.
The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
01/10
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-253
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-150: Pay Schedule Controls (RTPS) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Pay Schedule Codes
Display
Selection from List
Fiscal Year
Key
Fiscal Year
Pay Schedule Code
Key
Text (6 characters)
Pay Schedule Name
Display
From selected pay schedule
Cycle
Display
From selected pay schedule
Class
Display
From selected pay schedule
Name
Required
Text (30 characters)
Abbreviation
Required
Text (8 characters)
Pr
Display
Payroll number from pay schedule
Def
Required
Selection from List
Start
Display
From selected pay schedule
End
Display
From selected pay schedule
Paid
Display
From selected pay schedule
Days
Required
Fixed Decimal Point (4 digits nn.nn)
Hours
Required
Fixed Decimal Point (5 digits nnn.nn)
Weeks
Optional
Fixed Decimal Point (3 digits n.nn)
Local Use
Not used
Leave blank
Page 1 through Page 5
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available from QCC. For reports, see
Chapter 5 of the QSS/OASIS Retirement Manual.
Retirement Group Subfolder
This subfolder includes the following master files:
♦ District Master File by Group (RTDG) Master File
♦ PERS Rates by Group (RTGP) Master File
4-254
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Retirement - CA Master Files
Retirement Group Subfolder
District Master File by Group (RTDG) Master File
Figure 4-161: Add dialog box for the District Master File by Group (RTDG) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the District Master File by Group (RTDG) master file. The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-151: District Master File by Group (RTDG) master file
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Codes
Display
Selection from List
Group
Key
Text (2 characters)
District
Display
Current district for QCC session
Unit Code
Required
Numerals (3 digits)
Report Overtime for Members
Optional
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Pickup/Buyout Option
Optional
Selection from List
STRS District Specific Values
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-255
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-151: District Master File by Group (RTDG) master file - continued
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Buyout Rate
Optional
Numerals (0.0000 to 9.9999 percent)
Unit Code
Required
Numerals (3 digits)
Office Code
Required
Numerals (5 digits)
Strip Control Records from Tape
Optional
Selected (Yes) or Cleared (No)
Default Coverage Codes
Optional
Numerals (5 digits)
Monthly
Optional
Numerals (4 digits)
Daily
Optional
Numerals (4 digits)
Hourly
Optional
Numerals (4 digits)
Pickup/Buyout Option
Optional
Selection from List
Buyout Rate
Optional
Numerals (0.0000 to 9.9999 percent)
Control payroll Data Entry for RS
Optional
Numerals (2 digits)
PERS District Specific Values
Default Work Schedules
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available from QCC. For reports, see
Chapter 5 of the QSS/OASIS Retirement Manual.
4-256
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Retirement - CA Master Files
Retirement Group Subfolder
PERS Rates by Group (RTGP) Master File
Figure 4-162: Add dialog box for the PERS Rates by Group (RTGP) master file
This heading describes the boxes for the PERS Rates by Group (RTGP) master file.
The instructions for maintaining records are in Chapter 2.
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
For inspecting, see page 2-23.
For changing or deleting, see page 2-25.
For adding, see page 2-27 (no pre-fill available).
For creating master file reports, see page 2-29.
For an explanation of the columns of the following table, see page 4-13.
Table 4-152: PERS Rates by Group (RTGP) master file
01/10
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
Codes
Display
Selection from List
Group
Key
Numeric Code (2 digits)
Rate ID
Key
Numeric Code (4 digits)
Rate Type
Key
Selection from List
Begin Date
Optional
Date
Copyright © QSS, 2010
4-257
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter 4: Defining Master Files
Table 4-152: PERS Rates by Group (RTGP) master file - continued
Box Label
R/O/D
Contents
End Date
Optional
Date
Employee Rate
Required
Numerals (0.0000 to 99.9999 percent)
FICA Deduction Amount
Required
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 999999.99)
Max Earning Amt
Required
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 999999.99)
Factor
Required
Numerals (0.0000 to 99.9999 percent)
Employer Rate
Required
Numerals (0.0000 to 99.9999 percent)
Revenue Limit Rate
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 999.99 percent)
Revenue Limit Reduction Rate
Required
Numerals (0.00 to 999.99 percent)
Maximum Pay Rate
Optional
Dollar Amount (0.00 to 999999.99)
Type
Optional
Selection from List
HINT: If you are using Adobe Acrobat or Reader to view this document, click the blue text for more
information. To return here, click the Previous View button
or press ALT+LEFT ARROW.
As of August 2009, the master file report is not available from QCC. For reports, see
Chapter 5 of the QSS/OASIS Retirement Manual.
4-258
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Appendix A:
Common Elements in
QCC Windows
Appendix Contents
The Grid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-2
Navigating through the Grid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-2
Sorting the Grid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-4
Filling In Boxes in Tabs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Moving from Tab to Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Moving from One Box to Another. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Selecting Options from Lists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Typing in a Text Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Checking Boxes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Selecting Option Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Typing or Selecting Dates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
A-5
A-5
A-5
A-6
A-7
A-8
A-8
A-9
Help Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-11
About Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-11
User Security Command. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-17
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
A-1
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter A: Common Elements in QCC Windows
The Grid
The instructions for the grid focus on the following areas:
♦ Navigating through the Grid
♦ Sorting the Grid
Navigating through the Grid
Many tabs and subtabs include a grid for displaying data. The grid is arranged like a
spreadsheet. The column headings are on the top of the grid. Each row on the grid is
divided into cells. When a grid is too large to display in the window, it displays vertical and horizontal scroll bars.
Column headings
The vertical
scroll bar
displays when
there are too
many rows to fit
in the window.
Current record
pointer
The horizontal scroll bar displays when the grid is to wide to fit in the windows.
Figure A-1: Grid for QCC applications
A grid includes the following parts:
♦ The column headings display along the top of the grid. They identify the information in each column.
♦ The rows display the data in the grid, much like the rows in a spreadsheet. The columns break up each row into a series of cells. Most grids have row numbers to the
left of the first column, but some do not.
♦ The current record pointer indicates the row that is selected. You can move this
pointer in either of the following ways:
◊ Clicking in a row.
◊ Pressing any of the following keys: UP ARROW, DOWN ARROW, PAGE UP,
PAGE DOWN, CTRL+HOME, and CTRL+END.
♦ The scroll bars display when the grid is too large to fit in the window.
◊ On horizontal scroll bars, you can do the following:
> Click a scroll arrow to move the grid one column to the left or the right.
A-2
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
The Grid
Navigating through the Grid
> Click between the scroll box and a scroll arrow to move the grid one visible
window width to the left or the right.
> Drag the scroll box to move the columns to the left or
right.
Scroll arrow
Scroll box
◊ On vertical scroll bars, you can do the following:
Scroll arrow
Scroll arrow
> Click a scroll arrow to move the grid up or down one
row.
Scroll box
> Click between the scroll box and a scroll arrow to display the previous or next page of rows that fit in the
window.
Scroll arrow
> Drag the scroll box to move the rows up and down.
Table A-47 on page A-5 lists the keyboard shortcuts for navigating through the
grid.
◊ You can resize and move QCC windows to make more of the grid visible and
possible.
> Click the maximize
button on the upper right corner of the window to
make it fill the entire Windows desktop.
> Resize the window to a custom size. Move the mouse pointer over the sizing
corner on the lower left corner of the window until it becomes a doubleheaded arrow like this:
Then hold down the left mouse button and drag the mouse to change the
height and width of the window. When the window is the size that you want,
release the left mouse button.
> To move a window left-click in the title bar, hold down the left mouse button, and drag the window around the desktop.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
A-3
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter A: Common Elements in QCC Windows
Table A-1: Keyboard shortcuts for moving through the grid
TO MOVE THE CURSOR
PRESS THESE KEYS
Down one page
PAGE DOWN
Down one row
DOWN ARROW
First column in a row
HOME
First row
CTRL+HOME
Last column in a row
END
Last row
CTRL+END
Left one column
LEFT ARROW
Right one column
RIGHT ARROW
Up one page
PAGE UP
Up one row
UP ARROW
Sorting the Grid
You can sort the grid on any column.
♦ To sort a column in ascending order, double-click a column heading.
♦ To sort a column in descending order, double-click the same column heading a second time.
A-4
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Filling In Boxes in Tabs
Moving from Tab to Tab
Filling In Boxes in Tabs
This heading provides general instructions for filling in the tabs on the report
window:
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
Moving from Tab to Tab
Moving from One Box to Another
Selecting Options from Lists
Typing in a Text Box
Checking Boxes
Selecting Option Buttons
Typing or Selecting Dates
Many of these topics are basic techniques for using the Windows desktop that are
familiar to experienced Windows users. However, even experienced Windows users
should review the instructions for typing dates.
Moving from Tab to Tab
The active tab has a green dot to the left of its label. The window displays the active
tab.
To make a tab active, do either of the following:
♦ Click the tab label.
♦ Press ALT and the underlined letter in the tab label, such as ALT+R for the Reference Types tab.
Moving from One Box to Another
Each tab contains one or more boxes for selecting or typing information, check boxes,
or option buttons. The active box is the one that you are currently filling in. Its label
changes color and is surrounded by a dotted box.
The background color for a box indicates whether it is available or unavailable:
♦ Boxes with white backgrounds are available, which means that you can type text,
select an option from a list, or check the box.
♦ Boxes with any other color background are unavailable. A common color is yellow, but your site can select gray, blue, orange, or any other color for unavailable
boxes.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
A-5
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter A: Common Elements in QCC Windows
Boxes are unavailable because your logon ID does not allow access or because they
are not relevant to the options you have chosen elsewhere in a window. For example,
the District box has a colored background if your QCC logon ID does not allow
selecting the district for which to create a report.
Unavailable box with
colored background (yellow
in this example).
Available boxes with white
backgrounds
Active box with colored
label surrounded by a
dotted box
Figure A-2: Unavailable, available, and active boxes
To activate another box and highlight its contents, do any of the following:
♦ Press TAB to move to the next available box (one with a white background).
♦ Press ALT+TAB to move to the previous available box.
♦ Click the label for an available box.
NOTE: The TAB and SHIFT+TAB keys skip over unavailable boxes, and you cannot select
an unavailable box with the mouse.
Selecting Options from Lists
Drop-down list boxes force you to select from a list of options, such as reporting
approved transactions only, unapproved only, or both. After you click the drop-down
arrow, a list displays the options from which you can choose. The box displays the
option that you have chosen. In most lists, you cannot type text to define your own
options.
Drop-down arrow
Figure A-3: Drop-down list box
To make a selection from a drop-down list box:
1 Click the drop-down arrow or anywhere in the box. The list drops down to display
the options from which you can choose.
Figure A-4: Drop-down list box with options expanded after clicking the drop-down arrow
A-6
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Filling In Boxes in Tabs
Typing in a Text Box
2 Select an option in any of the following ways:
◊ Click the option.
◊ Type the first letter of an option, then moving to another box by clicking
another box or pressing the TAB key.
◊ Press the UP ARROW or DOWN ARROW key to highlight an option, then
click another box or press any of the following keys: ENTER, TAB, or
SHIFT+TAB.
◊ Click the label for a box, then press the UP ARROW or DOWN ARROW key
to highlight another option. When the option you want is highlighted, click
another box or press the TAB key.
Typing in a Text Box
Text boxes allow you to type information, such as the description for a report or
range of object values to select for reporting.
To edit the contents of a text box, do any of the following:
♦ Position the cursor by clicking in a text box or by pressing the LEFT ARROW or
RIGHT ARROW keys. You can:
◊ Insert new text to the right of the cursor by typing.
◊ Press the DELETE key to delete text to the right of the cursor.
◊ Press the BACKSPACE key to delete text to the left of the cursor.
♦ Delete and add text in a single operation.
◊ Select text to delete by holding down the SHIFT key, then pressing the LEFT
ARROW or RIGHT ARROW key to select text.
◊ Begin typing. The highlighted text is deleted and replaced with the new text that
you type.
♦ Replace the text with one mouse click.
◊ Click the label for a box. All of the text is highlighted.
◊ Type new text. The old text is deleted and replaced with what you type.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
A-7
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter A: Common Elements in QCC Windows
♦ Replace everything to the left of the cursor.
◊ Click and hold the left mouse button anywhere in a text box. The text to the left
of the cursor is highlighted.
◊ Release the mouse button.
◊ Delete the text by pressing the DELETE key, or replace the text by typing new
text.
Checking Boxes
The financial reports use check boxes for situations where there are only two options:
yes (checked) and no (not checked). Check boxes are square boxes that are toggle
switches. Whenever you select a check box, it changes from yes to no or from no to
yes.
Figure A-5: Check boxes for yes (checked) or no (unchecked) options
To check or uncheck a box, do either of the following:
♦ Click inside the box. It changes from checked to unchecked, or unchecked to
checked.
♦ Click the label for the check box, then press the SPACEBAR to check or uncheck
the box.
Selecting Option Buttons
Option buttons (also called radio buttons) are for situations where there are several
options from which you can select only one. Option buttons are groups of rounded
buttons. You can select only one button in each group, just as you can select only one
preset radio station at a time on a car radio. For example, the Request Report of
Interim Values (J251S1) window has option buttons for selecting whether to create a
report for interim period 1, 2, or 3.
Figure A-6: Option buttons for selecting Interim Period 1, 2, or 3
To select an option, do either of the following:
♦ Click the option button that you want to select. All other options in the group are
unselected.
♦ When an option button is the active field, press the arrow keys to move to the previous or next option button and check it.
A-8
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Filling In Boxes in Tabs
Typing or Selecting Dates
Typing or Selecting Dates
Date boxes allow you to type a date or select a date from a calendar. Almost every
Main Selection tab has date boxes for selecting a range of dates for the report.
Figure A-7: Date box
These instructions tell how to type a date, change a date, select a date from the calendar, and select today from the calendar.
To type a date:
1 Make the date box the active box and highlight the date in either of the following
ways:
◊ Press the TAB or ALT+TAB key.
◊ Click the label for the date field.
2 Type the date as an 8-digit number.
Make sure that the entire date field is highlighted. If it is not, use the mouse to
highlight all 8 digits of the date.
The month and day are always 2 digits, and the year is 4 digits. For example, type
February 4, 2008 like this: 02042008.
As you type the date, the box automatically inserts the / characters that separate the
month, day, and year. You cannot type the / (or any other separator between parts
of the date).
To change part of a date:
1 Select the part of the date that you want to change, such as the day or the month,
with the mouse pointer.
2 Type the changes you want to make.
To select a date from the calendar:
1 To display the calendar, click the drop-down arrow for a date box.
2 On the top of the calendar, click the left arrow to display the previous month or the
right arrow to display the next month.
3 To select a date, double-click the date. The calendar closes, and the date field contains the selected date.
4 To close the calendar without selecting a date, press the ESC key.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
A-9
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter A: Common Elements in QCC Windows
To select the current date from the calendar:
1 Click the drop-down arrow for a date box.
2 Click Today: dd/mm/yy on the bottom of the calendar.
The calendar displays the current month with today’s date circled in red.
3 Double-click the circled date on the calendar.
The calendar closes, and today’s date displays in the date field.
A-10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Help Menu
About Command
Help Menu
These instructions describe the following commands from the Help menu:
♦ About Command
♦ User Security Command
About Command
The tabs display
information about the
QCC module that you
are using and about
your QCC session.
Click a label on the
tab bar to select the
kind of information to
display.
Figure A-8: : About dialog box for the About command on the Help menu
The About command opens an About dialog box that displays information about the
QCC module that you are using and the current QCC session. The instructions for the
About dialog box focus on the following areas:
♦ Commands for the About Dialog Box
♦ Tabs on the About Dialog Box
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
A-11
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter A: Common Elements in QCC Windows
Commands for the About Dialog Box
Open the System Information dialog box for Windows.
This dialog box is a Windows utility that allows you to display
information about your PC. For more information, see
Microsoft’s on-line help file that is available from the Help
menu.
Close the About dialog box and resume using the window in QCC.
You must close this dialog box before you can resume using the
window.
Click this button twice to rebuild the user security for the current
QCC session.
This button is active only when you select the USERSEC tab.
Click this button only when instructed to do so.
Print a graphic image of the window on the default Windows
printer for your PC.
Save a graphic image of the dialog box to a .jpg file.
The Save screen as picture dialog box identifies the name of the
file.
Copy version information to the Windows clipboard as plain text:
♦ The Program Info tab
♦ The information on the Package Info tab that displays when
you check the Package Description button
♦ The USERSEC tab
You can paste this information into the body of an email message, a Word document, Notepad, or any other text editor.
HINT: To make it easier to identify the parameters in each
column of the USERSEC tab, use a monospaced font to
display the user security.
A-12
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Help Menu
About Command
Copy user security or file versions to the Grid Output window.
♦ To copy a list of programs in the current package, click the
Package Info tab, then click this button.
♦ To copy the user security for the current QCC session, click
any other tab, then click this button.
Tabs on the About Dialog Box
Figure A-102 illustrates the tab bar for the About dialog box. Click a tab label to display information about the current QCC module and your QCC session.
Figure A-9: Tab bar for the About dialog box
Program Info Tab
The Program Info tab displays the name of QCC module for the current window,
information about your QCC session, and information about the server session. This
topic gives a brief description of the information displayed. Some of it is technical
information of interest only to the support staff at your IT department.
Figure A-10: Program Info tab for the About dialog box
[module name] The name of the QCC module that corresponds to the current window, version number, compile date, and compile time.
In most cases, a module corresponds to a QCC window. For
example, the QSSGLApplication1 module is the GL Application
window.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
A-13
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Server
Chapter A: Common Elements in QCC Windows
The server program, version, compile date, and compile time.
The server program runs on the host HP e3000 computer. The
server program facilitates the exchange of data between the General Ledger database on the HP e3000 and the QCC program on
the PC.
Connection ID The connection ID assigned to your QCC session.
Client User
The QCC user name that you used for logging on to QCC.
District
Site
Year
The district, site, and year number associated with the Server User
listed below.
Server
The DNS name or IP address that QCC uses for connecting to the
HP e3000 server at your site.
Port
The port number for the current module for connecting with the HP
e3000.
Server User
The MPE logon ID linked to the Client User.
In this example, MARC is the user name, and QSSUSER is the
account. This user would type the following command to log on
to the traditional software: HELLO MARC.QSSUSER.
The Client User in QCC inherits all of the user security that is
set up for the Server User with Maintain User Data (MEN020).
Date
The date and time when you opened the dialog box.
Package Info Tab
The Package Info tab displays a variety of information about the package (or version)
of QCC that is installed on your PC. The support staff at your site may ask you for
this information.
♦ Click Package Description to display the QSS-defined description of the
package. The most important information is on the top of the tab.
◊ The Install Type is either Development (for the production version) or Beta
(for a test version that is deployed to a small group of testers)
A-14
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Help Menu
About Command
Figure A-11: Package information for QCC on the Package Info tab
◊ The Build Date/Time tells when the package was created.
◊ The top of the Version Date box displays the version number for the package.
You may be asked to look up other information from this tab.
♦ Click Site Description to display the custom description that your site has defined.
Sites that are using Package Manager can create their own descriptions.
♦ Click Users to see a list of QCC user names who can run this package. For a production release, it is "#ALL USERS#".
♦ Click Patch History to display a list of any patches that were applied to a package
after it was first released.
♦ Click File Versions to display a grid that lists all of the individual files in the package. You can sort the grid on any column. Double-click a column heading to sort in
ascending order. Double-click it again to sort in descending order. You can select
the [Grid Output] button to open a Grid Output window that allows you to export
the list of programs to Excel, Word, a PDF file, or a text file. For instructions, see
Appendix D.
USERSEC Tab
The USERSEC tab displays the USERSEC (user security) for the Server User listed
on the Program Info tab. The Client User on the Program Info tab (QCC user name)
inherits the user security for the Server User that is linked to the QCC user name.
Maintain User Data (MEN020) allows you to maintain the user security for each
Server User.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
A-15
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter A: Common Elements in QCC Windows
Figure A-105 illustrates the USERSEC tab that displays the user security that your
system administrator has set up for your QCC logon ID. You can sort the grid on any
column. Double-click a column heading to sort in ascending order. Double-click it
again to sort in descending order.
Figure A-12: USERSEC tab for the About dialog box
Program
The program name for the user security.
The Program name identifies the tab or subtab to which the user
security applies. For example, JOURNL is the Program name
for the Journal Entry (FI02JE) subtab. Many other tabs and subtabs have one or more Program names that your system administrator can set up.
[parameters]
A series of letters and numbers up to 60 characters long.
The parameters for each user security record allow your system
administrator to customize how the program works. For example, the parameters for JOURNL allow your system administrator to give you either single- or multi-district access, specify
whether journal entries are approved when you enter them, and
grant or deny access to the commands for adding, changing,
inspecting, and deleting journal entries.
The parameters are different for each Program name. Your system administrator uses the set-up instructions in Module, Task,
and User Security for QCC to identify the Program names for
each tab or subtab and to interpret the meaning of each column
of the parameters.
A-16
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Help Menu
User Security Command
Logging Tab
The Logging tab is primarily for testing during software development. Use this tab
only if you are explictly instructed to do so.
Diagnostics Tab
The Diagnostics tab is primarily for testing during software development. Use this tab
only if you are explicitly instructed to do so.
User Security Command
Figure A-13: User Security window for the Security command on the Help menu
These instructions focus on the following areas:
♦ Overview
♦ Commands
♦ Columns in the Grid
Overview
The User Security command allows you to open a User Security window that displays the user security (USERSEC) for the window. User security allows your system
administrator to maintain set-up options, such as whether you can use the commands
for adding, changing, or deleting transactions.
Commands
There are only three commands for the User Security window:
♦ Click the
(Cancel [F12]) icon to close the window.
♦ Click the
(Print Screen [F11]) icon print a copy of the window on the default
Windows printer for your PC.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
A-17
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Chapter A: Common Elements in QCC Windows
♦ Click the
(Grid Output [F8]) icon to open a Grid Output window that allows
you to save the contents of the grid as a Word, Excel, PDF, or plain text file. For
instructions, see Appendix E.
Columns in the Grid
Figure A-107 illustrates the grid that displays the user security records for a window.
You can sort the grid on any column. Double-click a column heading to sort in
ascending order. Double-click it again to sort in descending order.
Figure A-14: Columns in the grid for the User Security window
User Sec
The program name for the user security.
The User Sec name identifies the tab or subtab to which the user
security applies. For example, JOURNL is the User Sec name
for the Journal Entry (FI02JE) subtab. Many other tabs and subtabs have one or more User Sec names that your system administrator can set up.
Data
A series of letters and numbers up to 60 characters long.
The parameters for each user security record allow your system
administrator to customize how the program works. For example, the parameters for JOURNL allow your system administrator to give you either single- or multi-district access, specify
whether journal entries are approved when you enter them, and
grant or deny access to the commands for adding, changing,
inspecting, and deleting journal entries.
The parameters are different for each User Sec name. Your system administrator uses the set-up instructions in Module, Task,
and User Security for QCC to identify the User Sec names for
each tab or subtab and what parameters to fill in for the Data.
A-18
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Appendix B:
QSSInstaPrint Window
Appendix Contents
Overview of QSSInstaPrint Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-2
Menu Bar and Toolbar Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-3
File Menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-3
Options Menu and Toolbar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-3
Saving and Printing Instaprint Reports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-5
Saving a File. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-5
Opening in Excel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-6
Opening in Excel Wizard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-8
Opening in Word . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-13
Creating a PDF File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-14
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
B-1
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Appendix B: QSSInstaPrint Window
Overview of QSSInstaPrint Window
Title bar
Menu bar
Toolbar and line counter
Instaprint report
Figure B-1: QSSInstaPrint window
Table B-1: Parts of the QSSInstaPrint window
B-2
REGION
PURPOSE
PAGE
Title bar
The icon that displays in the Windows system tray and the name of
the module.
none
Menu bar
Toolbar
The menus and command icons allow you to do the following:
♦ Close the window.
♦ Create a PDF file.
♦ Save the instaprint report in a Word or Excel document.
♦ Import the instaprint report into Excel with the import wizard.
B-3
Line counter
The total number of lines in the report.
none
Instaprint report
The tax table you were that you were adding, changing, or inspecting
when you selected the InstaPrint command.
none
, 2010
Copyright © QSS
01/10
Menu Bar and Toolbar Commands
File Menu
Menu Bar and Toolbar Commands
The commands for the QSSInstaPrint window fall into the following categories:
♦ File Menu
♦ Options Menu and Toolbar
File Menu
The File menu has but one command. It allows you to exit the window when you are
through using it.
To exit the window, do any of the following:
♦ On the menu bar, click File and Exit.
♦ Press F12.
Options Menu and Toolbar
The Options menu and toolbar contain the commands for printing or saving the contents of the QSSInstaPrint window to one of the following file formats: text, PDF,
Word, and Excel.
The toolbar and Options menu
contain the same commands.
However, the commands are in a
different order in each place.
Figure B-2: Options menu and toolbar for the Grid Output window
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
B-3
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Appendix B: QSSInstaPrint Window
Table B-2: Menu bar and toolbar commands for the QSSInstaPrint window
OPTION MENU
COMMAND
B-4
COMMAND ICON
AND SHORTCUT
PURPOSE
PAGE
Save File
Ctrl+F4
Create a text file for the instaprint report.
Each line of the text file is 80 columns wide
and printed in a monospaced font.
B-5
Open in Excel
Ctrl+F5
Open a spreadsheet in Microsoft Excel that
contains the instaprint report. Each line of
text in the report becomes Column A of each
row.
B-6
Open in Excel Wizard
Ctrl+F6
Open a spreadsheet with the Excel Wizard.
The wizard is able to parse the instaprint
report into fixed-width columns.
B-8
Open in Word.
Ctrl+F7
Open a Microsoft Word document that contains the instaprint report.
B-13
Create PDF
Ctrl+F8
Create a PDF file that contains the instaprint
report.
B-14
Print
Ctrl+F11
Send the instaprint report directly to the
default Windows printer for your PC. The
report is in monospaced type and formatted
to print in portrait mode on 8-1/2 by 11 inch
paper.
none
, 2010
Copyright © QSS
01/10
Saving and Printing Instaprint Reports
Saving a File
Saving and Printing Instaprint Reports
These instructions focus on the following areas:
♦
♦
♦
♦
♦
Saving a File
Opening in Excel
Opening in Excel Wizard
Opening in Word
Creating a PDF File
Saving a File
The Save File command allows you to save the instaprint report as a plain ASCII text
file. Each line on the instaprint report becomes a record in the text file.
To save the instaprint report in a text file:
1 Click the
(Save File [Ctrl+F4]) icon to open a Save As dialog box.
Figure B-3: Save As dialog box for making a text file
2 In the Save in drop-down list, select the drive and folder where you want to save
the file.
◊ The default folder is the temporary folder that QCC creates for your QCC user
name.
QSS recommends that you select a different folder for saving your files so that
they are easier to find and manage. Getting to the folders for QCC requires
remembering a long and complex path to files.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
B-5
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Appendix B: QSSInstaPrint Window
◊ For the File name, type a file name with a .txt extension, such as
fileList17.txt.
The resulting file is a plain ASCII text file. Each row of the grid is a record that
ends with a hard return.
◊ Leave Save as type blank.
◊ To close the dialog box, do one of the following.
> Select [Save] to create the file.
> Select [Cancel] to exit without creating the file.
Opening in Excel
The Open in Excel command saves the instaprint report in an Excel spreadsheet. Each
line of the report becomes a row in the spreadsheet. The entire line of the report fills
Column A. The Open in Excel Wizard command is more useful, as the wizard is able
to break up report detail lines into separate columns for the account, debit, and credit
(or amount and AR flag for cash deposits).
To open an instaprint report in an Excel spreadsheet:
1 Click the
[Open in Excel] icon.
2 A new Microsoft Excel window opens and displays the contents of the instaprint
report.
Each row of the spreadsheet has only one column. The entire content of each
report line is in Column A. If you want to make the columns line up, format Column A with a monospaced font.
B-6
, 2010
Copyright © QSS
01/10
Saving and Printing Instaprint Reports
Opening in Excel
Figure B-4: Excel worksheet with entire report line in Column A
3 If you want to create an Excel spreadsheet, save the file in Excel format.
After you select File and Save from the pull-down menus in Excel, a Save As dialog box opens.
Figure B-5: Save As dialog box dialog box for Excel
This dialog box allows you to define the path, name, and type for the file.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
B-7
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Appendix B: QSSInstaPrint Window
◊ From the Save in drop-down list, select the drive and folder for saving the file.
If you leave this selection as is, the file is saved in the Temp folder for your
QCC user name.
◊ In the File name, type the name that you want to give the file. If you leave this
selection as is, the file has the system-assigned name that displays in the title
bar for the Microsoft Excel window. You can give the file a shorter and more
meaningful name.
◊ From the Save as type drop-down list, select one of the following:
> Leave Text (Tab Delimited) (*.txt) as is to save the file as a plain text file.
> Select Microsoft Excel Workbook (*.xls) to save the file as an Excel file.
◊ Select [Save] to save the file, or select [Cancel] to close the Save As dialog box
without saving the file.
Opening in Excel Wizard
The Open in Excel Wizard command allows you to save the instaprint report in an
Excel spreadsheet. The wizard is able to split the detail lines for accounts into separate columns for accounts, debits, and credits. However, the wizard is unable to parse
the header lines before the account detail lines. Also, the wizard is not able to parse
the deposit summary for cash deposits because its layout is too complex.
To create a spreadsheet for an instaprint report:
1 Click the
[Open in Excel Wizard] icon.
2 An Open dialog box displays.
◊ Select [Cancel] to abandon sending the file.
◊ Press [Open] to continue to the next step.
B-8
, 2010
Copyright © QSS
01/10
Saving and Printing Instaprint Reports
Opening in Excel Wizard
3 Define the type of text to import in the Text Import Wizard.
Figure B-6: Text Import Wizard step for choosing original data type
Excel opens the first of three screens for the Text Import Wizard. This step allows
you to define the type of file being imported to Excel.
◊ For the Original data type, the Text Import Wizard automatically checks
Fixed width. Leave this check box as is.
◊ Select [Next >] to continue to the next step.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
B-9
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Appendix B: QSSInstaPrint Window
4 Define the data that goes in each column of the spreadsheet in the Text Import
Wizard.
Figure B-7: Wizard for dividing up the report line into spreadsheet columns
The vertical lines indicate where the wizard senses that fields begin and end. It is
usually able to detect the fixed width columns correctly, so there is normally no
need to change anything for this step.
Select [Next >] to continue with importing data.
5 If desired, define the data format for each column of the spreadsheet in the Text
Import Wizard.
Figure B-8: Wizard for defining the data format for each column of the spreadsheet
B-10
, 2010
Copyright © QSS
01/10
Saving and Printing Instaprint Reports
Opening in Excel Wizard
In most cases, the default choice of General format will work for a column. But
you can customize each column.
HINT: The General format removes all leading zeroes. For example, 0018 becomes
18. If you want to maintain leading zeroes on accounts, site numbers, district numbers, and the like, select the Text format.
Do the following to change the format of a column:
◊ Click a column to highlight it in black.
◊ Under Column data format, click the radio button for a data format or the button for skipping a column.
After you have completed defining the column formats, select [Finish] to import
the file into a spreadsheet.
6 A Microsoft Excel window opens and displays the data you have just imported.
Figure B-9: Microsoft Excel window with data imported into columns
If the spreadsheet did not import as expected, close the Microsoft Word window
without saving the spreadsheet.
After the import, you can resize columns to fit the data by doing the following:
◊ Click the empty gray box above row 1 and to the left of column A.
◊ Place the mouse pointer between any two column headings. When you do, the
cursor becomes a double-headed arrow .
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
B-11
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Appendix B: QSSInstaPrint Window
◊ Double-click the left mouse button to reformat all columns to the width of the
data that they contain.
7 If you want to keep the Excel spreadsheet, save the file in Excel format.
Figure B-10: Save As dialog box dialog box for Excel
After you select File and Save As from the pull-down menus in Excel, a Save As
dialog box opens. It displays the system-assigned path and name. Use this dialog
box to define the drive, folder, and name under which you want to save the file.
◊ From the Save in drop-down list, select the drive and folder for saving the file.
If you leave this selection as is, the file is saved in the Temp folder for your
QCC user. QSS suggests that you select a different folder for files that you
want to keep.
◊ In the File name, type the name that you want to give the file. If you leave this
selection as is, the file retains the system-assigned name that displays in the title
bar for the Microsoft Excel window. You can give the file a shorter and more
meaningful name.
◊ From the Save as type drop-down list, select Microsoft Excel Workbook
(*.xls).
◊ Select [Save] to save the file, or select [Cancel] to close the Save As dialog box
without saving the file.
B-12
, 2010
Copyright © QSS
01/10
Saving and Printing Instaprint Reports
Opening in Word
Opening in Word
These instructions tell how to save an instaprint report as a word document. They
illustrate the steps for using Word 2003 to accomplish this task.
To open a Word document:
1 Click the
[Open in Word] icon.
A new Microsoft Word window opens and displays the instaprint report. The document is formatted in 10 point Courier type for portrait print on standard 8-1/2 by
11 inch paper.
2 If desired, save the file with a path and name of your choice.
A Save As dialog box opens after you select File and Save As from Word’s pulldown menus.
Figure B-11: Save As dialog box dialog box for Word
This dialog box allows you to select the path, name, and type of the file.
◊ From the Save in drop-down list, select the drive and folder for saving the file.
If you leave this selection as is, the file is saved in the Temp folder for your
QCC user name. QSS suggests that you select a different folder for files that
you want to keep.
◊ In the File name, type the name that you want to give the file. If you leave this
selection as is, the file has the system-assigned name that displays in the title
bar for the Microsoft Word window. You can give the file a shorter and more
meaningful name.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
B-13
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Appendix B: QSSInstaPrint Window
◊ From the Save as type drop-down list, select the file format.
> Select Plain Text (*.txt) to save the file as a plain text file. You cannot
change the font, make text bold, or do any other such enhancements to the
file.
> Select Word Document (*.doc) to save the file as a Word document. With
this format, you can use Word to change the font, make text bold or italic,
and do other such formatting enhancements.
Creating a PDF File
These instructions tell how to save an instaprint report as a PDF file.
To create a PDF file:
1 Click the
[Create PDF] icon to open a Create PDF dialog box.
Figure B-12: Create PDF dialog box for making a PDF file
2 Leave the Input file as is.
The box displays the full path to the Temp folder for your QCC user name. The
system assigns the name of the input file based on the time you created it, such as
out20060914164358.txt for a file created on year 2006, month 09, day 14, time
16:43:58.
3 For the Output file, select the path and the name for the PDF file that you are
creating.
QSS suggests that you choose a path other than the cryptic one assigned by QCC.
You can select the file path and name in one of the following ways:
B-14
, 2010
Copyright © QSS
01/10
Saving and Printing Instaprint Reports
Creating a PDF File
Table B-3: Commands for the PDF dialog box
MENU COMMAND
KEYBOARD
ICON
PURPOSE
File | Exit
F12
none
Close the dialog box.
Options | Create
PDF
Ctrl+F1
Create a PDF file from the data grid.
Options | Open
PDF
Ctrl+F2
Open the PDF file after you have created it with the Create PDF
command.
Options | Reset to
Defaults
Ctrl+D
Restore all of the boxes on the dialog
box to their default settings.
Options | Print
Screen
F11
Print a graphic image of the dialog
box on the default Windows printer
for your PC.
◊ Type the full path of the name for the PDF file, such as:
f:\archives\printfilelist.pdf
Be sure that .pdf is at the end of the file name. That extension signals Windows to open the file with Adobe Acrobat or Adobe Reader.
◊ Click the box to the right of the Output file to bring up a Save PDF As dialog
box.
> From the Save in drop-down list, select the drive and folder in which you
want to create the PDF file.
> Type the File name for the PDF file.
> Leave the Save as type as is.
> Select [Save] to select the file name and close the dialog box, or select
[Cancel] to close the dialog box without changing the default file name and
continue.
4 If desired, fill in the optional Author Name, Creator, Keywords, Subject, and
Title.
All of these fields are optional. They are primarily for making the file more visible
to Web search engines that use the Title to display the name of the document and
the Keywords to search for documents.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
B-15
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Appendix B: QSSInstaPrint Window
5 Select a Font from the drop-down list.
The only choices are Courier and Courier New, which are monospaced fonts.
Thus, the columns will line up properly in the PDF file.
6 Select a Font Size from the drop-down list.
For the instaprint report, 10 points is a good size. The print lines are large enough
to read easily. Smaller fonts may be difficult to read, and a larger font size will
make each line of the report too big to fit on the print line.
NOTE: For instaprint reports, there is no need to make any other adjustments to the print
layout. Skip to Step 12 to create the PDF file with the default settings. However, you can
customize the page layout if you like.
7 Select a Paper Size from the drop-down list.
8 Select the Vertical Spacing from the drop-down list, or select the number of Lines
per Page.
◊ The Vertical Spacing can be anything from 0.2 to 4.999 in increments of .001
lines.
> A setting of 1.000 means that there is no extra white space between the lines.
For example, the current font is 10-point Courier New. The distance between
the baseline of one line and the next is 10 points. (A point is 1/72 of an inch.)
> A setting of more than 1.000 means there is white space between the lines.
For example, a line spacing of 1.200 means that distance between the baseline of one line and the next is 1.200 times the font size. In the case of 10
point Courier New, this setting inserts 2 points of extra space between print
lines.
> A setting of less than 1.000 creates negative white space. For example, a line
spacing of 0.800 means that the distance between the baseline of one line
and the next is 0.800 times the point size for the font.
First line of 10 point Courier New with line spacing of 0.800.
Second line of 10 point Courier New with line spacing of 0.800.
First line of 10 point Courier New with line spacing of 1.000.
Second line of 10 point Courier New with line spacing of 1.000.
First line of 10 point Courier New with line spacing of 1.200.
Second line of 10 point Courier New with line spacing of 1.200.
◊ The Lines per Page can be anywhere from 1 through 200.
B-16
, 2010
Copyright © QSS
01/10
Saving and Printing Instaprint Reports
Creating a PDF File
This number is the total lines per page from the top edge of the page to the bottom edge. Many laser printers have an unprintable area around the outside edge
of the page, so the number of printable lines may be less than the Lines per
Page.
The two drop-down lists are linked.
◊ If you select the Vertical Spacing, the Lines per Page list displays how many
lines fit on each page.
◊ If you select the Lines per Page, the Vertical Spacing list displays the amount
of space between lines to make the number of lines fit on a page.
The Lines per Page and Vertical Spacing adjustment allow you to select how
much text fits on each page. Thus, you can fine tune the line spacing for special
forms, such as warrants or purchase orders.
9 For Rotate, select the number of degrees to rotate the print.
In most cases, you can leave the rotation at zero degrees and use the Page Size
selection to determine whether the PDF file has a portrait or landscape orientation.
10 For Left Margin, select how far in from the left side of the page you want each
print line to be.
11 For Top Margin, select how far down from the top of the page you want the first
line to print.
12 Create the PDF file in any of the following ways.
◊ Click the
[Create PDF] icon.
◊ Press CTRL+F1.
◊ From the menu bar, click Options and Create PDF.
After the file is created, the title bar displays the message “*** File created ***.”
13 If Adobe Acrobat or Adobe Reader is installed on your PC, you can view the PDF
file that you have just created in any of the following ways:
◊ Click the
[Open PDF] icon.
◊ Press CTRL+F2.
◊ From the menu bar, select Options and Open PDF.
01/10
Copyright © QSS, 2010
B-17
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Appendix B: QSSInstaPrint Window
14 Close the Create PDF dialog box in any of the following ways.
◊ Click the
[Exit] icon.
◊ Press F12.
◊ From the menu bar, click File and Exit.
B-18
, 2010
Copyright © QSS
01/10
Index
A
About (Shift+F12) command, 2-6, 3-6
Absence FTE Codes (AF) master file, 4-29 to 4-30
Absence Indices (AI) master file, 4-27
Absence Interface Rules (IR) master file, 4-37 to 4-42
Absence Reasons (AR) master file, 4-21 to 4-22
Absence Tracking master files, list of, 4-21
AC (Accrual Rules) master file, 4-32 to 4-35
Accrual Rules (AC) master file, 4-32 to 4-35
Accrual Schedules (AS) master file, 4-36 to 4-37
Accumulator Limits (RTAL) master file, 4-249 to
4-250
activating tabs, A-5
Add dialog box, instructions for using, 2-27 to 2-29
Add New (Ctrl+F6) command, 2-7, 3-7
Add New No Preload (Shift+F6) command, 2-7, 3-7
add/import multiple records
formats for master file records, 2-32
instructions, 2-30 to 2-31
source files, 2-30
adding master file records, 2-27 to 2-29
AF (Absence FTE Codes) master file, 4-29 to 4-30
AI (Absence Indices) master file, 4-27
ALT+TAB (previous available box), A-6
AR (Absence Reasons) master file, 4-21 to 4-22
AS (Accrual Schedules) master file, 4-36 to 4-37
audience for manual, 1-6
Auto Select (Ctrl+A) command, 2-7, 3-7
B
Bargaining Units (BU) master file, 4-50 to 4-51
BC (Bonus Codes) master file, 4-125 to 4-126
BD (Benefit Controls) master file, 4-135 to 4-136
BD (Board Dates) master file, 4-51 to 4-52
Benefit Controls (BC) master file, 4-135 to 4-136
Benefit Group Maps (GMAP) master file, 4-139 to
4-140
Benefit Object Maps (OMAP) master file, 4-136 to
4-137
Benefit Projected Rates (BPR) master file, 4-164,
4-166
Benefit Status Codes (BMBS) master file, 4-243 to
4-244
Benefits Management, list of master files for, 4-223
01/10
BMBS (Benefit Status Codes) master file, 4-243 to
4-244
BMCA (Cap Amounts) master file, 4-242
BMCL (Deduction Class List) master file, 4-226 to
4-227
BMDC (Depenent Codes) master file, 4-227 to 4-228
BMFT (FTE Allocation Table) master file, 4-229 to
4-233
BMLC (Coverage Level Codes) master file, 4-223 to
4-224
BMPA (Package Assignment) master file, 4-244
BMPC (Plan Codes) master file, 4-237
BMPK (Package Codes) master file, 4-234
BMPL (Plan/Level Amounts) master file, 4-240
Board Dates (BD) master file, 4-51 to 4-52
Bonus Codes (BC) master file, 4-125 to 4-126
Box Label column for master files, 4-14
BPR (Benefit Projected Rates) master file, 4-164,
4-166
BU (Bargaining Units) master file, 4-50 to 4-51
C
CA (Credential Authorizations) master file, 4-62 to
4-63
California Retirement Setup (TT10) master file, 4-158
to 4-159
California State Disability (TT11) master file, 4-159 to
4-160
Cap Amounts (BMCA) master file, 4-242
category, list of master files by, 4-4 to 4-6
CB (Credential Subject Codes) master file, 4-65 to
4-66
Certificate Level (CL) master file, 4-52 to 4-53
Certificate Type (CT) master file, 4-54 to 4-55
CG (Control Groups) master file, 4-57 to 4-58
Change (Ctrl+F9) command, 2-7, 3-7
Change dialog box, instructions for using, 2-25 to 2-26
changing master file records, 2-25 to 2-26
check boxes, A-8
check boxes (yes/no choices) for master files, 4-17
CL (Certificate Level) master file, 4-52 to 4-53
Clear Filter (F4) command, 2-7, 3-7
Clear Settings on Exit command, 2-5, 3-5
closing folders on tree view, 2-9 to 2-10, 3-9 to 3-11
Copyright © QSS, 2010
Index-1
Human Resources Master Files Manual
D
CN (Contract Types) master file, 4-56 to 4-57
CO (Comments Types) master file, 4-55 to 4-56
code, master files listed by, 4-10 to 4-12
Collapse All Branches (Ctrl+C) command, 2-5, 2-7,
3-5, 3-7
commands
File menu, 2-4 to 2-5, 3-4 to 3-5
Help menu, 2-6, 3-6
Options menu, 2-6 to 2-7, 3-6 to 3-7
toolbar, 2-6 to 2-7, 3-6 to 3-7
View menu, 2-5 to 2-6, 3-5 to 3-6
Comments Type (CO) master file, 4-55 to 4-56
Contract Types (CN) master file, 4-56 to 4-57
Control Groups (CG) master file, 4-57 to 4-58
County/State Codes (CS) master file, 4-59 to 4-60
county-level master files, 2-12 to 2-13, 3-13
Coverage Leel Codes (BMLC) master file, 4-223 to
4-224
CR (Credentials) master file, 4-61 to 4-62
Create Report (Ctrl+R) command, 2-7, 3-7
Credential Authorizations (CA) master file, 4-62 to
4-63
Credential Level Codes (CV) master file, 4-66 to 4-67
Credential Renewal Codes (CW) master file, 4-64 to
4-65
Credentials (CR) master file, 4-61 to 4-62
CredentialSubject Codes (CB) master file, 4-65 to
4-66
CS (County/State Codes) master file, 4-59 to 4-60
CT (Certificate Type) master file, 4-54 to 4-55
Ctrl+A (Auto Select) command, 2-7, 3-7
Ctrl+C (Collapse All Branches) command, 2-7, 3-7
Ctrl+E (Expand All Branches) command, 2-7, 3-7
Ctrl+F (Preserve Expanded Branchs) command, 2-5,
3-5
Ctrl+F5 (Inspect) command, 2-7, 3-7
Ctrl+F6 (Add New) command, 2-7, 3-7
Ctrl+F9 (Change) command, 2-7, 3-7
Ctrl+F12 (Show Status) command, 2-4 to 2-5, 3-4 to
3-5
Ctrl+R (Create Report) command, 2-7, 3-7
Ctrl+T (Expand Tree on Startup) command, 2-5, 3-5
CV (Credential Level Codes) master file, 4-66 to 4-67
CW (Credential Renewal Codes) master file, 4-64 to
4-65
Index-2
DAP (District Authorized Positions) master file
account Distribution tab, 4-174
Benefits tab, 4-175
Description tab, 4-170 to 4-171
Employee List tab, 4-176
header information, 4-170
instructions for using, 4-167 to 4-169
overview, 4-166
Requirements 1 tab, 4-172
Requirements 2 tab, 4-173
DAPN (New District Authorized Positions) master file
Accounts Distribution tab, 4-185 to 4-187
Authorized Position Report, 4-188 to 4-189
Authorized Position Report (Abbreviated Format),
4-190 to 4-191
Description tab, 4-182 to 4-183
Employee List tab, 4-187
Employee Position Report, 4-189 to 4-190
header information, 4-181
instructions for maintaining, 4-177 to 4-181
overview, 4-177
Position Invalid Account Report, 4-191, 4-193
Requirements 1 tab, 4-183 to 4-184
Requirements 2 tab, 4-184 to 4-185
date boxes
changing dates, A-9
selecting current date, A-10
selecting dates from calendar, A-9
typing dates, A-9
dates, filling in for master files, 4-15 to 4-16
Deduction Class List (BMCL) master file, 4-226 to
4-227
Deduction Rate Table (DR) master file, 4-123 to 4-124
Deduction Rule Codes (PR) master file, 4-128 to
4-129
Deduction Schedule (DS) master file, 4-121 to 4-122
Deduction Schedule Code Links (FL06) master file,
4-221
Degree Type (DT) code, 4-67 to 4-68
deleting master file records, 2-25 to 2-26
Dependent Codes (BMDC) mster file, 4-227 to 4-228
District (DP) master file, 4-44 to 4-46
District Authorized Positions (DAP) master file
Account Distribution tab, 4-174
Benefits tab, 4-175
Description tab, 4-170 to 4-171
Employee List tab, 4-176
header information, 4-170
instructions for using, 4-167 to 4-169
overview, 4-166
Requirements 1 tab, 4-172
Requirements 2 tab, 4-173
District Master File (RTDI) master file, 4-247 to 4-248
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Index
District Master File by Group (RTDG) master file,
4-255 to 4-256
district selection from QSS ControlCenter window,
2-18, 3-18
district-level master files, 2-12 to 2-13, 3-13
dollar amounts for master files, 4-16
DP (District) master file, 4-44 to 4-46
DR (Deduction Rate Table) master file, 4-123 to 4-124
drop-down arrow, A-6
drop-down lists, A-6 to A-7
DS (Deduction Schedule) master file, 4-121 to 4-122
DT (Degree Type) code, 4-67 to 4-68
E
EM (Employee Types) master file, 4-69 to 4-70
Employee Types (EM) master file, 4-69 to 4-70
ET (Ethnic Codes) master file, 4-70 to 4-71
ET (Experience Types) master file, 4-71 to 4-72
Ethnic Codes (ET) master file, 4-70 to 4-71
ew District Authorized Positions (DAPN) master file
Authorized Position Report (Abbreviated Format),
4-191
Position Invalid Account Report, 4-191, 4-193
Exit (F12) command, 2-5, 3-5
Expand All Branches (Ctrl+E) command, 2-5, 2-7,
3-5, 3-7
Expand Tree on Startup (Ctrl+T) command, 2-5, 3-5
Experience Types (ET) master file, 4-71 to 4-72
F
F2 (Retrieve Data) command, 2-7, 3-7
F4 (Clear Filter) command, 2-7, 3-7
F9 (Save) command, 2-7, 3-7
F11 (Print Screen) command, 2-7, 3-7
F12 (Exit) command, 2-5, 3-5
Federal Income Tax (TT01) master file
EIC tab, 4-142 to 4-143
New EIC tab, 4-145
overview, 4-141
withholding table tabs, 4-143 to 4-144
File menu, 2-4 to 2-5, 3-4 to 3-5
filter
examples of searching, 2-15 to 2-16, 3-15 to 3-17
instructions for using, 2-13 to 2-14, 3-14 to 3-15
fiscal years for master files, 4-16
fixed decimal points boxes for master files, 4-17
FL01 (Pay Code Links) master file, 4-216 to 4-217
01/10
FL02 (Vol-Ded Frequency Code Links) master file,
4-218
FL02 (Voluntary Deduction Code Links) master file,
4-217
FL04 (Pay Schedule Code Links) master file, 4-219
FL05 (Stat Ded profile Code Links) master file, 4-220
FL06 (Deduction Schedule Code Links) master file,
4-221
folder, list of master files by, 4-4 to 4-6
folders, expanding and collapsing on tree view, 2-9 to
2-10, 3-9 to 3-11
FP (Freeze Placement Reasons) master file, 4-73
Freeze Placement Reasons (FP) master file, 4-73
FTE Allocation Table (BMFT) master file, 4-229 to
4-233
G
GMAP (Benefit Group Maps) master file, 4-139 to
4-140
grid
columns, 2-19 to 2-20, 3-19
keyboard shortcuts, A-4
name of master file, 2-19, 3-19
navigating, A-2 to A-3
resizing, A-3
scroll bars, A-3
sorting, A-4
Grid Output (Shift+F11) command, 2-7, 3-7
H
HA (Handicap) master file, 4-74 to 4-75
Handicap (HA) master file, 4-74 to 4-75
Health/Welfare Benefit Maps (VMAP) master file,
4-138 to 4-139
help file viewer, 1-7
Help menu, 2-6, 3-6
HO (Hospital Codes) master file, 4-75 to 4-76
Hospital Codes (HO) master file, 4-75 to 4-76
how to use this manual, 1-5
HR Code Maintenance window
filter
examples of searching, 2-15 to 2-16, 3-15 to
3-17
instructions for using, 2-13 to 2-14, 3-14 to
3-15
grid
columns, 2-19 to 2-20, 3-19
name of master file, 2-19, 3-19
-- continued on next column --
Copyright © QSS, 2010
Index-3
Human Resources Master Files Manual
HR Code Maintenance window - continued
menu bar
File menu, 2-4 to 2-5, 3-4 to 3-5
Help menu, 2-6, 3-6
Options menu, 2-6 to 2-7, 3-6 to 3-7
View menu, 2-5 to 2-6, 3-5 to 3-6
message bar, 2-8, 3-8
overview, 2-3, 3-3
status bar, 2-20, 3-20
title bar, 2-3 to 2-4, 3-3 to 3-4
toolbar, 2-6 to 2-7, 3-6 to 3-7
tree view
access level icons, 2-11 to 2-12, 3-11 to 3-12
county- and district-level master files, 2-12 to
2-13, 3-13
displaying master files in grid, 2-10 to 2-11,
3-11
expanding and collapsing folders, 2-9 to 2-10,
3-9 to 3-11
purpose, 2-9, 3-9
sample, 2-8, 3-8
I
IC (Insurance Carrier) master file, 4-81 to 4-82
IE (Inservice Ed Component) master file, 4-79 to 4-80
IM (Immunization) master file, 4-78 to 4-79
Immunization (IM) master file, 4-78 to 4-79
IN (Instiutiions) (Colleges) master file, 4-77 to 4-78
Inservice Ed Component (IE) master file, 4-79 to 4-80
Inspect (Ctrl+F5) command, 2-7, 3-7
inspecting master file records, 2-23 to 2-24, 3-23 to
3-25
InstaPrint. See QSSInstaPrint window
Institutions (Colleges) (IN) master file, 4-77
Institutions (Colleges)(IN) master file, ?? to 4-78
Insurance Carrier (IC) master file, 4-81 to 4-82
IR (Absence Interface Rules) master file, 4-37 to 4-42
J
JB (Job Categories) master file, 4-84 to 4-85
JC (Job Codes) master file, 4-85 to 4-88
Job Categories (JB) master file, 4-84 to 4-85
Job Codes (JC) master file, 4-85 to 4-88
Job Menu window, 1-9
K
knowledge assumed, 1-6
Index-4
L
LA (Language Codes) master file, 4-88 to 4-89
Language Codes (LA) master file, 4-88 to 4-89
launching reports for master files, 2-29
Leave Groups (LG) master file, 4-23 to 4-26
LG (Leave Groups) master fiile, 4-23 to 4-26
list boxes, A-6
lists, selections from, 4-18 to 4-19
LO (Location Org Levels Fields) master file, 4-49
LOC (Locations) master file, 4-46 to 4-47
Location Org Levels Fiels (LO) master file, 4-49
Locations (LOC) master file, 4-46 to 4-47
locked master file, icon for, 2-11, 3-12
M
Maintain User Data (MEN020) and user security for
QCC, 1-9
manual overview, 1-2 to 1-3
master file descriptions
Box Label column, 4-14
Contents column
check boxes (yes/no choices), 4-17
date, 4-15 to 4-16
dollar amounts, 4-16
fiscal years, 4-16
fixed decimal points, 4-17
lists, 4-18 to 4-19
numerals, 4-17
numeric codes, 4-17
option buttons, 4-18
text, 4-19
time stamp, 4-19
overview, 4-13
R/O/D column, 4-14 to 4-15
table layout, 4-13 to 4-14
master file links, list of, 4-216
master files
adding records, 2-27 to 2-29
changing records, 2-25 to 2-26
county level, 2-12 to 2-13, 3-13
deleting records, 2-25 to 2-26
displaying in the grid, 2-10 to 2-11, 3-11
district level, 2-12 to 2-13, 3-13
icons for access levels, 2-11 to 2-12, 3-11 to 3-12
insepcting records, 2-23 to 2-24, 3-23 to 3-25
launching reports, 2-29
name and code in tree view, 2-12, 3-13
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Index
master files, list of
Absence Tracking, 4-21
Benefits Management, 4-223
by code, 4-10 to 4-12
by folder in tree view, 4-4 to 4-6
by name, 4-6 to 4-9
master file links, 4-216
Payroll, 4-105
Personnel, 4-43 to 4-44
Position Control, 4-161
Retirement - CA, 4-246
ME (Medical Codes) master file, 4-82 to 4-83
Medical Codes (ME) master file, 4-82 to 4-83
Medicare tax rate table, 4-147 to 4-148
message bar, 2-8, 3-8
Module, Task, and User Security for QCC, 1-9
Module, Task, and User Security for QCC guide, 1-9
MPE logon ID, 1-9
N
name, master files listed by, 4-7 to 4-9
New District Authorized Positions (DAPN) master file
Account Distribution tab, 4-185 to 4-187
Authorized Position Report, 4-188 to 4-189
Authorized Position Report (Abbreviated Format),
4-190
Description tab, 4-182 to 4-183
Employee List tab, 4-187
Employee Position Report, 4-189 to 4-190
header information, 4-181
instructions for maintaining, 4-177 to 4-181
overview, 4-177
Requirements 1 tab, 4-183 to 4-184
Requirements 2 tab, 4-184 to 4-185
New Salary Schedules (SSN) master file
Benefits tab, 4-206 to 4-207
Bonus Calculation Rules tab, 4-202 to 4-203
header information, 4-200
instrutions for maintaining, 4-193 to 4-199
Payroll Interface Rules tab, 4-202
report sample, 4-208
Schedule Calculation Factors tab, 4-200 to 4-201
Steps and Ranges tab, 4-204 to 4-206
no access, icon for, 2-12, 3-12
numerals, filling in for master files, 4-17
numeric codes for master files, 4-17
01/10
O
OASDI/Medicare (TT03) master file, 4-147 to 4-148
objectives, 1-3 to 1-4
OMAP (Benefit Object maps) master file, 4-136 to
4-137
opening folders on tree view, 2-9 to 2-10, 3-9 to 3-11
option buttons, 4-18, A-8
Options menu, 2-6, 3-6
P
PA (PAF Category) master file, 4-101 to 4-102
Package Assignment (BMPA) master file, 4-244
Package Codes (BMPK) master file, 4-234
PAF Actions (PF) master file, 4-103 to 4-104
PAF Category (PA) master file, 4-101 to 4-102
PAF Dictionary (PD) master file, 4-104
Pay code Links (FL01) master file, 4-216 to 4-217
Pay Codes (PC) master file, 4-106 to 4-107
Pay Schedule Code Links (FL04) master file, 4-219
Pay Schedule Controls (RTPS) master file, 4-253 to
4-254
Pay Schedules (PS) master file, 4-109 to 4-111
Pay Types (PT) master file, 4-111 to 4-112
Payroll Edit Rules (PE) master file, 4-127 to 4-128
Payroll Master Files, list of, 4-105
Payroll Name (PYN) master files, 4-107 to 4-108
Payroll Profiles (PP) master file, 4-116 to 4-117
PB (Position Bonus Codes) master file, 4-162 to 4-164
PC (Pay Codes) master file, 4-106 to 4-107
PCR400 (District Positions Report), 4-189
PCR405 (Employee Position Report), 4-190
PCR409 (Position-Account Report), 4-193
PCR420 (Abbreviated District Position Report), 4-191
PD (PAF Dictionary) master file, 4-104
PE (Payroll Edit Rules) master file, 4-127 to 4-128
Pending Retirement Status Codes (PN) master file,
4-131 to 4-132
PERS California (TT08) master file, 4-155 to 4-156
PERS Rates (RTPE) master file, 4-251 to 4-252
PERS Rates by Group (RTGP) master file, 4-257 to
4-258
Personnel Master Files, list of, 4-43 to 4-44
PF (PAF Actions) master file, 4-103 to 4-104
PG (Program of Graduation) master file, 4-89 to 4-90
Plan Codes (BMPC) master file, 4-237
Plan/Level Amounts (BMPL) master file, 4-240
Copyright © QSS, 2010
Index-5
Human Resources Master Files Manual
PN (Pending Retirement Status Codes) master file,
4-131 to 4-132
Position Control Codes (PB) master file, 4-162 to
4-164
Position Control master files, list of, 4-161
PP (Payroll Profiles) master file, 4-116 to 4-117
PP0032 (Salary Schedule Matrix), 4-208
PR (Deduction Rule Codes) master file, 4-128 to
4-129
Preserve Expanded Branches (Ctrl+F) command, 2-5,
3-5
Print Screen (F11) command, 2-7, 3-7
Printing Reports with Print Manager, 1-8
Program of Graduation (PG) master file, 4-89 to 4-90
PS (Pay Schedules) master file, 4-109 to 4-111
PT (Pay Types) master file, 4-111 to 4-112
PYN (Payroll Name) master file, 4-107 to 4-108
Retirement Edits (RE) master file, 4-114 to 4-115
Q
RTST (STRS Rates) master file, 4-250 to 4-251
QCC help files, 1-7
QSS ControlCenter Guide, 1-7
QSS ControlCenter window, 1-9
help file viewer, 1-7
QSSInstaPrint window
creating a PDF file, B-14 to B-18
File menu, B-3
opening in Excel, B-6 to B-8
opening in Excel Wizard, B-8 to B-12
opening in Word, B-13 to B-14
Options menu, B-3 to B-4
overview, B-2
saving to a file, B-5 to B-6
toolbar, B-3 to B-4
Retrieve Data (F2) command, 2-7, 3-7
RO (Roll Codes) master file, 4-31 to 4-32
Roll Codes (RO) master file, 4-31 to 4-32
RR (Refusal Reason) master file, 4-91 to 4-92
RS (Retirement Systems) master file, 4-113 to 4-114
RTAL (Accumulator Limits) master file, 4-249 to
4-250
RTDG (District Master File by Group) master file,
4-255 to 4-256
RTDI (District Master File) master file, 4-247 to 4-248
RTGP (PERS Rates by Group) master file, 4-257 to
4-258
RTPE (PERS Rates) master file, 4-251 to 4-252
RTPS (Pay Schedule Rate Controls) master file, 4-253
to 4-254
S
Salary Schedules (SS) master file, 4-193
Salary Shedule Matrix (PP0032), 4-208
Save (F9) command, 2-7, 3-7
SD (Statutory Deduction Codes) master file, 4-118
searching master file codes, 2-15 to 2-16, 3-15 to 3-17
Secure Support Area, 1-8
selected master file, icon for, 2-11, 3-11
Seniority Class (SN) master file, 4-93 to 4-94
Session Administration window, 1-8
Shift+F6 (Add New No Preload) command, 2-7, 3-7
Shift+F11 (Grid Output) command, 2-7, 3-7
R
Shift+F12 (About) command, 2-6, 3-6
R/O/D column for master file descriptions, 4-14 to
4-15
radio buttons, A-8
RC (Report Codes) master file, 4-92 to 4-93
RE (Retirement Edits) master file, 4-114 to 4-115
read-only master file, icon for, 2-11, 3-12
Refusal Reason (RR) master file, 4-91 to 4-92
related documentation, 1-7 to 1-9
Report Codes (RC) master file, 4-92 to 4-93
reports for master files, launching, 2-29
Retirement - CA master ffiles, list of master files,
4-246
Index-6
Retirement Systems (RS) master file, 4-113 to 4-114
Show Status (Ctrl+F12) command, 2-4 to 2-5, 3-4 to
3-5
SK (Skill Codes) master file, 4-95 to 4-96
Skill Codes (SK) master file, 4-95 to 4-96
SM (SMF Status Codes) master file, 4-129 to 4-131
SMF Status Codes (SM) master file, 4-129 to 4-131
SN (Seniority Class) master file, 4-93 to 4-94
Social Security tax rate table, 4-147 to 4-148
SP (Statutory Deduction Profiles) master file, 4-119 to
4-120
SS (Salary Schedules) master file, 4-193
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10
Index
SSN (New Salary Schedules) master file
Benefits tab, 4-206 to 4-207
Bonus Calculation Rules tab, 4-202 to 4-203
header information, 4-200
instrucctions for maintaining, 4-193 to 4-199
Payroll Interface Rules tab, 4-202
report sample, 4-208
Schedule Calculation Factors tab, 4-200 to 4-201
Steps and Ranges tab, 4-204 to 4-206
Stat Ded profile Code Links (FL05) master file, 4-220
State Tax California (TT06) master file
Method B tabs, 4-152 to 4-153
overview, 4-150
Tables 1/2, 3/4 tab, 4-151 to 4-152
status bar, 2-20, 3-20
Statutory Deduction Codes (SD) master file, 4-118
Statutory Deduction Profiles (SP) Master File, 4-119
to 4-120
Statutory Deductions Codes (SD) master file, 4-118
STRS California (TT09) master file, 4-156 to 4-158
STRS Rates (RTST) master file, 4-250 to 4-251
SU (Subject Codes) master file, 4-96 to 4-97
Subject Codes (SU) master file, 4-96 to 4-97
SUI California (TT07) master file, 4-153 to 4-155
System Security and Session Administration for QCC,
1-8
System Security window, 1-8
T
TAB (next availble box), A-6
tabs
navigating, A-5
selecting boxes, A-5 to A-6
tax tables, 4-140
TE (Termination Code) master file, 4-98 to 4-99
Termination Code (TE) master file, 4-98 to 4-99
Test Master Codes (TM) master file, 4-100 to 4-101
text boxes
adding text, A-7
available, A-5
deleting text, A-7
editing content, A-7
replacing text, A-7 to A-8
text boxes for master files, 4-19
time stamp for master files, 4-19
title bar, 2-3 to 2-4, 3-3 to 3-4
TM (Test Master Codes) master file, 4-100 to 4-101
toolbar, 2-6 to 2-7, 3-6 to 3-7
01/10
tree view
access level icons, 2-11 to 2-12, 3-11 to 3-12
county- and district-level master files, 2-12 to
2-13, 3-13
displaying master files in grid, 2-10 to 2-11, 3-11
expanding and collapsing folders, 2-9 to 2-10, 3-9
to 3-11
purpose, 2-9, 3-9
sample, 2-8, 3-8
tree view, list of master files in, 4-4 to 4-6
TT01 (Federal Income Tax) master file
EIC tab, 4-142 to 4-143
New EIC tab, 4-145 to 4-146
overview, 4-141
wihtholding table tabs, 4-144
withholding table tabs, 4-143
TT03 (OASDI/Medicare) master file, 4-147 to 4-148
TT05 (Workers Compensation) master file, 4-148 to
4-150
TT06 (State Tax California) master file
Method B tabs, 4-152 to 4-153
overview, 4-150
Tables 1/2, 3/4 tab, 4-151 to 4-152
TT07 (SUI California) master file, 4-153 to 4-155
TT08 (PERS California) master file, 4-155 to 4-156
TT09 (STRS California) master file, 4-156 to 4-158
TT10 (California Retirement Setup) master file, 4-158
to 4-159
TT11 (California State Disability) master file, 4-159 to
4-160
U
user security and Maintain User Data (MEN020), 1-9
V
VD (Vol-Ded Frequency Codes) master file, 4-132 to
4-133
VD (Voluntary Deductions) master file, 4-133 to
4-135
View dialog box, instructions for using, 2-23 to 2-24,
3-23 to 3-25, 4-194 to 4-196
View menu, 2-5 to 2-6, 3-5 to 3-6
viewing master file records, 2-23 to 2-24, 3-23 to 3-25
VMAP (Health/Welfare Benefit Maps) master file,
4-138 to 4-139
Vol-Ded Frequency Code Links (FL03) master file,
4-218
Vol-Ded Frequency Codes (VD) master file, 4-132 to
4-133
Copyright © QSS, 2010
Index-7
Human Resources Master Files Manual
Voluntary Deduction Code Links (FL02) master file,
4-217
Voluntary Deductions (VD) master file, 4-133 to
4-135
W
WC (Work Calendars) master file, 4-209 to 4-215
Work Calendars (WC) master file, 4-209 to 4-215
Workers Compensation (TT05) master file, 4-148 to
4-150
write access, icon for, 2-11, 3-11
Index-8
Copyright © QSS, 2010
01/10